Quarterlytics / Healthcare / Medical - Devices / Cutera

Cutera

cutr · NASDAQ Healthcare
Claim this profile
Ticker cutr
Exchange NASDAQ
Sector Healthcare
Industry Medical - Devices
Employees 201-500
← All annual reports
FY2020 Annual Report · Cutera
Sign in to download
Loading PDF…
Table of Contents

UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549

FORM 10-K

☒  Annual Report Pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934

For fiscal year ended December 31, 2020
or 

☐  Transition Report Pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934

For the transition period from ____ to ____
Commission file number: 000-50644

CUTERA, INC.

(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)

Delaware
(State or other jurisdiction of
incorporation or organization)

77-0492262
(I.R.S. Employer
Identification No.)

3240 Bayshore Blvd., Brisbane, California 94005
(Address of principal executive offices)

(415) 657-5500
(Registrant’s telephone number, including area code)

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:

Title of each class

Trading Symbol(s)

Name of each exchange on which registered

Common Stock ($0.001 par value)

CUTR

The NASDAQ Stock Market, LLC

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act: None

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act. Yes ☐ No ☒

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act. Yes ☐ No ☒

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of
1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such
filing requirements for the past 90 days. Yes ☒ No ☐

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted pursuant to Rule
405 of Regulation S-T (§232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit
such files). Yes ☒ No ☐

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, smaller reporting company, or
an emerging growth company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer,” “smaller reporting company,” and “emerging growth
company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.

Large accelerated filer ☐            Accelerated filer ☒            Non-
accelerated filer ☐            Smaller reporting company ☐           
Emerging growth company ☐

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

If an emerging growth company, indicate by check mark if the registrant has elected not to use the extended transition period for complying with any

new or revised financial accounting standards provided pursuant to Section 13(a) of the Exchange Act.☐

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has filed a report on and attestation to its management’s assessment of the effectiveness of its internal

control over financial reporting under Section 404(b) of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act (15 U.S.C. 7262(b)) by the registered public accounting firm that
prepared or issued its audit report. Yes ☒ No ☐

Indicate by check mark whether registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Act). Yes ☐ No ☒

The aggregate market value of the registrant’s common stock, held by non-affiliates of the registrant as of June 30, 2020 (which is the last business
day of registrant’s most recently completed second fiscal quarter) based upon the closing price of such stock on the NASDAQ Global Select Market on
June 30, 2020, was approximately $143 million. For purposes of this disclosure, shares of common stock held by entities and individuals who own 5%
or more of the outstanding common stock and shares of common stock held by each officer and director have been excluded in that such persons may be
deemed to be “affiliates” as that term is defined under the Rules and Regulations of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934. This determination of affiliate
status is not necessarily conclusive.

The number of shares of Registrant’s common stock issued and outstanding as of March 10, 2021 was 17,782,872.

DOCUMENTS INCORPORATED BY REFERENCE

Part III incorporates by reference certain information from the registrant’s definitive proxy statement for the 2021 Annual Meeting of Stockholders,
which will be filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission not later than 120 days after December 31, 2020.

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

PART I

Item 1.
Item 1A.
Item 1B.
Item 2.
Item 3.
Item 4.

PART II

Item 5.
Item 6.
Item 7.
Item 7A.
Item 8.
Item 9.
Item 9A.
Item 9B.

PART III

Item 10.
Item 11.
Item 12.
Item 13.
Item 14.

PART IV

Item 15.
Item 16.

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Business
Risk Factors
Unresolved Staff Comments
Properties
Legal Proceedings
Mine Safety Disclosures

Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities
Selected Financial Data
Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations
Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk
Financial Statements and Supplementary Data
Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure
Controls and Procedures
Other Information

Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance
Executive Compensation
Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters
Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence
Principal Accounting Fees and Services

Exhibits, Financial Statement Schedules
Form 10K Summary

3

Page

4
17
46
47
47
47

48
50
51
64
65
99
99
100

100
100
100
100
100

101
103

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS

This Annual Report on Form 10-K contains “forward-looking statements” that involve risks and uncertainties. The Company’s actual results could differ
materially from those discussed in the forward-looking statements. The statements contained in this report that are not purely historical are forward-
looking statements within the meaning of Section 27A of the Securities Act and Section 21E of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, or the
Exchange  Act.  Forward-looking  statements  are  often  identified  by  the  use  of  words  such  as,  but  not  limited  to,  “anticipate,”  “believe,”  “can,”
“continue,”  “could,”  “estimate,”  “might,”  “expect,”  “intend,”  “may,”  “plan,”  “project,”  “seek,”  “should,”  “strategy,”  “target,”  “will,”  “would”  or
variations of these terms and similar expressions, or the negative of these terms or similar expressions intended to identify forward-looking statements.
Forward-looking statements are necessarily based on estimates and assumptions that, while considered reasonable by the Company and its management
based  on  their  knowledge  and  understanding  of  the  business  and  industry,  are  inherently  uncertain.  Forward-looking  statements  are  subject  to  risks,
uncertainties and other important factors that could cause actual results and the timing of certain events to differ materially from future results expressed
or implied by such forward-looking statements. Factors that could cause or contribute to such differences include, but are not limited to, those identified
below  and  those  discussed  in  the  section  titled  “Risk  Factors”  included  under  Part  I,  Item  1A  below.  Furthermore,  such  forward-looking  statements
speak only as of the date of this report. Except as required by law, the Company undertakes no obligation to update any forward-looking statements to
reflect events or circumstances after the date of such statements.

The following discussion and analysis should be read in conjunction with and are qualified in their entirety by reference to the discussions included in
Item 1A - Risk Factors, Item 7 - Management’s Discussion & Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations, and elsewhere in this Annual
Report on Form 10-K.

In this Annual Report on Form 10-K, unless the context otherwise requires, references to the “Company,” “Cutera,” “we,” “us” and “the Company’s”
refers to Cutera, Inc.

PART I

ITEM 1.          BUSINESS

In this Annual Report on Form 10-K, “Cutera,” “the Company,” “we,” “us” and “the Company’s” refer to Cutera, Inc. and its consolidated subsidiaries.
Cutera®, AccuTip®, CoolGlide®, CoolGlide excel®, enlighten®, excel HR®, excel V®, excel V+®, LimeLight®, MyQ®, Pearl®, PicoGenesis™,
ProWave®,  Solera®,  Titan®,  truSculpt®,  truSculpt®  flex,  Secret  PRO®,  Secret  RF®  and  xeo®  are  trademarks  for  the  systems  and  ancillary
products of the Company.

Company Background

Cutera was formed in 1988 as a Delaware corporation and is a global provider of laser and energy-based aesthetic systems for practitioners worldwide.
The  Company  designs,  develops,  manufactures,  distributes  and  markets  light  and  energy-based  product  platforms  for  use  by  physicians  and  other
qualified practitioners (collectively, “practitioners”), enabling them to offer safe and effective aesthetic treatments to their customers. In addition, the
Company  distributes  third-party  manufactured  skincare  products.  The  Company  currently  offers  easy-to-use  products  based  on  the  following  key
platforms: enlighten®, excel HR®, excel V®, excel V+®, truSculpt®, truSculpt® flex, Secret PRO®, Secret RF® and xeo® — each of which enables
physicians and other qualified practitioners to perform safe and effective aesthetic procedures, including treatment for body contouring, skin resurfacing
and  revitalization,  tattoo  removal,  removal  of  benign  pigmented  lesions,  vascular  conditions,  hair  removal,  toenail  fungus  and  women's  health.  The
Company’s platforms are designed to be easily upgraded to add additional applications and hand pieces, which provide flexibility for the Company’s
customers as they expand their practices. The Company’s ongoing research and development activities primarily focus on developing new products, as
well  as  improving  and  enhancing  the  Company’s  portfolio  of  existing  products.  The  Company  also  explores  ways  to  expand  the  Company’s  product
offerings  through  alternative  arrangements  with  other  companies,  such  as  distribution  arrangements.  The  Company  introduced  Juliet,  a  product  for
women’s health, in December 2017, Secret RF, a fractional RF microneedling device for skin revitalization, in January 2018, enlighten SR in April 2018,
truSculpt iD in July 2018, excel V+ in February 2019 and truSculpt flex in June 2019.

The  Company’s  trademarks  include:  “Cutera,”  “AcuTip,”  “CoolGlide,”  “CoolGlide  excel,”  “enlighten,”  “excel  HR,”  “excel  V,”  “excel  V+,”
“LimeLight,”  ‘myQ,”  “Pearl,”  “PicoGenesis,”  “ProWave  770,”  “Solera,”  “Titan,”  “truSculpt,”  “truSculpt  flex,”"Secret  PRO”  “Secret  RF”  and
“xeo.” The Company’s logo and other trade names, trademarks and service marks appearing in this document are the Company’s property. Other trade
names, trademarks and service marks appearing in this Annual Report on Form 10-K are the property of their respective owners. Solely for convenience,
the Company’s trademarks and trade names referred to in this Annual Report on Form 10-K appear without the ® or symbols, but those references are
not intended to indicate, in any way, that the Company will not assert, to the fullest extent under applicable law, the Company’s rights, or the right of the
applicable licensor to these trademarks and trade names.

4

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

A description of each of the Company’s hand pieces, and the aesthetic conditions they are designed to treat, is contained in the section below entitled
“Products” and a summary of the features of the Company’s primary platforms is as follows:

● truSculpt flex – In June 2019, the Company introduced the truSculpt flex for the muscle-sculpting market. This product is a bio-electrical muscle
stimulation device designed to strengthen, firm and tone the abdomen, buttocks and thighs, and can treat patients at all fitness levels. The truSculpt
flex  delivers  Multi-Direction  Stimulation  with  truControl,  inducing  muscle  hypertrophy.  Johari  (the  Company’s  contract  manufacturing
organization) received 510(k) clearance from the United States (“U.S.”) Food and Drug Administration (“FDA”) for muscle conditioning in 2013. It
is sold in the USA, Canada, Japan, certain Asia Pacific markets, and the European Union (“EU”) and is expected to be sold to a broader international
customer base upon required regulatory approvals. The truSculpt flex includes a consumable hand piece that needs to be "refilled" after a set number
of treatments are performed, resulting in recurring revenue.

● excel V+ – In February 2019, the Company introduced the excel V+, a new iteration of the excel V vascular platform originally introduced in 2011.
Excel  V+,  is  a  high-performance,  vascular  and  benign  pigmented  lesion  treatment  platform  designed  specifically  for  the  core-market  of
dermatologists and plastic surgeons. The excel V+ has 50% more power than its predecessor and provides a greater range of parameters for faster
more customizable treatments. The excel V and excel V+ are solid-state laser platforms providing a combination of the 532 nm green laser with 1064
nm Nd:YAG technology, to provide a single, compact and efficient system that treats the entire range of cosmetic vascular and benign pigmented
lesion conditions.

● truSculpt iD –In  July  2018  the  Company  introduced  a  hands-free  version  of  the  Company’s  truSculpt platform,  the  truSculpt iD,  for  the  non-
surgical  body  sculpting  market.  It  includes  consumable  cycles  that  need  to  be  ordered  by  the  practitioner  after  a  set  number  of  treatments  are
performed,  resulting  in  recurring  revenue.  This  product  is  a  high-powered  RF  system  designed  for  body  contouring,  lipolysis,  and  deep  tissue
heating,  and  is  able  to  treat  all  body  and  skin  types.  The  truSculpt iD delivers  targeted  energy  at  2  MHz,  causing  lipolysis  of  the  subcutaneous
adipose  tissue.  The  Company  received  510(k)  clearance  from  the  FDA  for  lipolysis  of  abdominal  fat  in  2018.  It  was  primarily  sold  in  the  U.S.,
Canada and Europe in 2018 and was sold to a broader international customer base in 2019. Prior truSculpt platforms include the truSculpt 3D, a 2
MHZ device for tissue heating and temporary reduction of fat in the abdomen, and the original truSculpt platform which was launched in August
2012 and delivered treatments at 1 MHz. In December 2016, the Company received 510(k) clearance from the FDA to market the truSculpt platform
for the temporary reduction in circumference of the abdomen. The truSculpt 3D includes a consumable hand piece that needs to be “refilled” after a
set number of treatments are performed, resulting in recurring revenue.

● Juliet – In December 2017, the Company introduced the Juliet laser for women’s intimate health. Juliet is a versatile multi-application platform
utilizing  an  Er:YAG  laser  with  the  2940  nm  wavelength.  This  Erbium  wavelength  produces  noticeable  results  due  to  its  high  peak  absorption  in
water.  Additionally,  Juliet’s Erbium  technology  allows  for  a  controlled  thermal  delivery  to  tissue,  keeping  the  procedure  safe  for  patients  while
minimizing downtime. Juliet delivers two passes of energy to the target area during treatment. The first pass uses ablation to vaporize the tissue and
create micro-channels of injury. The second pass uses coagulation to deliver a thermal injury to the area, which further stimulates the body's normal
wound healing process, revitalizing, and remodeling damaged tissue and introducing the formation of new blood vessels. Juliet also has a disposable
tip, which must be changed for every procedure. As a result, the replacement of the tips results in recurring revenue. The Company is the distributor
of  Juliet.  All  regulatory  activities  are  managed  by  Asclepion  laser  technologies  gmbh,  the  legal  manufacturer.  During  the  quarter  ended  June  30,
2020, the Company wrote-off $0.8 million of inventory on hand related to its Juliet platform due to declining sales. Sales related to Juliet have been
declining  due  to  the  COVID-19  pandemic  and  the  FDA  letter  issued  on  July  30,  2018  expressing  concerns  regarding  “vaginal  rejuvenation”
procedures using energy-based devices.

● Secret RF – In January 2018, the Company introduced a new fractional radio frequency (“RF”) microneedling device that delivers heat into the
deeper layers of the skin using controlled RF energy. The targeted energy revitalizes, rebuilds and firms up tissue, effectively remodeling collagen,
improving  mild  wrinkles  and  diminishing  scars  while  leaving  the  outer  layer  of  skin  intact,  minimizing  downtime.  Each  time  a  procedure  is
performed, it requires the physician to use a new hand piece tip. The sale of the replacement tip results in recurring revenue. The Company is the
distributor of Secret RF. All regulatory activities are managed by Ilooda Co. Ltd.

● enlighten – In December 2014, the Company introduced the enlighten laser platform with a dual wavelength (1064 nanometer, or “nm” + 532 nm)
and in December 2016, the Company introduced a three wavelength model (1064 nm + 532 nm + 670 nm), enlighten III. The enlighten system is a
dual pulse duration (750 picosecond, or “ps,” and 2 nanosecond, or “ns”) laser system and is cleared for multi-colored tattoo removal and for the
treatment of benign pigmented lesions and acne scars. In 2018, the Company introduced an expanded performance enlighten III and in April 2018,
the Company introduced enlighten SR, which is a lighter version of enlighten with reduced optical performance. Clinical studies were conducted to
support an FDA clearance in October 2018 for treatment of acne scars on patients with Fitzpatrick skin types II-V when used with the Micro Lens
Array (“MLA”) hand piece attachment.

● excel HR –  In  June  2014,  the  Company  introduced  the  excel HR platform,  a  premium  hair  removal  solution  for  all  skin  types,  combining  the
Company’s proven long-pulse 1064 nm Nd:YAG laser and a high-power 755 nm Alexandrite laser with sapphire contact cooling.

●   xeo –  In  2003,  the  Company  introduced  the  xeo platform,  which  combines  intense  pulsed  light  technology  with  laser  applications  in  a  single
system.  The  xeo  is  a  multi-application  platform  on  which  a  customer  can  purchase  hand  piece  applications  for  the  removal  of  unwanted  hair,
treatment of vascular lesions, and skin revitalization by treating discoloration, fine lines and laxity.

In addition to the above mentioned seven primary systems, the Company continues to generate revenue from its legacy products such as GenesisPlus,
CoolGlide, and the distribution of skincare products, a product manufactured by ZO Skin Health, Inc. (“ZO”), and sold in the Japanese market. The
Company also generates revenue from the sale of post-warranty services, as well as the sales of Titan hand piece refills, and from the lease arrangements
under its membership program.

The Company offers its customers the ability to select the systems and applications that best fit their practice and to subsequently upgrade their systems
to add new applications. This upgrade path allows the Company’s customers to cost-effectively build their aesthetic practices and provides the Company
with a source of incremental revenue.

5

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Recent Developments

On March 9, 2021, the Company offered $125 million aggregate principal amount of 2.25% convertible senior notes due 2026 (the “notes”) in a private
placement  to  qualified  institutional  buyers  pursuant  to  Rule  144A  under  the  Securities  Act  of  1933,  as  amended  (the  “Securities  Act”).  Cutera  also
granted the initial purchasers of the notes an option to purchase up to an additional $13.25 million aggregate principal amount of the notes on the same
terms and conditions. The Initial Purchasers exercised their option in full on March 5, 2021, bringing the total aggregate principal amount of the Notes
to $138.25 million.

The Company entered into capped call transactions, in connection with the offering, with one or more of the initial purchasers and/or their respective
affiliates and/or other financial institutions (the “option counterparties”). The capped call transactions are expected generally to reduce potential dilution
to Cutera’s common stock upon any conversion of notes, with such reduction subject to a cap. If the initial purchasers exercise their option to purchase
additional notes, the Company expects to enter into additional capped call transactions with the option counterparties.

The  net  proceeds  from  the  offering,  before  deducting  purchasers’  discounts  and  offering  expenses  were  approximately  $134.1  million.  The  Company
used $16.1 million of the net proceeds to pay the cost of the capped call transactions described above and the remainder of the net proceeds for general
corporate purposes, which may include working capital, capital expenditures and potential acquisitions and strategic transactions.

In connection with the offering, the Company entered into Amendment No. 1 to Loan and Security Agreement on March 4, 2021, which amends the
Company’s  Loan  and  Security  Agreement,  dated  as  of  July  9,  2020  between  the  Company,  as  borrower,  and  Silicon  Valley  Bank.  The  Amendment
amends  the  Loan  and  Security  Agreement  to  (i)  permit  the  Company  to  issue  the  Notes  and  perform  its  obligations  in  connection  therewith,  and  (ii)
permit the Capped Call transactions.

The Market for Non-Surgical Aesthetic Procedures

The market for non-surgical aesthetic procedures has grown significantly over the past several years. According to data presented at the IMCAS Global
Market Summit in February 2020, the medical aesthetic global market is expected to grow at 11.5% from 2019 to reach $22.2 billion by 2025. The body
contouring market is expected to grow to $1.1 billion by 2022 at annual growth rate of 7.9%.

The Company believes there are several factors contributing to the global growth of aesthetic treatment procedures and aesthetic laser equipment sales,
including:

● Improved Economic Environment and Expanded Physician Base – The improvements in overall global economic conditions since the financial
crisis of 2007-2008 have created increased demand for aesthetic procedures, which in turn has resulted in an expanding practitioner base to satisfy
the demand.
●   Aging  Demographics  of  Industrialized  Countries  –  The  aging  population  of  industrialized  countries,  the  amount  of  discretionary  income
available to the “baby boomer” demographic segment ─ ages 56 to 74 as of 2020 ─ and their desire to retain a youthful appearance, contribute to the
increased demand for aesthetic procedures.
● Broader Range of Safe and Effective Treatments – Technical developments, as well as an increase in treatable conditions due to new product
introductions,  lead  to  safe,  effective,  easy-to-use,  and  low-cost  treatments  with  fewer  side  effects,  resulting  in  broader  adoption  of  aesthetic
procedures  by  practitioners.  In  addition,  technical  advancements  enable  practitioners  to  offer  a  broader  range  of  treatments.  These  technical
developments reduce treatment and recovery times, which in turn lead to greater patient demand.
●   Broader  Base  of  Customers  –  Managed  care  and  government  payor  reimbursement  restrictions  motivate  physicians  to  establish,  or  seek  to
expand, their elective aesthetic practices with procedures that are paid for directly by patients. As a result, in addition to core practitioners such as
dermatologists  and  plastic  surgeons,  many  other  practitioners,  such  as  gynecologists,  family  practitioners,  primary  care  physicians,  physicians
performing aesthetic treatments in non-medical offices, and other qualified practitioners (“non-core practitioners”) expand their practices and offer
aesthetic procedures.
● Reductions in Cost per Procedure – Due in part to increased competition in the aesthetic market, the cost per procedure has been reduced in the
past few years. This attracts a broader base of customers and patients seeking aesthetic procedures.
●   Wide Acceptance of Aesthetic Procedures and  Increased  Focus  on  Body  Image  and  Appearance  –  According  to  the  American  Society  for
Aesthetic Plastic Surgery survey in 2019 both surgical and non-surgical procedures increased compared to 2015. Surgical procedures increased by
6.2%, while non-surgical procedures increased by 13.3% over this 4 year period.

Non-Surgical Aesthetic Procedures for Improving the Body and/or Skin’s Appearance and Their Limitations

Many alternative therapies are available for improving a person’s appearance by treating specific structures within the skin. These procedures utilize
injections or abrasive agents to reach different depths of the dermis and the epidermis. In addition, non-invasive and minimally invasive treatments have
been  developed  that  employ  laser  and  other  energy-based  technologies  to  achieve  similar  therapeutic  results.  Some  of  these  common  aesthetic
procedures and their limitations are described below.

Non-Invasive Body Contouring – Treatments for non-invasive body sculpting can be done utilizing a variety of technologies including radio frequency,
laser, cooling and ultrasound. Procedures address reduction of unwanted fat on the abdomen, flanks, arms, thighs, submentum and back, and can require
one or more treatments. Systems with the ability to induce non-invasive lipolysis (breakdown of fat) offer a more permanent solution with an average fat
reduction of more than 20%. Side effects to this approach may include nodules that typically resolve over time, and the risk of burning the treatment
area.  In  June  2019,  the  Company  introduced  the  truSculpt  flex,  a  bio-electrical  muscle  stimulation  device  designed  to  strength,  firm  and  tone  the
abdomen, buttocks and thighs.

Tattoo removal – The most effective way to remove tattoos on the body is to utilize laser systems that deliver very short pulse durations with high peak
power in order to break up the ink particles that comprise tattoos.

The global tattoo removal market was valued at $122.8 million in 2019 and is projected to reach $219.0 million by 2026 growing at 8.5% from 2019 to
2026. According to the market research, people tend to get rid of their tattoos due to career purposes, social conditions, personal situations, and more,
which have been the key drivers for the tattoo removal market. Despite the effectiveness of lasers for tattoo removal, common complaints concerning
laser tattoo removal include a low rate of complete clearance (sometimes no better than 50% after several treatments) as well as the high number of
treatments for satisfactory clearance (often 10 or more treatments spaced four to eight weeks apart). However, the latest generation of tattoo removal

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
lasers produce picosecond pulse durations, (a trillionth of a second) and thereby, can meaningfully improve tattoo clearance and reduce the total number
of treatments. The Company introduced the enlighten system, a dual pulse duration laser system, that was cleared for multi-colored tattoo removal.

6

 
Table of Contents

Hair Removal –  Techniques  for  hair  removal  include  waxing,  depilatories,  tweezing,  shaving,  electrolysis,  laser  as  well  as  other  energy-based  hair
removal modalities. The only techniques that provide a long-lasting solution are electrolysis, laser, and other energy-based technology such as an Intense
Pulsed Light (“IPL”). Electrolysis is usually painful, time-consuming and expensive for large areas, but is the most common method for removing light-
colored  hair.  During  electrolysis,  an  electrologist  inserts  a  needle  directly  into  a  hair  follicle  and  activates  an  electric  current  in  the  needle.  Since
electrolysis  only  treats  one  hair  follicle  at  a  time,  the  treatment  of  an  area  as  small  as  an  upper  lip  may  require  numerous  visits  and  many  hours  of
treatment. In addition, electrolysis can cause blemishes and infection related to needle use. In comparison, lasers can quickly treat large areas with a high
degree of safety and efficacy. In 2003, the Company introduced the xeo system platform utilized for hair removal, which combines intense pulse light
technology with laser applications in a single system. In 2014, the Company introduced the excel HR platform, a premium hair removal solution for all
skin  types,  combining  the  Company’s  proven  long-pulse  1064  nm  Nd:YAG  laser  and  a  high-power  755  nm  Alexandrite  laser  with  sapphire  contact
cooling.

Skin Revitalization – Skin  revitalization  treatments  include  a  broad  range  of  popular  alternatives,  including  Botox  and  collagen  injections,  chemical
peel, microdermabrasion, radio frequency treatment and laser and other energy-based treatments. With these treatments, patients hope to improve overall
skin tone and texture, reduce pore size, tighten skin and remove other signs of aging, including mottled pigmentation, diffuse redness and wrinkles. All
of these procedures are temporary solutions and must be repeated within several weeks or months to sustain their effect, thereby increasing the cost and
inconvenience to patients. For example, the body absorbs Botox and collagen, and patients require supplemental injections every three to six months to
maintain the benefits of these treatments.

Other  skin  revitalization  treatments,  such  as  chemical  peels  and  microdermabrasion,  can  have  undesirable  side  effects.  Chemical  peels  use  acidic  or
caustic solutions to peel away the epidermis, and microdermabrasion generally utilizes sand crystals to resurface the skin. These techniques can lead to
stinging, redness, irritation and scabbing. In addition, more serious complications, such as changes in skin color, can result from deeper chemical peels.

With many modalities available today for skin revitalization and resurfacing, the Company has developed a range of clinically proven solutions uniquely
paired  with  a  patient’s  lifestyle  and  skin  concerns,  such  as  Secret  PRO,  which  utilizes  fractional  CO2  for  skin  resurfacing  and  radio  frequency
microneedling for deep dermal remodeling and Secret RF, a novel fractional RF microneedling system for tissue coagulation and hemostasis designed to
stimulate and remodel collagen and address the common signs of aging.

Microneedling –  Also  known  as  collagen  induction  therapy,  microneedling  is  a  minimally  invasive  revitalization  treatment  that  involves  using  fine
needles to create hundreds of tiny, invisible puncture wounds in the top layer of the skin, which stimulates the body's natural wound healing processes,
resulting in cell turnover and increased collagen and elastin production. In January 2018, the Company introduced Secret RF product, a RF fractional
microneedling system that helps deliver tailored energy to improve fine lines, wrinkles, and scars from the inside out.

Women’s Intimate Health – Lasers and RF technology have emerged as a treatment for issues unique to women's health such as vulvar vaginal atrophy
and  genitourinary  symptoms  of  menopause.  The  condition  causes  vaginal  dryness,  inflammation  and  irritation,  which  can  lead  to  painful  or  frequent
urination.  Traditional  treatments  use  estrogen  therapy  to  combat  vulvar  vaginal  atrophy  and  genitourinary  symptoms  of  menopause  to  restore  vaginal
health, but not all women suffering from the symptoms are candidates. Lasers have been shown to ablate the vaginal tissue generating a healing response
that may lead to symptomatic improvement.

Leg and Facial Veins – Current  aesthetic  treatment  methods  for  leg  and  facial  veins  include  sclerotherapy,  as  well  as  laser  and  other  energy-based
treatments.  With  these  treatments,  patients  seek  to  eliminate  visible  veins,  and  improve  overall  skin  appearance.  Sclerotherapy  requires  a  skilled
practitioner to inject a saline or detergent-based solution into the target vein, which breaks down the vessel causing it to collapse and be absorbed into
the body. The need to correctly position the needle on the inside of the vein makes it difficult to treat smaller veins, which limits the treatment of facial
vessels  and  small  leg  veins.  In  2019,  the  Company  introduced  the  excel  V+,  a  high-performance,  vascular  and  benign  pigmented  lesion  treatment
platform designed specifically for the core-market of dermatologists and plastic surgeons, which treats the entire range of cosmetic vascular and benign
pigmented lesion conditions.

Laser  and  other  energy-based  non-surgical  treatments  for  hair  removal,  veins,  skin  revitalization  and  body  contouring  are  discussed  in  the  following
section.

Laser and Other Energy-Based Aesthetic Treatments

Laser and other energy-based aesthetic treatments can achieve therapeutic results by affecting structures within the skin. The development of safe and
effective aesthetic treatments has resulted in a well-established market for these procedures.

Practitioners  can  use  laser  and  other  energy-based  technologies  to  selectively  target  hair  follicles,  veins  or  collagen  in  the  dermis,  as  well  as  cells
responsible  for  pigmentation  in  the  epidermis,  without  damaging  surrounding  tissue.  Practitioners  can  also  use  these  technologies  to  safely  remove
portions  of  the  epidermis  and  deliver  heat  to  the  dermis  as  a  means  of  generating  new  collagen  growth.  Ablative  skin  resurfacing  improves  the
appearance of the skin by removing the outer layers of the skin. Ablative skin resurfacing procedures are considered invasive or minimally invasive,
depending on how much of the epidermis is removed during a treatment. Non-ablative skin resurfacing improves the appearance of the skin by treating
the underlying structure of the skin.

Safe and effective laser and energy-based treatments require an appropriate combination of the four parameters:

● Energy Level – the amount of light or radio frequency emitted to heat a target;
● Pulse Duration – the time interval over which the energy is delivered;
● Spot Size or Electrode Size – the diameter of the energy beam, which affects treatment depth and area; and
● Wavelength or Frequency – the position in the electromagnetic spectrum which impacts the absorption and the effective depth of the energy
delivered.

For example, in the case of hair removal, by utilizing the correct combination of these parameters, a practitioner can use a laser or other light source to
selectively target melanin within the hair follicle to absorb the laser energy and destroy the follicle, without damaging other delicate structures in the
surrounding tissue.

Technology and Design of the Company’s Systems

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
The Company’s enlighten, excel, Secret PRO, Juliet, Secret RF, truSculpt and xeo platforms provide the long-lasting benefits of laser and other energy-
based  aesthetic  treatments.  The  Company’s  technology  allows  for  a  wide  variety  of  applications  in  a  single  system.  Key  features  of  the  Company’s
solutions include:

7

 
 
Table of Contents

● Multiple Applications Available in a Single System – Many  of  the  Company’s  platforms  feature  multiple-applications  that  enable  practitioners  to
perform  a  variety  of  aesthetic  procedures  using  a  single  device.  These  procedures  include  hair  removal,  vascular  treatments  and  skin  revitalization,
which  address  discoloration,  fine  lines,  and  uneven  texture.  Because  practitioners  can  use  the  Company’s  systems  for  multiple  indications,  the
investment in a unit is spread across a greater number of patients and procedures, and the acquisition cost may be more rapidly recovered.

● Technology and Design Leadership – The Company’s innovative laser technology combines multiple wavelengths, adjustable energy levels, variable
spot sizes and a wide range of pulse durations, allowing practitioners to customize treatments for each patient and condition. The Company’s proprietary
pulsed  light  hand  pieces  for  the  treatment  of  discoloration,  hair  removal  and  vascular  treatments  optimize  the  wavelength  used  for  treatments  and
incorporate  a  monitoring  system  to  increase  safety.  The  Company’s  Titan hand  piece  utilizes  a  novel  light  source  not  previously  used  for  aesthetic
treatments. The Company’s Pearl and Pearl Fractional hand pieces, with proprietary YSGG technology, represent the first application of the 2790 nm
wavelength for minimally invasive cosmetic dermatology.

●   Upgradeable  Platform  –  Some  of  the  Company’s  products  allow  the  Company’s  customers  to  upgrade  their  system  to  the  Company’s  newest
technologies or add new applications to their system, each of which provide the Company with a source of incremental revenue. The Company believes
that product upgradeability allows customers to take advantage of the Company’s latest product offerings and provide additional treatment options to
their patients, thereby expanding the opportunities for their aesthetic practices.

● Treatments for Broad Range of Skin Types and Conditions – For hair removal, the Company’s products are safe and effective on patients of all skin
types, including harder-to-treat patients with dark or tanned skin. In addition, the wide parameter range of the Company’s systems allows practitioners to
effectively treat patients with both fine and coarse hair. Practitioners may use the Company’s products to treat spider veins on the leg; to treat facial
veins;  and  perform  skin  revitalization  procedures  for  discoloration,  texture,  fine  lines  and  wrinkles  on  any  type  of  skin.  The  ability  to  customize
treatment parameters based on skin type enables practitioners to offer safe and effective therapies to a broad base of their patients.

● Ease of Use – The Company designs its products to be easy to use. The Company’s proprietary hand pieces are lightweight and ergonomic, minimize
user fatigue, and facilitate clear views of the treatment area, reducing the possibility of unintended damage and increasing the speed of application. The
Company’s  control  console  contains  an  intuitive  user  interface  with  simple,  independently  adjustable  controls  from  which  to  select  a  wide  range  of
treatment parameters to suit each patient’s profile. For instance, the clinical navigation user interface on the xeo platform provides recommended clinical
treatment parameter ranges based on patient criteria entered. The Company’s Pearl and Pearl Fractional hand pieces include a scanner with multiple
scan  patterns  to  allow  simple  and  fast  treatments  of  the  face.  Finally,  the  Company’s  truSculpt iD embodies  the  best  of  many  of  the  above  features.
Unlike other body sculpting treatments on the market that require certain body types, or pinchable fat, truSculpt iD is “body agnostic” with the ability to
customize treatments to the patient's needs and body type. In addition, the Company’s proprietary algorithms and navigation enable the practitioner to
treat a 300cm2 area in only 15 minutes.

Business Strategy

The  Company’s  goal  is  to  maintain  and  expand  its  position  as  a  leading  worldwide  provider  of  light  and  energy-based  aesthetic  devices  and
complementary aesthetic products by executing the following strategies:

● Continue to Expand the Company’s Product Offering – Though the Company believes that its current portfolio of products is comprehensive, the
Company’s research and development group has a pipeline of potential products under development. The Company launched excel V in 2011, truSculpt
in 2012, ProWave LX in 2013, and excel HR and enlighten in 2014. In addition, the Company continues to expand offerings on the Company’s current
platforms with further enhancement such as the enlighten III launched in 2016, truSculpt 3D launched in 2017, enlighten SR launched in April 2018,
truSculpt iD launched in July 2018, excel V+ launched in February 2019 and truSculpt flex launched in June 2019. The Company also introduced Juliet,
a product for women’s health, in December 2017, Secret RF, a fractional RF microneedling device for skin revitalization, in January 2018, and Secret
PRO, a CO2 fractional RF microneedling device, in July 2020. These products allow the Company to leverage existing customer call points and create
new customer call points.

●   Increase  Revenue  and  Improve  Productivity  –  The  Company  believes  that  the  market  for  aesthetic  systems  will  continue  to  offer  growth
opportunities.  The  Company  continues  to  build  brand  recognition,  add  additional  products  to  the  Company’s  international  distribution  channel,  and
focus on enhancing the Company’s global distribution network, all of which the Company expects will contribute to increased revenue.

● Increase Focus on Practitioners with Established Medical Offices – The Company believes there is growth opportunity in targeting the Company’s
products  to  a  broad  customer  base.  The  Company  also  believes  that  its  customers’  success  is  largely  dependent  upon  having  an  existing  medical
practice, for which the Company’s systems provide incremental revenue sources to augment a customer’s existing practice revenue.

● Leverage the Company’s Installed Base – With the introduction of enlighten, excel V, excel HR and truSculpt, the  Company  is  able  to  effectively
offer additional platforms into the existing installed base. In addition, each of these platforms allows for potential future upgrades that offer additional
capabilities.  The  Company  believes  this  program  aligns  the  Company’s  interest  in  generating  revenue  with  the  Company’s  customers’  interest  in
improving the return on their investment by expanding the range of treatments that can be performed in their practice.

● Generate Revenue from Services and Refillable, Consumable, Hand Pieces – The Company’s Titan, truSculpt 3D, truSculpt iD and truSculpt flex
cycle and pulsed-light handpieces are refillable products, while the Company’s single use disposable tips applicable to Secret PRO, Juliet and Secret RF
are consumable products. Each provides the Company with the opportunity to participate in the procedure-based revenue from the Company’s existing
customers. The Company offers post-warranty services to its customers either through extended service contracts to cover preventive maintenance or
through direct billing for parts and labor. These post-warranty services serve as additional sources of revenue.

●   Generate  Revenue  from  Skincare  (Cosmeceutical)  Products  –  The  Company  generates  revenue  from  distribution  of  third  party  manufactured
skincare products in Japan. The skincare products are purchased from a third-party manufacturer and sold to licensed physicians and other end users.
The Company recognizes revenue for these skincare products when they are sold to the customer.

● Generate Revenue from Leasing of Equipment Through a Membership Program – In the second quarter of 2020, the Company began generating
revenue from leasing equipment to customers through a membership program where the customer pays a fixed monthly fee over the lease term. The
Company enters into leasing transactions, in which the Company is the lessor, through the Company's membership program. Revenue is recognized over

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
the term of the lease. Along with the leased equipment, the membership program provides customers with a warranty service and a fixed amount of
consumables per month for the term of the lease.

8

 
Table of Contents

Products

The  Company’s  enlighten, excel, Secret PRO, Juliet,  Secret  RF,  truSculpt, and xeo, and  myQ  platforms  allow  for  the  delivery  of  multiple  laser  and
energy-based  aesthetic  applications  from  a  single  system.  With  the  Company’s  xeo  platform,  practitioners  can  purchase  customized  systems  with  a
variety of the Company’s multi-technology applications. Each of the Company’s products consists of a control console and one or more hand pieces,
depending on the model.

The following table lists the Company’s currently offered products. Each checked box represents the applications included in the product in the years
noted.

Skin Revitalization

Noninvasive
Body
Contouring*

Women’s
Health

Vascular
Lesions  

BPL’s
Dyschromia
& Melasma  

Texture,
Lines and
Wrinkles  

Acne
Scars  

Tattoo
Removal   Lipolysis*

Gynecology

Applications:

System
Platforms  
CoolGlide  

xeo

  Year  
  2000  
  2001  
  2003  

Products
CV
Excel
Nd:YAG
ProWave
770
  2005  
AcuTip 500   2005  
Titan V/XL   2006  
  2006  
LimeLight
Pearl
  2007  
Pearl
  2008  
Fractional
ProWave LX  2013  
  2011  
  2011  
  2012  
  2014  
  2014  
  2016  
  2017  
  2018  
  2018  
  2018  
  2019  
  2019  
  2020  

excel V
myQ 
truSculpt 
excel HR 
enlighten(dual wavelength)
enlighten III (MLA)
truSculpt 3D
Juliet
Secret RF
truSculpt iD
truSculpt flex
excel V+
Secret PRO

(b)
(b)
(c)
(b)
(d)

(d)
(b)
(e)
(e)
(f)
(g)
(h)
(i)
(f)
(j)
(k)
(f)
(f)
(e)
(l)

Energy
Source  
(a)
(a)
(a)

Hair
Removal  
x
x
x

x

x
x

x

x
x

x

x

x

x

x
x

x

x
x

x
x
x

x

 x

 x

 x

  x

x

x

x

x

x
x

x

x

x
x

x

x

x

x*
x*

X

EnergySources:
  (a)1064 nm Nd:YAG laser;
  (b)Visible and near-infrared Intense Pulsed Light;
  (c)Infrared Intense Pulsed Light;
  (d)2790 nm Er:YSGG laser;
  (e)Combined frequency-doubled 532 nm and 1064 nm Nd:YAG laser;
  (f)Radio frequency at 1 & 2 MHz – mono-polar
  (g)Combined 755 nm Alexandrite laser and 1064 nm Nd:YAG laser;
  (h)Dual wavelength 532 nm and 1064 nm Nd:YAG picosecond laser;
  (i)Three wavelength 532 nm, 670 nm, and 1064 nm Nd:YAG picosecond laser;
  (j)2940 nm Er:YAG laser;
  (k)Radio frequency at 2 MHz mono-polar; and
  (l)Radio frequency at 2 MHz Bi-polar.

* The Company’s CE Mark allows it to market truSculpt in the European Union, Australia and certain other countries outside the U.S. for fat reduction,
body shaping and body contouring. In  the  U.S.  the  Company  has  510(k)  clearance  for  the  reduction  in  circumference  of  the  abdomen,  non-invasive
lipolysis (breakdown of fat) of the abdomen  and  elevating  tissue  temperature  for  the  treatment  of  selected  medical  conditions  such  as  relief  of  pain,
muscle spasms, increase in local circulation, and the temporary improvement in the appearance of cellulite.

Upgrade

The Company’s enlighten, truSculpt, and xeo products, are designed to allow customers to cost-effectively upgrade to the Company’s newest
technologies or add applications to their system, each of which provides the Company with a source of additional revenue.

9

 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Extended contract services and support

The Company offers post-warranty services to its customers through extended service contracts that cover parts and labor for a term of one, two, or three
years. The Company also offers services on a time-and-materials basis for systems and detachable hand piece replacements. Revenue related to services
performed on a time-and-materials basis is recognized when performed. These post-warranty services serve as additional sources of recurring revenue
from the Company’s installed product base.

The  Company’s  products  are  engineered  to  enable  quick  and  efficient  service  and  support.  There  are  several  separate  components  of  the  Company’s
products, each of which can be removed and replaced. The Company believes that quick and effective delivery of service is important to its customers.
As of December 31, 2020, the Company had 323 employees.

In  countries  where  the  Company  is  represented  by  distribution  partners,  customers  are  serviced  through  the  distributor.  Distributors  are  generally
provided  14  to  16  months  warranty  coverage  for  parts  only,  with  labor  customarily  provided  to  the  end  customer  by  the  distributor.  The  Company’s
Titan, truSculpt 3D, truSculpt iD, and truSculpt flex hand pieces generally include a warranty for a set number of shots, instead of for a period of time.

Training

Sales  of  systems  to  customers,  except  system  sales  through  distributors,  include  training  on  the  use  of  the  system  to  be  provided  within  180  days  of
purchase.  Training  is  also  sold  separately  from  systems.  The  Company  recognizes  revenue  for  training  when  the  training  is  provided.  Training  is  not
required for customers to use the systems.

Consumables (Other accessories)

The Company treats its customers' purchases of replacement cycles for truSculpt iD and truSculpt flex,  as  well  as  replacement  Titan  and  truSculpt  3D
hand pieces, as Consumable revenue, which provides the Company with a source of recurring revenue from existing customers. The Juliet and Secret RF
products have single use disposable tips which must be replaced after every treatment. Sales of these consumable tips further enhance the Company’s
recurring revenue. Hand piece refills of the Company’s legacy truSculpt product are accounted for as service contract revenue.

Applications and Procedures

The Company’s products are designed to allow the practitioner to select an appropriate combination of energy level, spot size and pulse duration for
each treatment. The ability to manipulate the combinations of these parameters allows the Company’s customers to treat the broadest range of conditions
available with a single energy-based system.

Non-Invasive Body Contouring – The Company’s truSculpt technology allows practitioners to apply a hand piece directly to the skin and deliver high-
powered RF energy that results in the deep and uniform heating of the subcutaneous fat tissue at sustained therapeutic temperatures. This heating can
cause selective destruction of fat cells, which are eliminated from the treatment area through the body’s natural wound healing processes. The treatment
takes approximately 15 minutes and two or more treatments may be required to obtain the desired aesthetic results. The Company’s CE Mark allows the
Company to market truSculpt in the EU, Australia and certain other countries outside the U.S. for fat reduction, body shaping, body contouring and
circumferential reduction. In the U.S., truSculpt has 510(k) clearance for topical heating for the purpose of elevating tissue temperature for the treatment
of selected medical conditions, such as relief of pain and muscle spasms and increase in local circulation. Additionally, the 2 MHz setting for the 40 cm2
hand  piece  is  indicated  for  reduction  in  circumference  of  the  abdomen  and  non-invasive  lipolysis  (breakdown  of  fat)  of  the  abdomen.  The  truSculpt
massage device is intended to provide a temporary reduction in the appearance of cellulite.

Tattoo Removal – The Company’s enlighten systems, delivering picosecond and nanosecond pulse duration, and the Company’s my Q Q-switched laser
are used for tattoo removal, the treatment of benign pigmented lesions, and a laser skin toning procedure that the Company refers to as PicoGenesis.

Hair Removal – The Company has two platforms, excel HR and xeo,  which  address  hair  removal  for  all  skin  types  as  well  as  hair  thicknesses.  The
Company’s xeo platform allows practitioners to select between the 1064 nm mode for darker, course hair, and the ProWave LX hand piece designed to
address finer, vellus hair. Contact cooling is present on both hand pieces for epidermal protection. excel HR employs both a 1064 nm Nd:YAG as well
as a 755 nm Alexandrite for hair removal. Like the xeo, the 1064 nm wavelength addresses darker, course hair while the 755 nm wavelength is used for
finer, lighter hair. Both wavelengths are transmitted through the same CoolView hand piece with spot sizes up to 20 mm for the 755 nm wavelength and
up to 18 mm for the 1064 nm wavelength. The CoolView hand  piece  employs  sapphire  as  a  means  of  contact  cooling  –  epidermal  protection.  Both
platforms are cleared for treating all skin types.

Vascular Lesions – Both the Company’s xeo as well as excel V platforms are capable of treating a wide range of aesthetic vein conditions, including
spider and reticular veins, and small facial veins. xeo employs the LimeLight hand piece for addressing small veins as well as vascular lesions while the
Nd:YAG is appropriate for deeper, larger vessels. LimeLight is a fixed spot size IPL while the Nd:YAG has adjustable spot sizes up to 10mm. excel V is
a dual wavelength laser – 1064 nm and 532 nm – with adjustable spot sizes ranging from 2 mm to 12 mm. The 532 nm wavelength can be used to treat
over 20 conditions ranging from small veins and vessels to a variety of vascular lesions while the Nd:YAG is appropriate for deeper, larger vessels. For
both of these devices, patients receive on average between one and six treatments, with six weeks or longer between treatments.

Skin Revitalization – The Company’s xeo, excel V, excel HR and  enlighten  platforms,  utilizing  an  Nd:YAG  laser,  allow  the  Company’s  customers  to
perform  non-invasive  and  minimally-invasive  treatments  that  reduce  redness,  dyschromia,  fine  lines,  improve  skin  texture,  and  treat  other  aesthetic
conditions. When using a 1064 nm Nd:YAG laser to improve skin texture and treat fine lines, cooling is not applied and the hand piece is held directly
above the skin. A large number of pulses are directed at the treatment site, repeatedly covering an area, such as the cheek. By delivering many pulses of
laser  light  to  a  treatment  area,  a  gentle  heating  of  the  dermis  occurs  and  collagen  growth  is  stimulated  to  rejuvenate  the  skin  and  reduce  wrinkles.
Patients typically receive four to six treatments for this procedure. The treatment typically takes less than a half hour with a spacing of two to four weeks
between treatments.

10

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Texture, Lines and Wrinkles – The xeo platform can address fine lines and wrinkles using the Pearl and Pearl Fractional hand pieces. When treating fine
lines, texture and wrinkles with a Pearl hand piece, the hand piece is held at a controlled distance from the skin and the scanner delivers a preset pattern
of spots to the treatment area. Cooling is not applied to the epidermis during the treatment. The energy delivered by the hand piece ablates a portion of
the epidermis while leaving a coagulated portion that will gently peel off over the course of a few days. Heat is also delivered into the dermis, which can
result in the production of new collagen. Treatment of the full face can usually be performed in 15 to 30 minutes. Patients receive on average between
one and three treatments at monthly intervals.

The Company’s Juliet laser is a versatile multi-application platform utilizing an Er:YAG laser with the 2940 nm wavelength. This Erbium wavelength
produces  noticeable  results  with  fewer  side  effects,  due  to  its  high  peak  absorption  in  water.  Additionally,  Juliet’s  Erbium  technology  allows  for  a
controlled thermal delivery to tissue. The Microspot hand piece delivers fractionated energy to induce skin resurfacing and improved skin quality, tone
and texture.

Additionally, the Company’s Secret RF platform is a Radio Frequency microneedling device that employs fractionated RF energy (2 MHz) delivered at
different pre-programmed depths in the dermis to produce new collagen. The Secret RF comes with four treatment tips: a 25-pin tip, both insulated and
semi-insulated, and a 64-pin tip, both insulated and semi-insulated. The treatment has minimal side effects, negligible downtime and results in improved
skin tone and texture as well as improvement in acne scars.

Dyschromia – The Company’s pulsed-light technologies allow the Company’s customers to safely and effectively treat red and brown dyschromia (skin
discoloration),  benign  pigmented  lesions,  and  rosacea.  The  practitioner  delivers  a  narrow  spectrum  of  light  to  the  surface  of  the  skin  through  the
Company’s LimeLight hand  pieces.  These  hand  pieces  include  one  of  the  Company’s  proprietary  wavelength  filters,  which  reduce  the  energy  level
required for therapeutic effect and minimize the risk of skin injury.

The 532 nm wavelength green laser option of the excel V and enlighten systems, as well as the 755 nm infrared wavelength of the excel HR, can be used
to treat benign pigmented lesions in substantially the same way.

In treating benign pigmented lesions, the hand piece is placed directly on the skin and then the pulse is triggered. The cells forming the pigmented lesion
absorb the light energy, darken and then flake off over the course of two to three weeks. Several treatments may be required to completely remove the
lesion. The treatment takes a few minutes per area treated and there are typically three to four weeks between treatments.

Practitioners can also treat dyschromia and other skin conditions with the Company’s Pearl hand piece. During these treatments, the heat delivered by
the Pearl hand piece will remove the outer layer of the epidermis while coagulating a portion of the epidermis. That coagulated portion will gently peel
off over the course of a few days, revealing a new layer of skin underneath. Treatment of the full face can usually be performed in 15 to 30 minutes.
Patients receive on average between one and three treatments at monthly intervals.

Skin  Quality  –  The  Company’s  Titan  technology  allows  the  Company’s  customers  to  use  deep  dermal  heating  to  tighten  lax  skin.  The  practitioner
delivers a spectrum of light to the skin through the Company’s Titan hand piece. This hand piece includes the Company’s proprietary light source and
wavelength filter which tailors the delivered spectrum of light to provide heating at the desired depth in the skin.

In treating compromised skin, the hand piece is placed directly on the skin and then the light pulse is triggered. A sustained pulse causes significant
heating in the dermis. This heating can cause immediate collagen contraction while also stimulating long-term collagen regrowth. Several treatments
may be required to obtain the desired degree of tightening of the skin. The treatment of a full face can take over an hour and there are typically four
weeks between treatments.

The Company’s CE Mark allows the Company to market the Titan in the EU, Australia and certain other countries outside the U.S. for the treatment of
wrinkles through skin tightening. However, in the U.S. the Company has a 510(k) clearance for only deep dermal heating.

Sales and Marketing

The Company markets, sells, and services the Company’s products through direct sales and service employees in North America (including Canada),
Australia, Austria, Belgium, France, Germany, Hong Kong, Japan, Spain, Switzerland and the United Kingdom. International sales and services outside
of  these  direct  markets  are  made  through  a  network  of  distributors  in  over  42  countries,  as  well  as  a  direct  international  sales  force.  The  Company
internally manages its U.S. and Canadian sales organization as one North American sales region.

The  Company  also  sells  certain  items  like  hand  piece  refills,  cycle  refills,  consumable  tips,  and  marketing  brochures  through  the  Company’s  web  site
www.cutera.com.

Customers generally demand quality, performance, ease of use and high productivity in relation to the cost of ownership. The Company responds to
these  customer  demands  by  introducing  new  products  focused  on  these  requirements  in  the  markets  it  serves.  Specifically,  the  Company  believes  it
introduces new products and applications that are innovative, address the specific aesthetic procedures in demand, and are upgradeable on its customers’
existing systems. In addition, the Company provides attractive upgrade pricing to new product families. To increase market penetration, the Company
also markets to non-core practitioners in addition to the Company’s core specialties of plastic surgeons and dermatologists.

The  Company  seeks  to  establish  strong  ongoing  relationships  with  its  customers  through  the  upgradeability  of  the  Company’s  products,  sales  of
extended service contracts, hand piece refills and replacement disposable tips, ongoing training and support, and by distributing skincare products in
Japan. The Company primarily targets its marketing efforts to practitioners through office visits, workshops, trade shows, webinars and trade journals.
The Company also markets to potential patients through brochures, workshops and its website. In addition, the Company offers clinical forums with
recognized expert panelists to promote advanced treatment techniques using the Company’s products to further enhance customer loyalty and uncover
new sales opportunities.

11

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Competition

The  industry  in  which  the  Company  operates  is  subject  to  intense  competition.  The  Company’s  products  compete  against  conventional  non-energy-
based treatments, such as electrolysis, Botox and collagen injections, chemical peels, microdermabrasion and sclerotherapy. The products also compete
against laser and other energy-based products offered by other public companies, such as Abbvie (acquired Allergan, formerly Zeltiq), Sientra, Bausch
Health (formerly Valeant Pharmaceuticals), Vieve, Soliton, InMode and Lutronic, as well as private companies, including Sisram, Candela (formerly
Syneron  Candela,  acquired  in  2017  by  an  affiliate  of  private  equity  funds  advised  by  Apax  Partners),  Sciton,  BTL  Industries  and  several  others.
Additionally, in early 2020, the affiliated private equity funds of Baring Private Equity Asia completed the acquisition of Lumenis, a leading provider
of specialty energy-based medical devices across the fields of aesthetics, urology, ophthalmology, ENT and gynecology, with an international presence.
Also in late 2019, Clayton, Dubilier & Rice entered into an agreement under which its-managed funds acquired Cynosure, LLC, a leader in medical
aesthetics  systems  and  technologies,  from  Hologic,  Inc.  Cynosure  develops,  manufactures,  and  markets  medical  aesthetic  treatment  systems  for
dermatologists, plastic surgeons, medical spas and other healthcare practitioners, with sales and distribution worldwide.

Competition among providers of laser and other energy-based devices for the aesthetic market is characterized by extensive research and development
efforts, and innovative technology. While the Company attempts to protect its products through patents and other intellectual property rights, there are
few barriers to entry that would prevent new entrants or existing competitors from developing products that would compete directly with the Company.
There  are  many  companies,  both  public  and  private,  that  are  developing  innovative  devices  that  use  both  energy-based  and  alternative  technologies.
Some of these competitors have greater resources than the Company does or product applications for certain sub-markets in which the Company does
not  participate.  Additional  competitors  may  enter  the  market,  and  the  Company  is  likely  to  compete  with  new  companies  in  the  future.  To  compete
effectively, the Company has to demonstrate that the Company’s products are attractive alternatives to other devices and treatments by differentiating the
Company’s products on the basis of performance, brand name, service and price. The Company has encountered, and expects to continue to encounter,
potential  customers  who,  due  to  existing  relationships  with  the  Company’s  competitors,  are  committed  to,  or  prefer,  the  products  offered  by  these
competitors. Competitive pressures may result in price reductions and reduced margins for the Company’s products.

The Company also sells skincare products in Japan under the exclusive distribution agreement with ZO which granted the Company the exclusive right
to  promote,  market,  sell,  and  distribute  the  products  produced  by  ZO  in  Japan.  ZO’s  skincare  products  compete  against  other  Physician-dispensed
skincare brands developed and marketed by other companies, such as Environ, Navision and Revision Skincare.

Research and Development

The Company focuses its research and development efforts on innovation and improvement for products and services that align with its mission. The
Company  consistently  strives  to  understand  its  customers’  expectations  for  total  excellence.  The  Company  accomplishes  this  by  its  commitment  to
continuous improvement in design, manufacturing, and service, which the Company believes provides for superior products and services to ensure on
going customer satisfaction, trust and loyalty. The Company seeks to comply with all applicable domestic and international regulations to maintain the
highest quality.

As of December 31, 2020, the Company’s research and development activities were conducted by employees with a broad base of experience in lasers,
optoelectronics,  software,  and  other  related  disciplines.  The  Company  develops  working  relationships  with  outside  contract  engineering  and  design
consultants, giving the Company’s team additional technical and creative breadth. The Company works closely with thought leaders and customers, to
understand unmet needs and emerging applications in aesthetic medicine.

Acquisitions, Investments, and Distribution Agreements

The Company’s strategy of providing a broad range of therapeutic capabilities requires a wide variety of technologies, products, and capabilities. The
rapid pace of technological development in the aesthetic device industry and the specialized expertise required in different areas make it difficult for the
Company to develop a broad portfolio of technological solutions. In addition to internally generated growth through research and development efforts,
the  Company  has  considered,  and  expects  to  continue  to  consider,  acquisitions,  investments,  and  distribution  agreements  to  provide  access  to  new
products and technologies in both new and existing markets.

The  Company  expects  to  further  the  Company’s  strategic  objectives  and  strengthen  its  existing  businesses  by  making  future  acquisitions  and
investments, or by entering into new distribution agreements in areas that the Company believes it can acquire or stimulate the development of new
technologies and products. Mergers and acquisitions of medical technology companies, as well as distribution relationships, are inherently risky and no
assurance can be given that any acquisition will be successful or will not materially adversely affect the Company’s consolidated operations, financial
condition and cash flows.

Manufacturing

The Company manufactures its products with components and subassemblies supplied by vendors and assembles and tests each of its products at the
Brisbane,  California  facility,  and  at  third  party  contract  manufacturers’  facilities.  Quality  control,  cost  reduction  and  inventory  management  are  top
priorities of the manufacturing operations.

The Company purchases certain components, subassemblies, and assembled systems from a limited number of suppliers. The Company has flexibility
with  its  suppliers  to  adjust  the  number  of  components  and  subassemblies  as  well  as  the  delivery  schedules.  The  forecasts  are  based  on  historical
demands and sales projections. Lead times for components and subassemblies may vary significantly depending on the size of the order, time required to
fabricate and test the components or subassemblies, specific supplier requirements and current market demand for the components and subassemblies.
The potential for disruption of supply is reduced by maintaining sufficient inventories and identifying additional suppliers. The time required to qualify
new  suppliers  for  some  components,  or  to  redesign  them,  could  cause  delays  in  the  Company’s  manufacturing.  To  date,  the  Company  has  not
experienced significant delays in obtaining any of its components or subassemblies.

12

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Patents and Proprietary Technology

The  Company  relies  on  a  combination  of  patent,  copyright,  trademark  and  trade  secret  laws,  and  non-disclosure,  confidentiality,  and  invention
assignment agreements to protect the Company’s intellectual property rights. As of January 25, 2021, the Company had 26 issued U.S. patents and 5
pending  U.S.  patent  applications.  The  Company  intends  to  file  for  additional  patents  and  trademarks  to  continue  to  strengthen  the  Company’s
intellectual  property  rights.  Patents  typically  have  a  20-year  term  from  the  application  filing  date.  There  can  be  no  assurance  that  pending  patent
applications  will  result  in  the  issuance  of  patents,  that  patents  issued  to  or  licensed  by  the  Company  will  not  be  challenged  or  circumvented  by
competitors, or that these patents will be found to be valid or sufficiently broad to protect the Company’s technology or to provide the Company with a
competitive advantage.

The  Company  has  also  obtained  certain  trademarks  and  trade  names  for  the  Company’s  products  and  maintain  certain  details  about  the  Company’s
processes, products, and strategies as trade secrets. In the U.S. and several foreign countries, the Company registers its Company name and several of its
product names as trademarks, including Cutera, AcuTip, CoolGlide, CoolGlide excel, excel, enlighten, Juliet, LimeLight, myQ, Pearl, ProWave 770,
ProWave LX , SecretRF, Secret PRO, Titan, truSculpt and xeo. The Company may have common law rights in other product names, including excel V,
Pearl Fractional, Solera, Titan and excel HR. The Company intends to file for additional trademarks to continue to strengthen the Company’s intellectual
property rights.

The Company relies on non-disclosure and non-competition agreements with employees, technical consultants, and other parties to protect, in part, trade
secrets and other proprietary technology. The Company also requires them to agree to disclose and assign to the Company all inventions conceived in
connection with the relationship. There can be no assurance that these agreements will not be breached, that the Company will have adequate remedies
for any breach, that others will not independently develop equivalent proprietary information or that third parties will not otherwise gain access to the
Company’s trade secrets and proprietary knowledge.

For  additional  information,  please  refer  to  Item  1A.  Risk  Factors  of  this  Annual  Report  on  Form  10-K,  under  the  section  entitled  “Risk  Factors  -
Intellectual property rights may not provide adequate protection for some or all of the Company’s products, which may permit third parties to compete
against  the  Company  more  effectively,  and  the  Company  may  be  involved  in  future  costly  intellectual  property  litigation,  which  could  impact  the
Company’s future business and financial performance.”

Government Regulation

United States

The  Company’s  products  are  medical  devices  subject  to  regulation  by  numerous  government  agencies,  including  the  FDA  and  counterpart  agencies
outside  the  U.S.  To  varying  degrees,  each  of  these  agencies  require  the  Company  to  comply  with  laws  and  regulations  governing  the  research,
development,  testing,  manufacturing,  labeling,  pre-market  clearance  or  approval,  marketing,  distribution,  advertising,  promotion,  record  keeping,
reporting,  tracking,  and  importing  and  exporting  of  medical  devices.  In  the  U.S.,  FDA  regulations  govern  the  following  activities  that  the  Company
performs and will continue to perform to ensure that medical products distributed domestically or exported internationally are safe and effective for their
intended uses:

  ●product design and development;
  ●product testing;
  ●product manufacturing;
  ●product safety;
  ●product labeling;
  ●product storage;
  ●record keeping;
  ●pre-market clearance or approval;
  ●advertising and promotion;
  ●production;
  ●product sales and distribution; and
  ●complaint handling.

FDA’s Pre-market Clearance Requirements

Unless an exemption applies, each medical device the Company wishes to commercially distribute in the U.S. will require either prior 510(k) clearance,
or de novo approval from the FDA. The FDA classifies medical devices into one of three classes. Devices deemed to pose lower risks are placed in
either Class I or II. For Class II, the manufacturer must submit to the FDA a pre-market notification requesting permission to commercially distribute
the device. This process is known as 510(k) clearance. Some low risk devices are exempted from this requirement. Devices deemed by the FDA to pose
the greatest risk, such as life-sustaining, life-supporting or implantable devices, or devices deemed not substantially equivalent to a previously cleared
510(k) device, are placed in Class III, requiring more rigorous pre-market approval. All of the Company’s current products are Class II devices.

510(k) Clearance Pathway

When  510(k)  clearance  is  required,  the  Company  must  submit  a  pre-market  notification  demonstrating  that  the  Company’s  proposed  device  is
substantially equivalent to a previously cleared 510(k) device or a device that was in commercial distribution before May 28, 1976 for which the FDA
has not yet called for the submission of Pre-Market Approval, or "PMA", applications. By regulation, the FDA is required to clear or deny 510(k), pre-
market notification within 90 days of submission of the application. As a practical matter, clearance may take significantly longer, as FDA may require
additional  information.  Laser  devices  used  for  aesthetic  procedures,  such  as  hair  removal,  have  generally  qualified  for  clearance  under  510(k)
procedures.

13

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

The following table details the indications for which the Company received a 510(k) clearance for the Company’s products and when these clearances
were received.

FDA Marketing Clearances:
Laser-based products:
- treatment of vascular lesions
- hair removal
- permanent hair reduction
- treatment of benign pigmented lesions and pseudo folliculitis barbae, commonly referred to
as razor bumps, and for the reduction of red pigmentation in scars
- treatment of wrinkles

- treatment to increase clear nail in patients with onychomycosis
- expanded spot size to 5 mm for clear nail in patients with onychomycosis
- addition of Alexandrite 755 nm laser wavelength for hair removal, permanent hair reduction,
treatment of vascular, benign pigmented lesions and treatment of wrinkles

- addition of treatment of mild to moderate inflammatory acne vulgaris
- enlighten picosecond and nanosecond 532/1064 nm for the treatment of benign pigmented
lesions
- enlighten picosecond and nanosecond 532/1064 nm for multi-colored tattoo removal
- enlighten III picosecond and nanosecond 532/1064 nm for multi-colored tattoo removal and
treatment of benign pigmented lesion and picosecond 670 nm for benign pigmented lesions
- enlighten III higher performance specifications for 532/1064 nm; addition of nanosecond
mode for 670nm
- enlighten III addition of tattoo removal for lighter colored inks (green and blue) for 670 nm  
- enlighten Micro Lens Array (MLA) for treatment of acne scars

Pulsed-light technologies:

- treatment of pigmented lesions
- hair removal and vascular treatments

Infrared Titan technology for deep dermal heating for the temporary relief of minor muscle and

joint pain and for the temporary increase in local circulation where applied

Solera tabletop console:

- for use with the Titan hand piece
- for use with the Company’s pulsed-light hand pieces

Pearl product for the treatment of wrinkles

Pearl Fractional product for skin resurfacing and coagulation

truSculpt radio frequency product:

- for topical heating to elevate tissue temperature for the treatment of selected medical
conditions such as relief of pain and muscle spasms and increase in local circulation; massage
device for temporary reduction in the appearance of cellulite
- Temporary reduction in circumference of the abdomen
- truSculpt iD: Hands-free treatment powering sequentially six 40 cm2 puck-style applicators
- truSculpt iD: For non-invasive lipolysis of the abdomen and for reduction in circumference
of the abdomen
- truSculpt flex: for improvement of abdominal tone, strengthening of abdominal muscles, and
development of firmer abdomen; and strengthening, toning, and firming of buttocks and
thighs

14

Date Received:

June 1999
March 2000
January 2001
June 2002

October 2002
April 2011
May 2013
December 2013

March 2016
August 2014

November 2014
October 2016

April 2016

October 2017
December 2018

March 2003
March 2005

February 2004

October 2004
January 2005

March 2007

August 2008

April 2008

December 2016
August 2017
June 2018

June 2019

 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Product Modifications

Pursuant to FDA regulations, after a device receives 510(k) clearance, any modification that could significantly affect its safety or effectiveness, or that
would constitute a major change in its intended use, labeling and biocompatibility, requires a new clearance. The FDA requires manufacturers to make
this determination initially, but the FDA can review any such decision and may disagree with a manufacturer’s determination. To date, the Company has
modified aspects of the Company’s products after receiving regulatory clearance and determined that new 510(k) clearances are not required for these
modifications.  If  the  FDA  disagrees  with  the  Company’s  determination  not  to  seek  a  new  510(k)  clearance,  the  FDA  may  retroactively  require  the
Company to seek 510(k) clearance.

Clinical Trials

When  FDA  approval  of  a  Class  II  device  requires  human  clinical  trials,  only  approval  from  the  Institutional  Review  Board  (“IRB”),  is  required  to
proceed with the planned and IRB approved clinical trial/study.

The  Company  is  required  to  manufacture  the  Company’s  products  in  compliance  with  the  FDA’s  Quality  System  Regulation  (“QSR”)  and  the
international quality management standard for medical systems ISO 13485:2016. The QSR and ISO 13485 cover the methods and documentation of the
design,  testing,  control,  manufacturing,  labeling,  quality  assurance,  packaging,  storage  and  shipping  of  the  Company’s  products.  Since  2017,  the
Company  has  been  enrolled  in  the  Medical  Device  Single  Audit  Program  (“MDSAP”).  The  MDSAP  allows  a  single  audit  of  a  medical  device
manufacturer’s  Quality  Management  System  (“QMS”),  which  satisfies  the  requirements  of  5  regulatory  jurisdictions  (FDA  -  US,  Health  Canada  -
Canada,  Therapeutic  Goods  Administration  (“TGA”)  -  Australia,  Pharmaceuticals  and  Medical  Devices  Agency  (“PMDA”)  -  Japan,  and  Agência
Nacional de Vigilancia Sanitária (“ANVISA”) - Brazil); and for the EU under Europäische Norm (“EN”) International Standards Organization (“ISO”)
13485:2016 and Medical Device Directive (MDD)/EU Medical Device Regulation MDR”).

MDSAP re-certification occurs every three years with a surveillance audit taking place annually. Major findings during these audits or an increase in
field reportable events could trigger regulatory enforcement action including by the FDA. The Company’s manufacturing facility is ISO 13485 certified.
The  Company  had  a  successful  MDSAP  re-certification  audit  in  January  2021.  There  were  no  significant  findings  or  observations  as  a  result  of  this
audit; however, the Company’s failure to maintain compliance with the QSR requirements could result in the shutdown of the Company’s manufacturing
operations and the recall of the Company’s products, which would have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business. In the event that one of the
Company’s  suppliers  fails  to  maintain  compliance  with  specified  quality  requirements,  the  Company  may  have  to  qualify  a  new  supplier  and  could
experience manufacturing delays as a result. The Company has opted to maintain quality assurance and quality management certifications to enable the
Company to market the Company’s products in the U.S., the member states of the EU, the European Free Trade Association and countries which have
entered into Mutual Recognition Agreements with the EU.

Pervasive and Continuing Regulation

After a device is placed on the market, numerous regulatory requirements apply. These include:

●   Quality  system  regulations,  which  require  manufacturers,  including  third-party  manufacturers,  to  follow  stringent  design,  testing,  control,
documentation and other quality assurance procedures during all aspects of the manufacturing process;
● Labeling regulations and FDA prohibitions against the promotion of products for un-cleared, unapproved or “off-label” uses;
● Medical device reporting regulations, which require that manufacturers report to the FDA if their device may have caused or contributed to a death or
serious injury or malfunctioned in a way that would likely cause or contribute to a death or serious injury if the malfunction were to recur; and
● Post-market surveillance regulations, which apply when necessary to protect the public health or to provide additional safety and effectiveness data
for the device.

The FDA has broad post-market and regulatory enforcement powers. The Company is subject to unannounced inspections by the FDA and the Food and
Drug Branch of the California Department of Health Services (or “CDHS”), to determine the Company’s compliance with the QSR and other applicable
regulations, which may include the manufacturing facilities of the Company’s subcontractors. In the past, the Company’s current manufacturing facility
has been inspected by the FDA and the CDHS. The FDA and the CDHS noted observations, but there were no findings that involved a material violation
of regulatory requirements. The Company’s responses to those observations have been accepted by the FDA and CDHS.

The  Company  is  also  regulated  under  the  Radiation  Control  for  Health  and  Safety  Act,  which  requires  laser  products  to  comply  with  performance
standards, including design and operation requirements, and manufacturers to certify in product labeling and in reports to the FDA that their products
comply with all such standards. The regulations also require laser manufacturers to file new product and annual reports, maintain manufacturing, testing
and sales records, and report product defects. Various warning labels must be affixed and certain protective devices installed, depending on the class of
the product.

Failure  to  comply  with  applicable  regulatory  requirements  can  result  in  enforcement  action  by  the  FDA,  which  may  include  any  of  the  following
sanctions:

  ●Warning letters, fines, injunctions, consent decrees and civil penalties;
  ●Repair, replacement, recall or seizure of the Company’s products;
  ●Operating restrictions or partial suspension or total shutdown of production;
  ●Refusing the Company’s requests for 510(k) clearance of new products, new intended uses, or modifications to existing products;
  ●Withdrawing 510(k) clearance that have already been granted; and
  ●Criminal prosecution and penalties.

The  FDA  also  has  the  authority  to  require  the  Company  to  repair,  replace  or  refund  the  cost  of  any  medical  device  that  it  has  manufactured  or
distributed. If any of these events were to occur, they could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business.

The Company is also subject to a wide range of federal, state and local laws and regulations, including those related to the environment, health and
safety,  land  use  and  quality  assurance.  The  Company  believes  that  compliance  with  these  laws  and  regulations  as  currently  in  effect  will  not  have  a
material adverse effect on the Company’s capital expenditures, earnings and competitive and financial position.

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
15

Table of Contents

International

International  sales  of  medical  devices  are  subject  to  foreign  governmental  regulations,  which  vary  substantially  from  country  to  country.  The  time
required  to  obtain  clearance  or  approval  by  a  foreign  country  may  be  different  than  that  required  for  FDA  clearance.  And  the  clearance  or  approval
requirements may be different from those in the U.S.

In Japan, the Company is actively seeking approvals for products to supplement the Company’s existing approvals for enlighten, excel V, excel  HR  ,
LimeLight, ProWave, Solera, Titan, truSculpt iD and xeo.

In  the  European  Economic  Area  (“EEA”),  which  is  composed  of  the  28  Member  States  of  the  EU  plus  Norway,  Liechtenstein  and  Iceland,  a  single
regulatory approval process exists, and conformity with the legal requirements is represented by the CE mark. While it remains somewhat unresolved,
the cabinet of the United Kingdom agrees that the UK should maintain conformity with the CE mark process following Brexit. Other countries, such as
Switzerland, have entered into Mutual Recognition Agreements and allow the marketing of medical devices that meet EU requirements. The EU has
adopted  numerous  directives  and  European  Standardization  Committees  have  promulgated  voluntary  standards  regulating  the  design,  manufacture,
clinical trials, labeling and adverse event reporting for medical devices. Devices that comply with the requirements of a relevant directive will be entitled
to bear CE conformity marking, indicating that the device conforms to the essential requirements of the applicable directives and, accordingly, can be
commercially  distributed  throughout  the  EEA  and  countries  which  have  entered  into  a  Mutual  Recognition  Agreement.  The  method  of  assessing
conformity varies depending on the type and class of the product, but normally involves a combination of self-assessment by the manufacturer and a
third-party assessment by a Notified Body, an independent and neutral institution appointed by a country to conduct the conformity assessment. This
third-party assessment may consist of an audit of the manufacturer’s quality system and specific testing of the manufacturer’s device. An assessment by
a Notified Body in one member state of the EEA, or one country which has entered into a Mutual Recognition Agreement is required in order for a
manufacturer  to  commercially  distribute  the  product  throughout  these  countries.  ISO  9001  and  ISO  13845  certification  are  voluntary  harmonized
standards. Compliance establishes the presumption of conformity with the essential requirements for a CE Marking. In February 2000, the Company’s
facility was awarded the ISO 9001 and EN 46001 certification.

In March 2003, the Company received the Company’s ISO 9001 updated certification (ISO 9001:2000) as well as the Company’s certification for ISO
13485:1996 which replaced the Company’s EN 46001 certification. In March 2004, the Company received the Company’s ISO 13485:2003 certification
and  in  March  2006,  March  2009,  and  January  2012  the  Company  passed  ISO  13485  recertification  audits.  In  January  2015,  the  Company  passed  a
recertification  audit  establishing  compliance  with  the  requirements  of  EN  ISO  13485:2012,  CAN/CSA  ISO  13485:2003,  and  MDD  93/42/EEC.  In
January  2018,  the  Company  conducted  the  Company’s  recertification  audit  to  the  requirements  of  ISO  13485:2003  under  the  MDSAP  for  the  five
regulatory jurisdictions signatory to MDSAP (FDA - US, Health Canada - Canada, TGA - Australia, PMDA - Japan, and ANVISA - Brazil); and for the
EU  under  EN  ISO  13485:2016  and  MDD  93/42/EEC.  In  January  2021,  the  Company  passed  the  recertification  audit  re-confirming  compliance  with
ISO13485:2016 and MDSAP. The MDSAP and EU certification can be used to demonstrate compliance with GMP/QSR/QMS requirements for all five
regulatory jurisdictions, replacing routine audits from each regulatory jurisdiction. For cause audits can still occur.

Applicability of Anti-Corruption Laws and Regulations

The Company’s worldwide business is subject to the U.S. Foreign Corrupt Practices Act of 1977 (the “FCPA”), the United Kingdom Bribery Act of
2010 (the “UK Bribery Act”) and other anti-corruption laws and regulations applicable in the jurisdictions where the Company operates. The FCPA can
be used to prosecute companies in the U.S. for arrangements with physicians, or other parties outside the U.S., if the physician or party is a government
official of another country and the arrangement violates the law of that country. The UK Bribery Act prohibits both domestic and international bribery,
as  well  as  bribery  across  both  public  and  private  sectors.  There  are  similar  laws  and  regulations  applicable  to  the  Company  outside  the  U.S.,  all  of
which are subject to evolving interpretations. For additional information, please refer to Item 1A. Risk Factors of this Annual Report on Form 10-K,
under the sections entitled “Risk Factors – the Company’s failure to comply with rules relating to bribery, foreign corrupt practices and privacy and
security laws may subject the Company to penalties and adversely impact the Company’s reputation and business operations.”

Patient Privacy and Security Laws

Various  laws  worldwide  protect  the  confidentiality  of  certain  patient  health  and  other  consumer  information,  including  patient  medical  records,  and
restrict the use and disclosure of patient health information by healthcare providers. Privacy standards in Europe and Asia are becoming increasingly
strict,  enforcement  action  and  financial  penalties  related  to  privacy  in  the  EU  are  growing,  and  new  laws  and  restrictions  are  being  passed.  The
management of cross-border transfers of information among and outside of EU member countries is becoming more complex, which may complicate the
Company’s clinical research and commercial activities, as well as product offerings that involve transmission or use of data. The Company will continue
its efforts to comply with those requirements and to adapt the Company’s business processes to those standards.

In the U.S., the Health Insurance Portability and Accountability Act of 1996 (“HIPAA”), as amended by the Health Information Technology and Clinical
Health  Act  (“HITECH”)  and  their  respective  implementing  regulations,  including  the  final  omnibus  rule  published  on  January  25,  2013,  imposes
specified requirements relating to the privacy, security and transmission of individually identifiable health information. Among other things, HITECH
makes  HIPAA’s  privacy  and  security  standards  directly  applicable  to  “business  associates,”  defined  as  independent  contractors  or  agents  of  covered
entities that create, receive, maintain or transmit protected health information in connection with providing a service for or on behalf of a covered entity.
HITECH also increased the civil and criminal penalties that may be imposed against covered entities, business associates and possibly other persons,
and gave state attorneys new general authority to file civil actions for damages or injunctions in federal court to enforce the federal HIPAA laws and
seek attorney’s fees and costs associated with pursuing federal civil actions. In addition, state laws govern the privacy and security of health information
in  certain  circumstances,  many  of  which  differ  from  each  other  in  significant  ways,  thus  complicating  compliance  efforts.  The  Company  potentially
operates as a business associate to covered entities in a limited number of instances. In those cases, the patient data that the Company receives may
include protected health information, as defined under HIPAA. Enforcement actions can be costly and interrupt regular operations of its business. While
the Company has not been named in any such actions, if a substantial breach or loss of data from the Company’s records were to occur, the Company
could become a target of such litigation.

16

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

In the EU, Regulation 2016/679 on the protection of natural persons with regard to the processing of personal data and on the free movement of such
data (“General Data Protection Regulation” or “GDPR”) came into effect on May 25, 2018. The GDPR replaces Directive 95/46/EC (“Data Protection
Directive”). While many of the principles of the GDPR reflect those of the Data Protection Directive, for example in relation to the requirements relating
to  the  privacy,  security  and  transmission  of  individually  identifiable  health  information,  there  are  a  number  of  changes.  In  particular:  (1)  pro-active
compliance measures are introduced, such as the requirement to carry out a Privacy Impact Assessment and to appoint a Data Protection Officer where
health data is processed on a “large scale;” and (2) the administrative fines that can be levied are significantly increased, the maximum being the higher
of  €20  million,  or  4%,  of  the  total  worldwide  annual  turnover  of  the  group  in  the  previous  financial  year.  The  Company  will  continue  its  efforts  to
comply with the GDPR requirements and to adapt the Company’s business processes to those requirements.

Environmental Health and Safety Laws

The  Company  is  also  subject  to  various  environmental  health  and  safety  laws  and  regulations  worldwide.  Like  other  medical  device  companies,  the
Company’s manufacturing and other operations involve the use and transportation of substances regulated under environmental health and safety laws
including those related to the transportation of hazardous materials. To the best of the Company’s knowledge at this time, the Company does not expect
that compliance with environmental protection laws will have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated results of operations, financial position
or cash flows.

Employees and Human Capital

As  of  December  31,  2020,  the  Company  had  323  employees,  compared  to  447  employees  as  of  December  31,  2019.  The  Company  believes  that  its
future success will depend in part on the Company’s continued ability to attract, hire and retain qualified personnel. None of the Company’s employees
are  represented  by  a  labor  union,  and  the  Company  believes  its  employee  relations  are  good. The  Company  is  committed  to  fostering  a  diverse  and
inclusive  workplace  that  attracts  and  retains  exceptional  talent.  Through  ongoing  employee  development,  comprehensive  compensation  and  benefits,
and a focus on health, safety and employee wellbeing, the Company strives to help its employees in all aspects of their lives so they can do their best
work.

Diversity, Equity and Inclusion

The Company is committed to create and maintain a diverse and safe work environment to capture the ideas and perspectives that fuel innovation and
enable its workforce, customers, and communities to succeed in creating the future of medical aesthetics. The Company strives to create an inclusive
workplace  where  people  can  design,  manufacture,  and  market  a  comprehensive  portfolio  of  aesthetic  laser  and  energy-based  products  that  enable  its
customers  (the  practitioner)  to  provide  safe  and  effective  treatments.  Its  commitment  to  diversity  and  inclusion  starts  at  the  highest  levels  of  the
Company. 

Employee Engagement

The Company regularly collects feedback to better understand and improve the employee experience and identify opportunities to continually strengthen
its culture. The Company wants to know what is working well, what the Company can do better and how well its associates understand and practicing its
cultural values. In 2020, nearly 86% of its employees participated in its annual employee survey.

Leadership development and training

At Cutera, the Company believes that the best leaders are the ones who come from within. These leaders learn with Cutera, grow with Cutera and reach
their potential through challenging job experiences. The Company provides deliberate learning opportunities by offering valuable training resources for
employees  in  order  to  ensure  its  people  have  everything  they  need  to  succeed  both  personally  and  professionally.  The  Company’s  employees  are
encouraged to take responsibility for their own development and create learning plans that best fit their needs and development goals.

Health, Safety and Wellness

The  physical  health,  financial  wellbeing,  life  balance  and  mental  health  of  its  employees  is  vital  to  its  success.  The  Company  sponsors  wellness
initiatives designed to enhance physical, financial, and mental wellbeing for all employees. The Company has successfully implemented a number of
safety and social distancing measures within its premises to protect the health and safety of associates who are required to be on-premise to support its
business.

Available Information

The Company makes its periodic and current reports, including the Company's Annual Reports on Form 10-K, Quarterly Reports on Form 10-Q, Current
Reports on Form 8-K and any amendments to those reports, filed or furnished pursuant to Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934,
as  well  as  its  charters  for  the  Company's  Audit  and  Compensation  Committees  and  its  Code  of  Ethics,  available  free  of  charge,  on  the  Company’s
website as soon as practicable after such material is electronically filed or furnished with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”). The
Company’s website address is www.cutera.comand the reports are filed under “SEC Filings,” under “Financials” on the Investor Relations portion of the
Company’s website. These reports and other information concerning the Company may be accessed through the SEC’s website at www.sec.gov.

ITEM 1A.          RISK FACTORS

The  Company  operates  in  a  rapidly  changing  economic  and  technological  environment  that  presents  numerous  risks,  many  of  which  are  driven  by
factors that the Company cannot control or predict. The Company’s business, financial condition and results of operations may be impacted by a number
of  factors.  In  addition  to  the  factors  discussed  elsewhere  in  this  report,  the  following  risks  and  uncertainties  could  materially  harm  the  Company’s
business, financial condition or results of operations, including causing the Company’s actual results to differ materially from those projected in any
forward-looking statements. The following list of significant risk factors is not all-inclusive or necessarily in order of importance. Additional risks and
uncertainties not presently known to the Company, or that the Company currently deems immaterial, also may materially adversely affect the Company
in future periods. You should carefully consider these risks and uncertainties before investing in the Company’s securities.

17

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents
Summary of Risk Factors

The Company’s business, financial condition, operating results and cash flows are subject to numerous risks and uncertainties that are summarized below.
The below summary of risk factors should be read together with the more detailed discussion of risks set forth following this section under the heading
“Risk Factors,” as well as elsewhere in this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

Risks Related to the Company’s Business and its Industry

■ The Company’s business, financial condition, liquidity, capital, and results of operations have been, and may continue to be, adversely

affected by the COVID-19 pandemic.

■ The increase in sales of skincare products in Japan may be temporarily caused by the change in its customer’s spending habit due to the

COVID-19 pandemic.

■ Any defects in the design, material or workmanship of its products, defective design, material or workmanship or misuse of its products

will cause additional costs, including product recalls and product liability suits, and harm the Company’s reputation.

■ Failure in hiring, training and retaining Sales professional and skilled and experienced personnel, or changes to management will cause

adversely affects the Company’s operation and operation results.

■ The aesthetic equipment market is characterized by rapid innovation, product innovation and high competition.
■ The Company competes against companies that offer alternative solutions to its products, have greater resources, or have a larger installed

base of customers and broader product offerings than the Company’s.

■ The Company’s business is subject to regulatory requirements, laser performance standards, federal regulatory reforms, FDA and other
government agencies’ regulation and oversight which may negatively affect its business, financial condition and results of operations if
the Company fails to comply with them.

■ The Company's products may cause or contribute to adverse medical events or be subject to failures or malfunctions that would be subject

to sanctions that could harm its reputation, business, financial condition and results of operations.

■ The Company may be unable to obtain or maintain international regulatory qualifications or approvals for its current or future products

and indications, which could harm its business.

■ Failure in International expansion and economic and other risks associated with international sales and operations could adversely affect

the Company’s business.

■ Some of the Company’s manufacturing operations are dependent upon third-party suppliers, making its vulnerable to supply shortages

and price fluctuations, which could harm its business.

■ Reduction or interruption in supply and an inability to develop alternative sources for supply may adversely affect the Company’s

manufacturing operations and related product sales.

■ If customers are not trained and/or the Company’s products are used by non-licensed practitioners, it could result in product misuse and
adverse treatment outcomes, which could harm the Company’s reputation, result in product liability litigation, distract management and
result in additional costs, all of which could harm the Company’s business.

■ The Company’s products are subject to clinical trial process which is lengthy and expensive with uncertain outcomes. Delays or failures

in the Company's clinical trials will prevent it from commercializing any modified or new products.

■ Intellectual property rights may not provide adequate protection for some or all the Company’s products, or the Company may be

involved in future costly intellectual property litigation.

■ The expense and potential unavailability of insurance coverage for the Company’s customers could adversely affect its ability to sell its

products, and therefore adversely affect its financial condition.

■ Any acquisitions that the Company makes could result in operating difficulties, dilution, and other consequences that may adversely

impact the Company’s business and results of operations.

■ Inability to access credit on favorable terms for the funding of the Company’s operations and capital projects may be limited due to

changes in credit markets.

■ Security breaches, cyber-security incidents and other disruptions could compromise the Company’s information and impact the

Company’s business, financial condition or results of operations.

■ Macroeconomic political and market conditions, and catastrophic events may adversely affect the Company’s business, results of

operations, financial condition and the trading price of the notes and the stock.

■ The Company has a relatively limited number of shares of common stock outstanding, which could result in the increase in volatility of

its stock price and the trading price of the notes.

■ Disaster or other similar event could cause damage to its facilities and equipment, which might require the Company to cease or curtail

sales of these sole sourced platforms.

■ Income tax audits or similar proceedings or changes in accounting standards may have a material adverse effect on the Company’s results

of operations and financial position.

18

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Risks Related to the Notes

■ Although the notes are referred to as convertible senior notes, they are effectively subordinated to any of the Company's secured debt and

any liabilities of its subsidiaries.

■ Regulatory actions and other events may adversely affect the trading price and liquidity of the notes.
■ Volatility in the market price and trading volume of the Company's common stock could adversely impact the trading price of the notes.
■ The Company may still incur substantially more debt or take other actions which would intensify the risks discussed above.
■ The Company may not have the ability to raise the funds necessary to settle conversions of the notes in cash or to repurchase the notes
upon a fundamental change, and its future debt may contain limitations on its ability to pay cash upon conversion or repurchase of the
notes.

■ The conditional conversion feature of the notes, if triggered, may adversely affect the Company's financial condition and operating

results.

■ The accounting method for the notes could adversely affect the Company's financial condition and operating results.
■ Holders of notes will not be entitled to any rights with respect to the Company's common stock, but they will be subject to all changes

made with respect to the Company's common stock to the extent the Company satisfies its conversion obligation, in whole or in part, with
shares of its common stock.

■ The conditional conversion feature of the notes could result in holders receiving less than the value of the Company's common stock into

which the notes would otherwise be convertible.

■ Upon conversion of the notes, holders may receive less valuable consideration than expected because the value of the

Company's common stock may decline after holders exercise their conversion right but before the Company satisfies it conversion
obligation.

■ The notes are not protected by restrictive covenants.
■ The increase in the conversion rate for notes converted in connection with a make-whole fundamental change or during a redemption

period may not adequately compensate holders for any lost value of their notes as a result of such transaction or redemption.

■ The conversion rate of the notes may not be adjusted for all dilutive events.
■ Provisions in the indenture governing the notes may deter or prevent a business combination that may be favorable to the holders. 
■ The capped call transactions may affect the value of the notes and the Company's common stock.
■ The Company is subject to counterparty risk with respect to the capped call transactions.
■ Some significant restructuring transactions may not constitute a fundamental change, in which case the Company would not be obligated

to offer to repurchase the notes.

■ The Company has not registered the notes or the common stock issuable upon conversion, if any, which will limit the ability of holders to

resell them.

■ The Company cannot assure the holders of the notes that an active trading market will develop for the notes.
■ Any adverse rating of the notes may cause their trading price to fall.
■ The holders of the notes may be subject to tax if the Company makes or fails to make certain adjustments to the conversion rate of the

notes even though the holders do not receive a corresponding cash distribution.

■ The Company may redeem the notes at its option, which may adversely affect the holders' return.
■ The notes will initially be held in book-entry form and, therefore, holders must rely on the procedures and the relevant clearing systems to

exercise their rights and remedies.

Risks Related to Ownership of the Company's Common Stock

■ Anti-takeover provisions contained in the Company's amended and restated certificate of incorporation and amended and restated bylaws,

as well as provisions of Delaware law, could impair a takeover attempt.

■ The Company's business could be negatively affected by activist shareholders.
■ If securities or industry analysts do not publish or cease publishing research or reports about the Company, its business, its market or

its competitors, or if they adversely change their recommendations regarding the Company's common stock, the market price and trading
volume of its notes and common stock could decline.

■ The Company does not expect to declare any dividends on its common stock in the foreseeable future.
■ If the Company raises additional capital through the sale of shares of the Company’s common stock, convertible securities or debt in the
future, its stockholders’ ownership in the Company could be diluted and restrictions could be imposed on the Company’s business.

19

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Risks Related to the Company’s Business and its Industry

The effects of the COVID-19 pandemic have affected how the Company and its customers are operating its businesses, and the duration and extent to
which this will impact its future results of operations and overall financial performance remains uncertain.

The COVID-19 pandemic and related public health measures have affected how the Company and its customers are operating their businesses and have
materially  and  adversely  affected  the  Company’s  business  and  the  Company’s  financial  results.  To  date,  the  impact  includes:  a)  the  deferral  of
procedures  using  its  products,  b)  disruptions  or  restrictions  on  the  ability  of  many  of  the  Company’s  employees  and  of  third  parties  on  which  the
Company relies, to work effectively, including “stay-at-home” orders and similar government actions; and c) temporary closures of its facilities and of
the  facilities  of  the  Company’s  customers  and  suppliers.  If  the  pandemic  has  a  substantial  impact  on  its  employees’  or  customers’  businesses  and
productivity,  the  Company’s  results  of  operations  and  overall  financial  performance  may  be  materially  and  adversely  affected.  The  global
macroeconomic effects of the pandemic may persist for an indefinite period, even after the pandemic has subsided.

As jurisdictions throughout the world continue to respond to the pandemic, the degree of the foregoing impacts may increase in scope or magnitude
or the Company may experience additional adverse effects in one or more regions. Any other outbreaks of contagious diseases or other adverse public
health developments in countries where the Company operates or where its customers or suppliers are located could also have a material and adverse
effect on its business, financial condition and results of operations.

Due  to  the  COVID-19  pandemic,  customers  and  their  patients  have  been,  and  in  certain  regions  continue  to  be,  required,  or  are  choosing,  to  defer
elective  procedures  in  which  the  Company's  products  otherwise  could  be  used,  and  many  facilities  that  specialize  in  the  procedures  in  which  the
Company's products otherwise could be used have temporarily closed and in some cases continue to be temporarily closed or operating at reduced hours.
In addition, even after the pandemic subsides or governmental orders no longer prohibit or recommend against performing such procedures, patients
may continue to defer such procedures due to personal concerns. Further, facilities at which its products typically are used may not reopen or, even if
they reopen, patients may elect to have procedures performed at facilities that are, or are perceived to be, lower-risk, such as private surgery centers,
and the Company's products may not be approved at such facilities, and the Company may be unable to have the Company's products approved for use
at  such  facilities  on  a  timely  basis,  or  at  all.  The  effect  of  the  pandemic  on  the  broader  economy  could  also  negatively  affect  demand  for  elective
procedures using its products, both in the near- and long-term. Workforce limitations and travel restrictions resulting from government actions taken to
contain  the  spread  of  COVID-19  have  and  will  continue  to  adversely  affect  almost  every  aspect  of  its  business.  If  a  significant  percentage  of  the
Company's  workforce,  or  of  the  workforce  of  third  parties  on  which  the  Company  relies,  cannot  work,  including  because  of  illness  or  travel  or
government restrictions, its operations will be negatively affected. Because of government restrictions and social distancing guidelines in many countries
around the world, there is an increased reliance on working from home for the Company's workforce and on the workforce of third parties on which the
Company  rely.  For  example,  most  of  the  Company's  sales  personnel  and  third-party  agents  currently  are  working  largely  using  virtual  and  online
engagement tools and tactics, which may be less effective than its typical in-person sales and marketing programs. In addition, the Company reduced
access to its hands-on customer trainings, which, in turn, adversely impacted the Company's ability to educate and train customers on the proper use
of  the  Company's  products,  which  may  make  surgeons  less  comfortable  using,  and  therefore  less  likely  to  use,  the  Company's  products.  The
Company expects that “stay-at-home” orders will also limit its ability to develop, and therefore launch, the products the Company believes will drive the
Company’s future revenue growth on the timelines the Company anticipated previously, or at all, and could also delay the planned launch of products in
2021 and beyond. It may also cause the Company not to submit required filings on its previous timelines, including with the FDA, or other regulatory
bodies, both in the U.S. and outside the U.S. The continued spread of COVID-19 has adversely impacted the Company's clinical trial operations in the
United  States.  In  addition,  changes  impacting  workforce  function  at  the  FDA  and  other  regulatory  bodies,  as  well  as  changes  impacting  workforce
function  at  the  facilities  at  which  the  Company  seeks  to  have  new  products  approved  for  use,  could  adversely  impact  the  timing  of  when  the
Company's new products are cleared for marketing and approved for use, either of which would adversely impact the timing of its ability to sell these
new products and would have a material and adverse effect on the Company's revenue growth.

As a result of the COVID-19 outbreak, some of the Company’s customers are being required to shelter-in-place and are not working. In cases where the
Company’s  customers  are  working,  they  are  performing  fewer  procedures.  When  they  are  performing  procedures,  customers  are  mostly  focused  on
medically necessary procedures that should not be delayed. Non-urgent, non-essential procedures are getting cancelled or delayed. As a result of fewer
aesthetic procedures being performed and anxiety about the economic future, the Company’s customers may cancel orders for laser systems or will use
less consumables. Some of the Company’s customers will feel less confident about making investments in their practices and focus on retaining their
cash. As a result of cash conservation efforts by the Company’s customers, the Company may also encounter problems collecting on its receivables,
which will impact the Company’s cash position and could result in negative cash flows.

Further,  disruptions  in  the  manufacture  and  distribution  of  the  Company's  products  or  in  its  supply  chain  may  occur  as  a  result  of  the  COVID-19
pandemic, including for the reasons above, or other events that result in staffing shortages, production slowdowns, stoppages, or disruptions in delivery
systems,  any  of  which  could  materially  and  adversely  affect  the  Company's  ability  to  manufacture  or  distribute  its  products,  or  to  obtain  the  raw
materials and supplies necessary to manufacture and distribute the Company’s products, in a timely manner, or at all.

The  Company  may  also  experience  other  unknown  adverse  impacts  from  COVID-19  that  cannot  be  predicted.  For  example,  customers  and  other
facilities  at  which  the  Company  sells  its  products  may  renegotiate  their  purchase  prices,  including  as  a  result  of,  or  the  perception  that  they  may  be
suffering, financial difficulty as a result of the pandemic. Similarly, facilities at which the Company seeks to sell its products in the future may require
price reductions relative to the price at which the Company previously expected to sell its products. Reduction in the prices at which the Company sells
products  to  existing  customers  may  have  a  material  and  adverse  effect  on  its  future  financial  results  and  reductions  in  the  prices  at  which  the
Company expected to sell products would have a material and adverse effect on its expectations for revenue growth.

Further, the global capital markets experienced, and the Company expects will continue to experience, disruption and volatility due to the COVID-19
pandemic, adversely impacting access to capital not only for the Company, but also for its customers and suppliers who need access to capital. Their
inability to access capital in a timely manner, or at all, could adversely impact demand for its products and/or adversely impact its ability to manufacture
or supply its products, any of which could have a material and adverse effect on the Company's business.

20

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

The  extent  to  which  the COVID-19 pandemic  will  impact  the  Company’s  business  going  forward  will  depend  on  numerous  evolving  factors  that
cannot be reliably predicted, including the duration and scope of the pandemic; governmental, business, and individuals’ actions in response to the
pandemic; and the impact on economic activity including the possibility of recession or financial market instability.

The Company expects the customers will return and the amount of revenue to increase in 2021 compared to 2020 as the economic environment outlook
due  to  the  COVID-19  pandemic  improves;  however,  the  COVID-19  outbreak  continues  to  be  fluid  and  the  aftermath  of  the  business  and  economic
disruptions  due  to  the  COVID-19  in  2020  is  still  uncertain,  making  it  difficult  to  forecast  the  final  impact  it  could  have  on  the  Company’s  future
operations. The spread of the coronavirus, which caused a broad impact in 2020 globally, including restrictions on travel, shifting work force to work
remotely and quarantine policies put into place by businesses and governments, had a material economic effect on the Company’s business. Notably,
healthcare facilities in many countries effectively banned elective procedures. Many of the Company’s products are used in aesthetic elective procedures
and as such, the bans on elective procedures substantially reduced the Company’s sales and marketing efforts in the early months of the pandemic. The
Company  cannot  presently  predict  the  scope  and  severity  of  any  impacts  in  future  periods  from  the  business  shutdowns  or  disruptions  due  to
the COVID-19 pandemic, but the impact on economic activity such as the possibility of recession or financial market instability could have a material
adverse effect on the Company’s business, revenue, operating results, cash flows and financial condition.

The increase in sales of skincare products in Japan may be temporary and sales of Skincare products may decline in the future.

During 2020, the Company experienced a significant increase in sales of skincare products under the exclusive distribution agreement with ZO which
allows the Company to sell ZO’s skincare products in Japan. The reason for the increase in skincare products sales might have been the result of changes
in  customers’  spending  habits  to  purchase  more  aesthetic  treatments  which  could  be  applied  at  home  due  to  limitations  on  in-person  aesthetic
procedures, social distancing and mask wearing requirements due to the COVID-19 pandemic. Future growth in sales of skincare products depends on
the customers’ spending habits, which may change back to original spending habits after the COVID-19 pandemic. Such changes may have a material
adverse effect on the Company’s revenue, operating results and cash flows.

The  Company  may  be  deemed  ineligible  to  have  received  the  PPP  loan,  and  the  Company  may  be  required  to  repay  the  PPP  loan  in  its
entirety and could be subject to penalties. In addition, with respect to any portion of the PPP loan not forgiven, the Company may default on payment
or breach provisions of the PPP loan.

On  April  22,  2020,  the  Company  received  loan  proceeds  of  $7.1  million  pursuant  to  the  Paycheck  Protection  Program  (the  “PPP”)  under  the
Coronavirus Aid, Relief, and Economic Security Act (the “CARES Act”). The Company believes that the current economic uncertainty makes the loan
necessary to support ongoing operations.

The application for these funds required the Company to, in good faith, certify that the current economic uncertainty made the loan request necessary to
support the ongoing operations of the Company. Subsequently released guidance instructs all applicants and recipients to take into account their current
business  activity  and  the  Company's  ability  to  access  other  sources  of  liquidity  sufficient  to  support  ongoing  operations  in  a  manner  that  is  not
significantly detrimental to their business. On April 28, 2020, in press conference remarks, the Secretary of the U.S. Department of the Treasury stated
that the SBA intends to perform a review of PPP loans over $2.0 million. The required certification made by the Company is subject to interpretation. If,
despite  the  good-faith  belief  that  given  the  Company’s  circumstances  the  Company  satisfied  all  eligible  requirements  for  the  PPP  loan,  it  is  later
determined the Company was ineligible to apply for and receive the PPP loan, the Company may be required to repay the PPP loan in its entirety and the
Company could be subject to additional penalties.

The loan, which is in the form of a promissory note, dated April 21, 2020, between the Company and Silicon Valley Bank as the lender (the “Loan”),
matures  on  April  21,  2022  and  bears  interest  at  a  fixed  rate  of  1.00%  per  annum,  payable  monthly  commencing  in  September  2021.  There  is  no
prepayment penalty. Under the terms of the PPP, all or a portion of the principal may be forgiven if the Loan proceeds are used for qualifying expenses
as  described  in  the  CARES  Act,  such  as  payroll  costs,  benefits,  rent,  and  utilities.  No  assurance  can  be  provided  that  the  Company  will  obtain
forgiveness of the Loan in whole or in part. With respect to any portion of the Loan that is not forgiven, the Loan will be subject to customary provisions
for a loan of this type, including customary events of default relating to, among other things, payment defaults and breaches of the provisions of the
Loan. The PPP loan will be derecognized upon repayment of the loan in accordance with its terms and/or upon confirmation of forgiveness from the
SBA.

The trading price of the Company’s notes and common stock may fluctuate substantially due to several factors, some of which are discussed below.
Further, the Company has a relatively limited number of shares of common stock outstanding, a large portion of which is held by a small number of
investors, which could result in the increase in volatility of its stock price and the trading price of the notes.

There has been recent volatility in the price of the Company’s common stock. The Company believes this is due in part to the overall impact of COVID-
19 on the aesthetic industry and its partial recovery, the remaining open territories associated with the Company’s North America salesforce, and other
factors.  As  a  result  of  the  Company’s  relatively  limited  public  float,  its  common  stock  may  be  less  liquid  than  the  stock  of  companies  with  broader
public ownership. Among other things, trading of a relatively small volume of the Company’s common stock may have a greater impact on the trading
price for the Company’s notes and shares than would be the case if the Company’s public float were larger. The public market price of the Company’s
common  stock  has  in  the  past  fluctuated  substantially  and,  due  to  the  current  concentration  of  stockholders,  the  trading  price  of  the  notes  and  the
common stock may continue to do so in the future. The market price for the Company’s notes and common stock could also be affected by a number of
other  factors,  including  the  general  market  conditions  unrelated  to  the  Company’s  operating  performance,  including  market  volatility  as  a  result  of
the COVID-19 outbreak.

21

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

The market price for the Company’s notes and common stock could also be affected by a number of other factors, including:

  ●the general market conditions unrelated to the Company’s operating performance;
  ●sales of large blocks of the Company’s common stock, including sales by the Company’s executive officers, directors and large institutional investors;
  ●quarterly variations in the Company’s, or the Company’s competitors’, results of operations;
  ●actual or anticipated changes or fluctuations in the Company’s results of operations;

●actual or anticipated changes in analysts’ estimates, investors’ perceptions, recommendations by securities analysts or the Company’s failure to achieve

analysts ‘estimates;

  ●the announcement of new products, service enhancements, distributor relationships or acquisitions by the Company or the Company’s competitors;
  ●the announcement of the departure of a key employee or executive officer by the Company or the Company’s competitors;
  ●regulatory developments or delays concerning the Company’s, or the Company’s competitors’ products; and

●the initiation of any litigation by the Company or against the Company, including the lawsuit initiated by the Company on January 31, 2020 in Federal

District Court in California against Lutronic Aesthetics, Inc. as previously disclosed on February 3, 2020, or against the Company.

Actual  or  perceived  instability  and  /  or  volatility  in  the  Company’s  stock  price  could  reduce  demand  from  potential  buyers  of  the  Company’s  stock,
thereby  causing  the  trading  price  of  the  Company’s  notes  and  stock  to  either  remain  depressed  or  to  decline  further.  In  addition,  if  the  market  for
medical-device company stocks or the stock market in general experiences a loss of investor confidence, the trading price of the Company’s notes and
stock could decline for reasons unrelated to the Company’s business, results of operations or financial condition. The trading price of the Company’s
notes  and  common  stock  might  also  decline  in  reaction  to  events  that  affect  other  companies  in  the  Company’s  industry  even  if  these  events  do  not
directly affect us. In the past, following periods of volatility in the market price of a company’s securities, securities class action litigation has often been
brought against that company. Any future securities litigation could result in substantial costs and divert the Company’s management’s attention and
resources  from  the  Company’s  business.  This  could  have  a  material  adverse  effect  on  the  Company’s  business,  results  of  operations  and  financial
condition.

Covenants  in  the  Loan  and  Security  Agreement  governing  the  Company's  revolving  credit  facility  may  restrict  its  operations,  and  if  the  Company
does not effectively manage its business to comply with these covenants, its financial condition could be adversely impacted.

The Company entered into a Loan and Security Agreement with Silicon Valley Bank in July 2020, which provides for a four-year secured revolving loan
facility  in  an  aggregate  principal  amount  of  up  to  $30.0  million  (the  “senior  credit  facility”).  The  senior  credit  facility  contains  various  restrictive
covenants, including, among other things, minimum liquidity and revenue requirements, restrictions on the Company's ability to dispose of assets, make
acquisitions or investments, incur debt or liens, make distributions to its stockholders, or enter into certain types of related party transactions. These
restrictions may restrict the Company's current and future operations, particularly the Company's ability to respond to certain changes in its business or
industry, or take future actions. Pursuant to the senior credit facility, the Company granted the parties thereto a security interest in substantially all of
its assets. See Note 12 of the notes to the Company's consolidated financial statements and the section titled “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of
Financial Condition and Results of Operations - Liquidity and Capital Resources Loan and Security Agreement” in Part II, Item 8 of the Company's
Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2020. The Company’s ability to meet these restrictive covenants can be impacted
by events beyond the Company’s control and the Company may be unable to do so. The Company’s senior credit facility provides that its breaches or
failure  to  satisfy  certain  covenants  constitutes  an  event  of  default.  Upon  the  occurrence  of  an  event  of  default,  the  Company’s  lenders  could  elect  to
declare all amounts outstanding under its debt agreements to be immediately due and payable. In addition, the Company's lenders would have the right
to proceed against the assets the Company provided as collateral pursuant to the senior credit facility. If the debt under its senior credit facility was to be
accelerated,  the  Company  may  not  have  sufficient  cash  on  hand  or  be  able  to  sell  sufficient  collateral  to  repay  it,  which  would  have  an  immediate
adverse effect on the Company's business and operating results.

22

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

The Company’s annual and quarterly operating results may fluctuate in the future, which may cause the Company’s trading price for the notes and
shares to decline.

The Company’s net sales, expenses and operating results may vary significantly from year to year and quarter to quarter for several reasons, including,
without limitation:

●   the  ability  of  the  Company’s  sales  force  to  effectively  market  and  promote  the  Company’s  products,  and  the  extent  to  which  those  products  gain
market acceptance;
● the inability to meet the Company’s debt repayment obligations under its senior credit facility due to insufficient cash;
●   the  possibility  that  cybersecurity  breaches,  data  breaches,  and  other  disruptions  could  compromise  the  Company’s  information  or  result  in  the
unauthorized disclosure of confidential information;
● the existence and timing of any product approvals or changes;
● the rate and size of expenditures incurred on the Company’s clinical, manufacturing, sales, marketing, and product development efforts;
● the Company’s ability to attract and retain personnel;
● the availability of key components, materials and contract services, which depends on the Company’s ability to forecast sales, among other things;
● investigations of the Company’s business and business-related activities by regulatory or other governmental authorities;
● variations in timing and quantity of product orders;
● temporary manufacturing interruptions or disruptions;
● the timing and success of new product and new market introductions, as well as delays in obtaining domestic or foreign regulatory approvals for such
introductions;
● increased competition, patent expirations or new technologies or treatments;
● product recalls or safety alerts;
● litigation, including product liability, patent, employment, securities class action, stockholder derivative, general commercial and other lawsuits;
● volatility in the global market and worldwide economic conditions;
● changes in tax laws, including changes domestically and internationally, or exposure to additional income tax liabilities;
● the impact of the EU privacy regulations (GDPR) on the Company’s resources;
● the financial health of the Company’s customers and their ability to purchase the Company’s products in the current economic environment;
● other unusual or non-operating expenses, such as expenses related to mergers or acquisitions, may cause operating results to vary; and
● an epidemic or pandemic, such as the current COVID-19 pandemic.

As a result of any of these factors, the Company’s consolidated results of operations may fluctuate significantly, which may in turn cause the trading
price of the notes and the shares to fluctuate.

If  defects  are  discovered  in  the  Company’s  products,  the  Company  may  incur  additional  unforeseen  costs,  customers  may  not  purchase  the
Company’s product and the Company’s reputation may suffer.

The  Company’s  success  depends  on  the  quality  and  reliability  of  its  products.  While  the  Company’s  subject  components  are  sources  and  products
manufactured to stringent quality specifications and processes, the Company’s products incorporate different components including optical components,
and other medical device software, any of which may contain errors or exhibit failures, especially when products are first introduced. In addition, new
products or enhancements may contain undetected errors or performance problems that, despite testing, are discovered only after commercial shipment.
Because the Company’s products are designed to be used to perform complex surgical procedures, due to the serious and costly consequences of product
failure, the Company and its customers have an increased sensitivity to such defects. In the past, the Company has voluntarily recalled certain products.
Although the Company’s products are subject to stringent quality processes and controls, the Company cannot provide assurance that its products will
not experience component aging, errors, or performance problems. If the Company experiences product flaws or performance problems, any or all of the
following could occur:

  ●delays in product shipments;
  ●loss of revenue;
  ●delay in market acceptance;
  ●diversion of the Company’s resources;
  ●damage to the Company’s reputation;
  ●product recalls;
  ●regulatory actions;
  ●increased service or warranty costs; or
  ●product liability claims.

Costs  associated  with  product  flaws  or  performance  problems  could  have  a  material  adverse  effect  on  the  Company’s  business,  financial  condition,
results of operations or cash flows.

23

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

The success and continuing development of the Company’s products depends, in part, upon maintaining strong relationships with physicians and
other healthcare professionals.

If the Company fails to maintain the Company’s working relationships with physicians and other ancillary healthcare and aesthetic professionals, the
Company’s  products  may  not  be  developed  and  marketed  in  line  with  the  needs  and  expectations  of  the  professionals  who  use  and  support  the
Company’s products. Physicians assist the Company as researchers, marketing consultants, product consultants, and public speakers, and the Company
relies on these professionals to provide the Company with considerable knowledge and experience. If the Company is unable to maintain these strong
relationships, the development and marketing of the Company’s products could suffer, which could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s
consolidated financial condition and results of operations.

The Company relies heavily on its sales professionals to market and sell its products worldwide. If the Company is unable to hire, effectively train,
manage, improve the productivity of, and retain the Company’s sales professionals, the Company’s business will be harmed, which would impair its
future revenue and profitability.

The Company’s success largely depends on the Company’s ability to hire, train, manage, train, and improve the productivity levels of the Company’s
sales  professionals  worldwide.  Because  of  the  Company’s  focus  on  non-core  practitioners  in  the  past,  several  of  its  sales  professionals  do  not  have
established  relationships  with  the  core  market,  consisting  of  dermatologists  and  plastic  surgeons,  or  where  those  relationships  exist,  they  are  not
appropriately strong.

Competition for sales professionals who are familiar with, and trained to sell in, the aesthetic equipment market continues to be robust. As a result, the
Company  occasionally  loses  its  sales  people  to  competitors.  The  Company’s  industry  is  characterized  by  a  few  established  companies  that  compete
vigorously for talented sales professionals. Some of its sales professionals leave the Company for jobs that they perceive to be better opportunities, both
within and outside of the aesthetic industry. For instance, in the first quarter of 2020, the Company experienced significant turnover of the Company’s
sales  professionals,  including  several  people  in  key  sales  leadership  positions.  Most  of  these  sales  professionals  went  to  work  for  a  competitor.  The
Company believes the loss of these sales professionals may negatively impacted the Company’s sales performance in the first half of 2020. The Company
believes  it  has  adequate  measures  in  place  to  protect  the  Company’s  proprietary  and  confidential  information  when  employees  leave  the  Company,
however the ability to enforce these measures varies from jurisdiction to jurisdiction and the Company must make a case-by-case decision regarding legal
enforcement  action.  For  instance,  covenants  not-to-compete  are  not  allowed  in  many  states,  and  if  allowed,  difficult  to  enforce  in  many  jurisdictions.
Furthermore, such legal enforcement actions are expensive and the Company cannot give any assurance that these enforcement actions will be successful.

However, the Company also continues to hire and train new sales people, including several from the Company’s competitors. Several of the Company’s
sales employees and sales management are recently hired or transferred into different roles, and it will take time for them to be fully trained to improve
their productivity. In addition, due to the competition for sales professionals in the Company’s industry, the Company also recruits sales professionals
from outside the industry. Sales professionals from outside the industry typically take longer to train and become familiar with the Company’s products
and the procedures in which they are used. As a result of a lack of industry knowledge, these sales professionals may take longer to become productive
members of the Company’s sales force.

The Company trains its existing and recently recruited sales professionals to better understand the Company’s existing and new product technologies
and  how  they  can  be  positioned  against  the  Company’s  competitors’  products.  These  initiatives  are  intended  to  improve  the  productivity  of  the
Company’s sales professionals and the Company’s revenue and profitability. It takes time for the sales professionals to become productive following
their  training  and  there  can  be  no  assurance  that  the  newly  recruited  sales  professionals  will  be  adequately  trained  in  a  timely  manner,  or  that  the
Company direct sales productivity will improve, or that the Company will not experience significant levels of attrition in the future.

Measures the Company implements in an effort to recruit, retain, train and manage the Company’s sales professionals, strengthen their relationships with
core  market  physicians,  and  improve  their  productivity  may  not  be  successful  and  may  instead  contribute  to  instability  in  its  operations,  additional
departures from the Company’s sales organization, or further reduce the Company’s revenue and harm the Company’s business. If the Company is not
able  to  improve  the  productivity  and  retention  of  the  Company’s  North  American  and  international  sales  professionals,  then  the  Company’s  total
revenue, profitability and stock price may be adversely impacted.

The  aesthetic  equipment  market  is  characterized  by  rapid  innovation.  To  compete  effectively,  the  Company  must  develop  and/or  acquire  new
products, seek regulatory clearance, market them successfully, and identify new markets for the Company’s technology.

The  aesthetic  light  and  energy-based  treatment  system  industry  is  subject  to  continuous  technological  development  and  product  innovation.  If  the
Company does not continue to innovate and develop new products and applications, the Company’s competitive position will likely deteriorate as other
companies successfully design and commercialize new products and applications or enhancements to the Company’s current products. The Company
created  products  to  apply  the  Company’s  technology  to  body  contouring,  hair  removal,  treatment  of  veins,  tattoo  removal  and  skin  revitalization,
including the treatment of diffuse redness, fine lines and wrinkles via hemostasis and coagulation, skin texture, pore size and benign pigmented lesions,
etc. For example, the Company introduced Juliet, a product for women’s health, in December 2017, Secret RF, a fractional RF microneedling device for
skin revitalization, in January 2018, enlighten SR in April 2018, truSculpt iD in July 2018, excel V+ in February 2019, truSculpt flex in June 2019, and
the Secret Pro, a device combining the benefits of RF microneedling with the capabilities of a fractional, ablative CO2 laser in September of 2020. To
grow in the future, the Company must continue to develop and/or acquire new and innovative aesthetic products and applications, identify new markets,
and successfully launch the newly acquired or developed product offerings.

24

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

To successfully expand the Company’s product offerings, the Company must, among other things:

  ●develop or otherwise acquire new products that either add to or significantly improve the Company’s current product offerings;
  ●obtain regulatory clearance for these new products;

●convince the Company’s existing and prospective customers that the Company’s product offerings are an attractive revenue-generating addition to their

practice;

  ●sell the Company’s product offerings to a broad customer base;
  ●identify new markets and alternative applications for the Company’s technology;
  ●protect the Company’s existing and future products with defensible intellectual property; and
  ●satisfy and maintain all regulatory requirements for commercialization.

Historically,  product  introductions  have  been  a  significant  component  of  the  Company’s  financial  performance.  To  be  successful  in  the  aesthetics
industry, the Company believes it needs to continue to innovate. The Company’s business strategy is based, in part, on its expectation that the Company
will continue to increase or enhance its product offerings. The Company needs to continue to devote substantial research and development resources to
make new product introductions, which can be costly and time consuming to its organization.

The Company also believes that, to increase revenue from sales of new products, the Company needs to continue to develop its clinical support, further
expand and nurture relationships with industry thought leaders, and increase market awareness of the benefits of its new products. However, even with a
significant investment in research and development, the Company may be unable to continue to develop, acquire or effectively launch and market new
products and technologies regularly, or at all. If the Company fails to successfully commercialize new products or enhancements, its business may be
harmed.

While the Company attempts to protect its products through patents and other intellectual property, there are few barriers to entry that would prevent
new entrants or existing competitors from developing products that compete directly with the Company’s. The Company expects that any competitive
advantage the Company may enjoy from current and future innovations may diminish over time as companies successfully respond to the Company’s, or
create their own, innovations. Consequently, the Company believes that it will have to continuously innovate and improve the Company’s products and
technology to compete successfully. If the Company is unable to innovate successfully, its products could become obsolete and its revenue could decline
as its customers and prospective customers purchase its competitors’ products.

Demand for the Company’s products in any of the Company’s markets could be weakened by several factors, including:

  ●inability to develop and market the Company’s products to the core market specialties of dermatologists and plastic surgeons;
  ●poor financial performance of market segments that attempt to introduce aesthetic procedures to their businesses;
  ●the inability to differentiate the Company’s products from those of the Company’s competitors;
  ●competitive threat from new innovations, product introductions capturing mind and wallet share;
  ●reduced patient demand for elective aesthetic procedures;
  ●failure to build and maintain relationships with opinion leaders within the various market segments; and
  ●the lack of credit financing, or an increase in the cost of borrowing, for some of the Company’s potential customers.

If  the  Company  does  not  achieve  anticipated  demand  for  the  Company’s  products,  there  could  be  a  material  adverse  effect  on  its  total  revenue,
profitability, employee retention and stock price.

25

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Exposure to United Kingdom political developments, including the effect of its withdrawal from the European Union, could be costly and difficult to
comply with and could seriously harm the Company’s business.

In June 2016, a referendum was passed in the United Kingdom to leave the European Union, commonly referred to as “Brexit.” This decision created an
uncertain  political  and  economic  environment  in  the  United  Kingdom  and  other  European  Union  countries.  The  United  Kingdom  formally  left  the
European  Union  on  January  31,  2020.  The  long-term  nature  of  the  United  Kingdom’s  relationship  with  the  European  Union  is  unclear  and  there  is
considerable  uncertainty  as  to  when  any  agreement  will  be  reached  and  implemented.  The  political  and  economic  instability  created  by  Brexit  has
caused  and  may  continue  to  cause  significant  volatility  in  global  financial  markets  and  uncertainty  regarding  the  regulation  of  data  protection  in  the
United Kingdom. In particular, although the United Kingdom enacted a Data Protection Act in May 2018 that is consistent with the EU General Data
Protection Regulation, uncertainty remains regarding how data transfers to and from the United Kingdom will be regulated. The full effect of Brexit is
uncertain and it is not possible to determine the extent of the impact of the Brexit. Consequently, no assurance can be given about the impact of the
outcome and the Company’s business, including operational and tax policies, may be seriously harmed or require reassessment.

The Company depends on skilled and experienced personnel to operate its global business effectively. Changes to management or the inability to
recruit, hire, train and retain qualified personnel, could harm the Company’s ability to successfully manage, develop and expand its business, which
would impair the Company’s future revenue and profitability.

The Company’s success largely depends on the skills, experience and efforts of the Company’s officers and other key employees. The loss of any of the
Company’s  executive  officers  could  weaken  its  management  expertise  and  harm  the  Company’s  business,  and  it  may  not  be  able  to  find  adequate
replacements on a timely basis, or at all. Except for Change of Control and Severance Agreements for the Company’s executive officers and a few key
employees, the Company does not have employment contracts with any of its officers or other key employees. Any of the Company’s officers and other
key employees may terminate their employment at any time and their knowledge of the Company’s business and industry may be difficult to replace.
The Company does not have a succession plan in place for each of its officers and key employees. In addition, the Company does not maintain “key
person” life insurance policies covering any of the Company’s employees.

In addition to dependence on the Company’s officers and key employees, the Company is highly dependent on other sales and scientific personnel. For
example, in the first quarter of 2020 the Company experienced a few turnover of its sales professionals, including several people in key sales leadership
positions. Most of these sales professionals went to work for a competitor. Additionally, the Company’s product development plans depend, in part, on
the Company’s ability to attract and retain engineers with experience in medical devices. Attracting and retaining qualified personnel will be critical to
the Company’s success, and competition for qualified personnel is intense. The Company may not be able to attract and retain personnel on acceptable
terms given the competition for such personnel among technology and healthcare companies and universities. The loss of any of these persons or the
Company’s  inability  to  attract,  train  and  retain  qualified  personnel  could  harm  the  Company’s  business  and  the  Company’s  ability  to  compete  and
become profitable.

Security  breaches,  cyber-security  incidents  and  other  disruptions  could  compromise  the  Company’s  information  and  impact  the  Company’s
business, financial condition or results of operations.

The  Company  relies  on  networks,  information  management  software  and  other  technology,  or  information  systems,  including  the  Internet  and  third-
party  hosted  services,  to  support  a  variety  of  business  processes  and  activities,  including  procurement  and  supply  chain,  manufacturing,  distribution,
invoicing,  order  processing  and  collection  of  payments.  The  Company  uses  information  systems  to  process  financial  information  and  results  of
operations  for  internal  reporting  purposes  and  to  comply  with  regulatory  financial  reporting,  legal  and  tax  requirements.  In  addition,  the  Company
depends on information systems for digital marketing activities and electronic communications among the Company’s locations around the world and
between company personnel as well as customers and suppliers. Because information systems are critical to many of the Company’s operating activities,
the Company’s business processes may be impacted by system shutdowns or service disruptions. These disruptions may be caused by failures during
routine operations such as system upgrades or user errors, as well as network or hardware failures, malicious or disruptive software, computer hackers,
geopolitical events, natural disasters, failures or impairments of telecommunications networks, or other catastrophic events. These events could result in
unauthorized disclosure of material confidential information. If the Company’s information systems suffer severe damage, disruption or shutdown and
the Company business continuity plans do not effectively resolve the issues in a timely manner, the Company could experience delays in reporting the
Company’s financial results and the Company may lose revenue and profits as a result of the Company’s inability to timely manufacture, distribute,
invoice and collect payments. Misuse, leakage or falsification of information could result in a violation of data privacy laws and regulations and damage
the Company’s reputation and credibility, and could expose the Company to liability. The Company may also be required to spend significant financial
and  other  resources  to  remedy  the  damage  caused  by  a  security  breach  or  to  repair  or  replace  networks  and  information  systems.  Like  most  major
corporations, the Company’s information systems are a target of attacks.

A cyber security attack or other incident that bypasses the Company’s information systems security could cause a security breach which may lead to a
material disruption to the Company’s information systems infrastructure or business and may involve a significant loss of business or patient health
information. If a cyber security attack or other unauthorized attempt to access the Company’s systems or facilities were successful, it could result in the
theft, destructions, loss, misappropriation or release of confidential information or intellectual property, and could cause operational or business delays
that may materially impact the Company’s ability to provide various healthcare services. Any successful cyber security attack or other unauthorized
attempt to access the Company’s systems or facilities also could result in negative publicity which could damage the Company’s reputation or brand with
the Company’s patients, referral sources, payors or other third parties and could subject the Company to a number of adverse consequences, the vast
majority of which are not insurable, including but not limited to disruptions in the Company’s operations, regulatory and other civil and criminal
penalties, fines, investigations and enforcement actions (including, but not limited to, those arising from the SEC, Federal Trade Commission, Office of
Civil Rights, the OIG or state attorneys general), fines, private litigation with those affected by the data breach, loss of customers, disputes with payors
and increased operating expense, which either individually or in the aggregate could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business, financial
position, results of operations and liquidity.

The  Company  has  not  had  any  disruptions  to  its  information  systems  that  have  materially  affected  its  business,  financial  condition  or  results  of
operations. However, there can be no assurance that such disruptions may occur and have a material adverse effect on the Company in the future.

26

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Changes in accounting standards and estimates could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s results of operations and financial position.

Generally  accepted  accounting  principles  and  the  related  authoritative  guidance  for  many  aspects  of  the  Company’s  business,  including  revenue
recognition, inventories, warranties, leases, income taxes, expected credit losses, fair-value measurements, and stock-based compensation, are complex
and  involve  subjective  judgments.  Changes  in  these  rules  or  changes  in  the  underlying  estimates,  assumptions  or  judgments  by  the  Company’s
management could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s results of operations and may retroactively affect previously reported results. For
example, recently issued authoritative guidance for credit losses may result in a significant impact to allowance for doubtful accounts.

The Company’s ability to access credit on favorable terms, if necessary, for the funding of the Company’s operations and capital projects may be
limited due to changes in credit markets.

On July 9, 2020, the Company terminated its Wells Fargo Revolving Line of Credit and subsequently entered into a Loan and Security Agreement with
Silicon  Valley  Bank  (the  “SVB  Revolving  Line  of  Credit”).  The  agreement  provides  for  a  four-year  secured  revolving  loan  facility  in  an  aggregate
principal amount of up to $30.0 million. The SVB Revolving Line of Credit matures on July 9, 2024. As of December 31, 2020, the Company had not
drawn on this credit facility.

A violation of any of the covenants could result in a default under the SVB Revolving Line of Credit that would permit Silicon Valley Bank to restrict
the Company’s ability to further access the revolving line of credit for loans and letters of credit and require the immediate repayment of any outstanding
loans  under  the  agreement.  In  addition,  these  covenants  are  subject  to  renegotiation  at  the  beginning  of  each  fiscal  year,  which  further  reduces  the
Company’s ability to anticipate whether this source of capital will continue to be available in the near term.

Additionally,  in  the  past,  the  credit  markets  and  the  financial  services  industry  have  experienced  disruption  characterized  by  the  bankruptcy,  failure,
collapse  or  sale  of  various  financial  institutions,  increased  volatility  in  securities  prices,  diminished  liquidity  and  credit  availability  and  intervention
from  the  U.S.  and  other  governments.  Continued  concerns  about  the  systemic  impact  of  potential  long-term  or  widespread  downturn,  energy  costs,
geopolitical  issues,  the  availability  and  cost  of  credit,  the  global  commercial  and  residential  real  estate  markets  and  related  mortgage  markets  and
reduced  consumer  confidence  have  contributed  to  increased  market  volatility.  The  cost  and  availability  of  credit  has  been  and  may  continue  to  be
adversely  affected  by  these  conditions.  The  Company  cannot  be  certain  that  funding  for  the  Company’s  capital  needs  will  be  available  from  the
Company’s existing financial institutions and the credit markets if needed, and if available, to the extent required and on acceptable terms. The SVB
Revolving Line of Credit terminates on July 9, 2024 and if the Company cannot renew or refinance this facility or obtain funding when needed, in each
case on acceptable terms, such conditions may have an adverse effect on the Company’s revenues and results of operations.

The Company’s  ability  to  report  timely  and  accurate  information  could  be  negatively  impacted  by  its  plan  to  implement  a  new  accounting  and
enterprise resource planning (“ERP”) system.

The Company is in the process of implementing a new accounting and ERP system. The Company has not previously had a comprehensive ERP system
and  to  date  has  relied  on  a  myriad  of  non-integrated  systems,  as  well  as  manual  processes.  A  system  implementation  of  this  magnitude  entails  a
significant degree of inherent risk. The key elements of this implementation include the conversion of data from existing systems to the new system and
the design of the new system to process and report financial and other transactions in an accurate and complete manner. If these, or other aspects of the
implementation are not executed successfully, then its ability to report timely and accurate information could be negatively impacted. Failure to report
required information in a timely and accurate fashion could result in financial penalties, fines and other administrative actions. Such events could have a
material adverse effect on the Company’s total enterprise value and stock price. Additionally, the process of implementing a new ERP system is capital
intensive and includes the inherent risk of incurring significant additional costs should the time and resources requirements of the implementation be
greater than what the Company currently anticipates.

27

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Macroeconomic  political  and  market  conditions,  and  catastrophic  events  may  adversely  affect  the  Company’s  business,  results  of  operations,
financial condition and the trading price of the notes and the stock.

The Company’s business is influenced by a range of factors that are beyond the Company’s control, including:

●general macro-economic and business conditions in the Company’s key markets of North America, Japan, Asia Pacific, the Middle East, Europe and

Australia;

●the lack of credit financing, or an increase in the cost of borrowing, for some of the Company’s potential customers due to increasing interest rates and

lending requirements;

  ●the overall demand for the Company’s products by the core market specialties of dermatologists and plastic surgeons;

●the timing and success of new product introductions by the Company or the Company’s competitors or any other change in the competitive landscape of

the market for non-surgical aesthetic procedures, including consolidation among the Company’s competitors;

  ●the level of awareness of aesthetic procedures and the market adoption of the Company’s products;
  ●changes in the Company’s pricing policies or those of the Company’s competitors;
  ●governmental budgetary constraints or shifts in government spending priorities;
  ●general political developments, both domestic and in the Company’s foreign markets, including economic and political uncertainty caused by elections;
  ●natural disasters;
  ●tax law changes;
  ●currency exchange rate fluctuations; and
  ●any trade restrictions or higher import taxes that may be imposed by foreign countries against products sold internationally by U.S. companies.

Macroeconomic developments, like global recessions and financial crises could negatively affect the Company’s business, operating results, or financial
condition which, in turn, could adversely affect the Company’s stock price. A general weakening of, and related declining corporate confidence in, the
global economy or the curtailment in government or corporate spending could cause current or potential customers to reduce their budgets or be unable
to fund product or upgrade application purchases, which could cause customers to delay, decrease or cancel purchases of the Company’s products and
services or cause customers not to pay the Company or to delay paying the Company for previously purchased products and services.

In addition, political unrest in regions like the Middle East, terrorist attacks around the globe and the potential for other hostilities in various parts of the
world, potential public health crises and natural disasters continue to contribute to a climate of economic and political uncertainty that could adversely
affect the Company’s results of operations and financial condition, including the Company’s revenue growth and profitability.

Macroeconomic  declines,  negative  political  developments,  adverse  market  conditions  and  catastrophic  events  may  cause  a  decline  in  the  Company’s
revenue, negatively affect the Company’s operating results, adversely affect the Company’s cash flow and could result in a decline in the Company’s
stock price.

To successfully market and sell the Company’s products internationally, the Company must address many issues that are unique to the Company’s
international  business.  Furthermore,  international  expansion  is  a  key  component  of  the  Company’s  growth  strategy,  although  the  Company’s
international operations and foreign transactions expose the Company to additional operational challenges that the Company might not otherwise
face.

The Company is focused on international expansion as a key component of its growth strategy and has identified specific areas of opportunity in various
international  markets.  International  revenue  is  a  material  component  of  the  Company’s  business  strategy  and  represented  48%  of  its  total  revenue  in
2020 compared to 42% of the Company’s total revenue in 2019. The Company employs a direct sales force in the major markets throughout Europe as
well as Canada, Japan and Australia/New Zealand while using third-party distributors to sell its products in several other country in the Middle East,
Asia,  and  South  America  in  particular.  The  Company  may  be  unable  to  increase  or  maintain  its  level  of  international  revenue  due  to  supply  chain
disruptions or loss of distributor relationship.

The Company experienced significant turnover of the Company’s North America sales team during the first quarter of 2020. Though these departures
did  not  have  an  adverse  effect  on  the  Company’s  international  sales,  they  added  additional  pressure  on  the  global  sales  team.  While  the  Company
continues  to  have  a  direct  sales  and  service  organization  in  Australia,  New  Zealand,  Japan,  France,  Belgium,  Spain,  Germany,  Switzerland  and  the
United Kingdom, a significant portion of its international revenue is generated through its network of distributors. Though the Company continues to
evaluate and replace non-performing distributors and has recently brought greater focus to collaboration with its distribution partners, there can be no
assurance given that these initiatives will result in improved international revenue or profitability in the future.

To grow the Company’s business, it is essential to improve productivity in current sales territories and expand into new territories. However, direct sales
productivity  may  not  improve  and  distributors  may  not  accept  the  Company’s  business  or  commit  the  necessary  resources  to  market  and  sell  the
Company’s products at the Company’s expectations. If the Company is not able to increase or maintain international revenue growth, the Company’s total
revenue, profitability and stock price may be adversely impacted.

If the Company fails to renew any of its distribution agreements as they expire under the terms of the particular agreement, its revenues and cash
flow may be adversely affected.

The  Company's  business  may  suffer  if  any  of  its  distribution  partners  terminates  or  otherwise  fails  to  renew  its  distribution  agreement  with  the
Company  and  the  Company  is  otherwise  unable  to  replace  such  agreement  with  a  distribution  agreement  containing  similar  terms.  For  example,  the
Company's distribution agreement with ZO to distribute certain of their proprietary skincare products in Japan expires in June 2021. If ZO fails to renew
the  distribution  agreement  or  it  terminates  the  distribution  agreement  early  for  any  reason,  the  Company's  revenues  and  cash  flow  may  be  adversely
affected.

28

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Economic and other risks associated with international sales and operations could adversely affect the Company’s business.

In  2019,  42%  of  the  Company’s  total  revenue  was  from  customers  outside  of  North  America.  The  Company  expects  its  sales  from  international
operations  and  export  sales  to  continue  to  be  a  significant  portion  of  the  Company’s  revenue.  The  Company  has  placed  a  particular  emphasis  on
increasing its growth and presence in international markets. The Company’s international operations and sales are subject, in varying degrees, to risks
inherent in doing business outside the U.S. These risks include:

●changes in trade protection measures, including embargoes, tariffs and other trade barriers, and import and export regulations and licensing

requirements;

●instability and uncertainties arising from the global geopolitical environment, such as economic nationalism, populism, protectionism and anti-global

sentiment;

●changes in tax laws and potential negative consequences from the interpretation, application and enforcement by governmental tax authorities of tax

laws and policies;

  ●unanticipated changes in other laws and regulations or in how such provisions are interpreted or administered;

●reduced protection for intellectual property rights in some countries and practical difficulties of enforcing intellectual property and contract rights

abroad;

●possibility of unfavorable circumstances arising from host country laws or regulations, including those related to infrastructure and data transmission,

security and privacy;

  ●currency exchange rate fluctuations and restrictions on currency repatriation;
  ●difficulties and expenses related to implementing internal control over financial reporting and disclosure controls and procedures;
  ●disruption of sales from labor and political disturbances;
  ●regional safety and security considerations;

●increased costs and risks in developing, staffing and simultaneously managing global sales operations as a result of distance as well as language and

cultural differences;

  ●increased management, travel, infrastructure and legal compliance costs associated with having multiple international operations;
  ●lengthy payment cycles and difficulty in collecting accounts receivable;
  ●preference for locally-produced products, as well as protectionist laws and business practices that favor local companies;
  ●outbreak or escalation of insurrection, armed conflict, terrorism or war; and
  ●supply chain disruption or the loss of distributor relationships.

Changes  in  the  geopolitical  or  economic  environments  in  the  countries  in  which  the  Company  operates  could  have  a  material  adverse  effect  on  the
Company’s financial condition, results of operations or cash flows. For example, changes in U.S. policy regarding international trade, including import
and export regulation and international trade agreements, could also negatively impact the Company’s business. In 2018, the U.S. imposed tariffs on
certain goods imported from China and certain other countries, which has resulted in retaliatory tariffs by China and other countries. Additional tariffs
imposed by the U.S. on a broader range of imports, or further retaliatory trade measures taken by China or other countries in response, could adversely
impact the Company’s financial condition and results of operations.

The Company’s global operations are required to comply with the U.S. Foreign Corrupt Practices Act of 1977, as amended (“FCPA”), Chinese anti-
corruption laws, U.K. Bribery Law, and similar anti-bribery laws in other jurisdictions, and with U.S. and foreign export control, trade embargo and
customs laws. If the Company fails to comply with any of these laws, the Company could suffer civil and criminal sanctions.

Additionally,  the  Company  continues  to  monitor  Brexit  and  its  potential  impacts  on  the  Company’s  results  of  operations  and  financial  condition.
Following  the  end  of  the  “Brexit”  Transition  Period,  from  1  January  2021  onwards,  the  Medicines  and  Healthcare  Products  Regulatory  Agency
(“MHRA”) will be responsible for the UK medical device market. The new regulations will require medical devices to be registered with the MHRA
(but manufacturers will be given a grace period of four to 12 months to comply with the new registration process). Manufacturers based outside the UK
will need to appoint a UK Responsible Person to register devices with the MHRA in line with the grace periods. By July 1, 2023, in the UK (England,
Scotland, and Wales), all medical devices will require a UKCA (UK Conformity Assessed) mark but CE marks issued by EU notified bodies will remain
valid until this time. However, UKCA marking alone will not be recognized in the EU. The rules for placing medical devices on the Northern Ireland
market will differ from those in the UK.

In  addition  to  the  general  risks  that  the  Company  faces  outside  the  U.S.,  the  Company’s  operations  in  emerging  markets  could  involve  additional
uncertainties for us, including risks that governments may impose withholding or other taxes on remittances and other payments to us, or the amount of
any such taxes may increase; governments may seek to nationalize the Company’s assets; or governments may impose or increase investment barriers or
other  restrictions  affecting  the  Company’s  business.  In  addition,  emerging  markets  pose  other  uncertainties,  including  the  difficulty  of  enforcing
agreements,  challenges  collecting  receivables,  protection  of  the  Company’s  intellectual  property  and  other  assets,  pressure  on  the  pricing  of  the
Company’s products and services, higher business conduct risks, ability to hire and retain qualified talent and risks of political instability. The Company
cannot predict the impact such events might have on the Company’s business, financial condition and results of operations.

In addition, compliance with laws and regulations applicable to the Company’s international operations increases the Company’s cost of doing business
in foreign jurisdictions. The Company may be unable to keep current with changes in foreign government requirements and laws as they change from
time to time. Failure to comply with these regulations could have adverse effects on the Company’s business. In many foreign countries it is common for
others  to  engage  in  business  practices  that  are  prohibited  by  the  Company’s  internal  policies  and  procedures  or  U.S.  regulations  applicable  to  us.  In
addition, although the Company has implemented policies and procedures designed to ensure compliance with these laws and policies, there can be no
assurance that all of the Company’s employees, contractors, distributors and agents will comply with these laws and policies. Violations of laws or key
control  policies  by  the  Company’s  employees,  contractors,  distributors  or  agents  could  result  in  delays  in  revenue  recognition,  financial  reporting
misstatements, fines, penalties, or the prohibition of the importation or exportation of the Company’s offerings and could have a material adverse effect
on the Company’s business operations and financial results.

29

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

To  successfully  market  and  sell  third  party  products  internationally,  the  Company  must  address  many  issues  that  are  unique  to  the  related
distribution arrangements which could reduce the Company’s available cash reserves and negatively impact the Company’s profitability.

The  Company  has  entered  into  distribution  arrangements  pursuant  to  which  the  Company  utilizes  its  sales  force  and  distributors  to  sell  products
manufactured by other companies. In Japan, the Company has a non-exclusive right to distribute a Q-switched laser product manufactured by a third
party OEM. The Company also has an exclusive agreement with ZO to distribute certain of their proprietary skincare products in Japan. Each of these
agreements  requires  the  Company  to  purchase  annual  minimum  dollar  amounts  of  their  products.  Additionally,  the  Company  has  entered  into
distribution arrangements with other companies to promote and sell the Secret RF and Juliet products.

Each of these distribution agreements presents its own unique risks and challenges. For example, to sell skincare products the Company needs to invest
in creating a sales structure that is experienced in the sale of such products and not in capital equipment. The Company needs to commit resources to
train the Company’s sales force, obtain regulatory licenses, and develop new marketing materials to promote the sale of these products. In addition, the
minimum  commitments  and  other  costs  of  distributing  products  manufactured  by  these  companies  may  exceed  the  incremental  revenue  that  the
Company derives from the sale of their products, thereby negatively impacting the Company’s profitability and reducing the Company’s available cash
reserves.

If the Company does not make the minimum purchases required in the distribution contracts, or if the third party manufacturer revokes the Company’s
distribution rights, the Company could lose the distribution rights of the products, which would adversely affect the Company’s future revenue, results
of operations, cash flows and its stock price.

The Company offers credit terms to some qualified customers and also to leasing companies to finance the purchase of its products. In the event that
any of these customers default on the amounts payable to the Company, its earnings may be adversely affected.

The Company generally offers credit terms of 30 to 90 days to qualified customers. In addition, from time to time, it offers certain key international
distributors, with whom the Company has had an extended period of relationship and payment history, payment terms that are significantly longer than
the regular 30 to 90 day terms. This allows such international distribution partners to have its products in stock and provide its products to customers on
a timely basis.

While the Company believes it has an adequate basis to ensure that it collects its accounts receivable, the Company cannot provide any assurance that
the  financial  position  of  customers  to  whom  it  has  provided  payment  terms  will  not  change  adversely  before  the  Company  receives  payment.  In  the
event  that  there  is  a  default  by  any  of  the  customers  to  whom  the  Company  has  provided  credit  terms,  the  Company  may  recognize  a  credit  loss
provision  write-off  charge  in  the  Company’s  general  and  administrative  expenses.  If  this  write-off  charge  is  material,  it  could  negatively  affect  the
Company’s future results of operations, cash flows and its stock price.

Additionally,  in  the  event  of  deterioration  of  general  business  conditions  or  the  availability  of  credit,  the  financial  strength  and  stability  of  the
Company’s customers and potential customers may deteriorate over time, which may cause them to cancel or delay their purchase of its products. In
addition, the Company may be subject to increased risk of non-payment of its accounts receivables. The Company may also be adversely affected by
bankruptcies or other business failures of the Company’s customers and potential customers. A significant delay in the collection of funds or a reduction
of funds collected may impact the Company’s liquidity or result in credit losses.

The Company’s ability to effectively compete and generate additional revenue from new and existing products depends upon the Company’s ability
to  distinguish  the  Company  and  its  products  from  the  competitors  and  their  products,  and  to  develop  and  effectively  market  new  and  existing
products. The Company’s success is dependent on many factors, including the following:

  ●speed of new and innovative product development;
  ●effective strategy and execution of new product launches;
  ●identification and development of clinical support for new indications of the Company’s existing products;
  ●product performance;
  ●product pricing;
  ●quality of customer support;
  ●development of successful distribution channels, both domestically and internationally; and
  ●intellectual property protection.

To compete effectively, the Company has to demonstrate that its new and existing products are attractive alternatives to other devices and treatments, by
differentiating the Company’s products on the basis of such factors as innovation, performance, brand name, service, and price. This is difficult to do,
especially  in  a  crowded  aesthetic  market.  Some  of  the  Company’s  competitors  have  newer  or  different  products  and  more  established  customer
relationships than the Company does, which could inhibit the Company’s market penetration efforts. For example, the Company has encountered, and
expects to continue to encounter, situations where, due to pre-existing relationships, potential customers decide to purchase additional products from the
Company’s  competitors.  Potential  customers  also  may  need  to  recoup  the  cost  of  products  that  they  have  already  purchased  from  the  Company’s
competitors and may decide not to purchase the Company’s products, or to delay such purchases. If the Company is unable to increase the Company’s
market penetration or compete effectively, its revenue and profitability will be adversely impacted.

30

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

The Company competes against companies that offer alternative solutions to its products, have greater resources, or have a larger installed base of
customers and broader product offerings than the Company’s. In addition, increased consolidation in the Company’s industry may lead to increased
competition. If the Company is not able to effectively compete with these companies, it may harm its business.

The medical technology and aesthetic product markets are highly competitive and dynamic and are characterized by rapid and substantial technology
development and product innovations. The Company’s products compete against conventional non-energy-based treatments, such as electrolysis, Botox
and collagen injections, chemical peels, microdermabrasion and sclerotherapy. The Company’s products also compete against laser and other energy-
based products offered by public companies. Further, other companies could introduce new products that are in direct competition with the Company’s
products.  The  Company  may  also  face  competition  from  manufacturers  of  pharmaceutical  and  other  products  that  have  not  yet  been  developed.
Competition with these companies could result in reduced selling prices, reduced profit margins and loss of market share, any of which would harm the
Company’s business, financial condition and results of operations.

There has been consolidation in the aesthetic industry leading to companies combining their resources, which increases competition and could result in
increased downward pressure on the Company’s product prices. Consolidations have created newly-combined entities with greater financial resources,
deeper  sales  channels  and  greater  pricing  flexibility  than  the  Company.  Rumored  or  actual  consolidation  of  the  Company’s  partners  and  competitors
could cause uncertainty and disruption to the Company’s business and can cause the Company’s stock price to fluctuate.

If there is not sufficient consumer demand for the procedures performed with the Company’s products, practitioner demand for its products could be
inhibited, resulting in unfavorable operating results and reduced growth potential.

Continued expansion of the global market for laser and other-energy-based aesthetic procedures is a material assumption of the Company’s business
strategy.  Most  procedures  performed  using  the  Company’s  products  are  elective  procedures  not  reimbursable  through  government  or  private  health
insurance,  with  the  costs  borne  by  the  patient.  The  decision  to  utilize  the  Company’s  products  may  therefore  be  influenced  by  a  number  of  factors,
including:

  ●consumer disposable income and access to consumer credit, which as a result of an unstable economy, maybe significantly impacted;

●the cost, safety and effectiveness of alternative treatments, including treatments which are not based upon laser or other energy-based technologies and

treatments which use pharmaceutical products;

  ●the success of the Company’s sales and marketing efforts; and

●the education of the Company’s customers and patients on the benefits and uses of the Company’s products, compared to competitors’ products and

technologies.

If, as a result of these factors, there is not sufficient demand for the procedures performed with the Company’s products, practitioner demand for the
Company’s products could be reduced, which could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business, financial condition, revenue and result of
operations.

The Company's products and its operations are subject to extensive government regulation and oversight in the United States. If the Company fails
to obtain or maintain necessary regulatory clearances or approvals for its products, or if approvals or clearances for future products are delayed or
not issued, it will negatively affect its business, financial condition and results of operations.

The  Company's  laser  products  are  medical  devices  subject  to  extensive  regulation  in  the  United  States  and  elsewhere,  including  by  the  FDA  and  its
foreign counterparts. Government regulations specific to medical devices are wide ranging and govern, among other things:

  ●product design, development, manufacture, and release;
  ●laboratory and clinical testing, labeling, packaging, storage and distribution;
  ●product safety and efficacy;
  ●premarketing clearance or approval;
  ●service operations;
  ●record keeping;
  ●product marketing, promotion and advertising, sales and distribution;
  ●post-marketing surveillance, including reporting of deaths or serious injuries and recalls and correction and removals;
  ●post-market approval studies; and
  ●product import and export.

The FDA classifies medical devices into one of three classes on the basis of the intended use of the device, the risk associated with the use of the device
for  that  indication,  as  determined  by  the  FDA,  and  on  the  controls  deemed  by  the  FDA  to  be  necessary  to  reasonably  ensure  their  safety  and
effectiveness.

Class I includes devices with the lowest risk to the patient and are those for which safety and effectiveness can be assured by adherence to the FDA’s
General  Controls  for  medical  devices,  which  include  compliance  with  the  applicable  portions  of  the  QSR  facility  registration  and  product  listing,
reporting of adverse medical events, and truthful and non-misleading labeling, advertising, and promotional materials. Class II devices are subject to the
FDA’s  General  Controls,  and  special  controls  as  deemed  necessary  by  the  FDA  to  ensure  the  safety  and  effectiveness  of  the  device.  These  special
controls can include performance standards, post-market surveillance, patient registries and FDA guidance documents.

31

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

While most Class I devices are exempt from the premarket notification requirement, manufacturers of most Class II devices are required to submit to the
FDA a premarket notification under Section 510(k) of the FDCA requesting permission to commercially distribute the device. The FDA’s permission to
commercially distribute a device subject to a 510(k) premarket notification is generally known as 510(k) clearance. Devices deemed by the FDA to pose
the  greatest  risks,  such  as  life  sustaining,  life  supporting  or  some  implantable  devices,  or  devices  that  have  a  new  intended  use,  or  use  advanced
technology that is not substantially equivalent to that of a legally marketed device, are placed in Class III, requiring approval of a PMA application.
Some  pre-amendment  devices  are  unclassified,  but  are  subject  to  FDA’s  premarket  notification  and  clearance  process  in  order  to  be  commercially
distributed.  The  Company's  currently  marketed  products  are  Class  II  devices  subject  to  510(k)  clearance,  which  the  Company  has  obtained  from  the
FDA.

Before a new medical device, or a new intended use of, claim for, or significant modification to an existing device, can be marketed in the United States,
a company must first submit an application for and receive either 510(k) clearance pursuant to a premarket notification submitted under Section 510(k)
of  the  FDCA,  de-novo  classification,  or  PMA  approval  from  the  FDA,  unless  an  exemption  applies.  The  510(k),  de-novo  or  PMA  processes  can  be
expensive, lengthy and unpredictable. The FDA’s 510(k) clearance process usually takes from three to 12 months, but can last longer. The process of
obtaining a PMA approval is much more costly and uncertain than the 510(k) clearance process and generally takes from one to three years, or even
longer, from the time the application is filed with the FDA. In addition, a PMA approval generally requires the performance of one or more clinical
trials.  Despite  the  time,  effort  and  cost,  a  device  may  not  be  approved  or  cleared  by  the  FDA.  Any  delay  or  failure  to  obtain  necessary  regulatory
clearances  or  approvals  could  harm  its  business.  Furthermore,  even  if  the  Company  is  granted  regulatory  clearances  or  approvals,  they  may  include
significant limitations on the indicated uses for the device, which may limit the market for the device.

The Company has obtained 510(k) clearances to market its products, such as the Juliet device. The FDA or other regulators could delay, limit, or deny
clearance or approval of a device for many reasons, including:

●The Company's inability to demonstrate to the satisfaction of the FDA or the applicable regulatory entity or notified body that the Company's currently
marketed devices, or any other future device, and any accessories are substantially equivalent to a legally marketed predicate device or safe or effective
for their proposed intended uses;

●the disagreement of the FDA with the design or implementation of any clinical trials or the interpretation of data from preclinical studies or clinical

trials;

  ●serious and unexpected adverse device effects experienced by participants in its clinical trials;
  ●the insufficiency of the data from preclinical studies or clinical trials to support clearance or approval, where required;
  ●our inability to demonstrate that the clinical and other benefits of the device outweigh the risks;
  ●the failure of its manufacturing process or facilities to meet applicable requirements; and

●the potential for approval policies or regulations of the FDA or applicable foreign regulatory bodies to change significantly in a manner rendering its

clinical data or regulatory filings insufficient for clearance or approval.

The regulations to which the Company is subject are complex and have tended to become more stringent over time. Regulatory changes could result in
restrictions  on  the  Company's  ability  to  carry  on  or  expand  its  operations,  higher  than  anticipated  costs  or  lower  than  anticipated  sales.  The  FDA
enforces these regulatory requirements through, among other means, periodic unannounced inspections. The Company does not know whether it will be
found  compliant  in  connection  with  any  future  regulatory  inspections.  Moreover,  the  FDA  and  state  authorities  have  broad  enforcement  powers.
Its  failure  to  comply  with  applicable  regulatory  requirements  could  result  in  enforcement  action  by  any  such  agency.  If  any  of  these  events  were  to
occur, it would negatively affect the Company's business, financial condition and results of operations.

If the Company fails to comply with applicable regulatory requirements, it could result in enforcement action by the U.S. FDA, federal and state
agencies or international regulatory bodies and the Company’s commercial operations would be harmed.

The  Company’s  products  are  medical  devices  that  are  subject  to  extensive  regulation  in  the  U.S.  by  the  FDA  for  manufacturing,  labeling,  sale,
promotion, distribution and shipping. The FDA, state authorities and international regulatory bodies have broad enforcement powers. If the Company
fails to comply with any U.S. law or any of the applicable regulatory requirements of the FDA, or federal or state agencies, or one of the international
regulatory bodies, it could result in enforcement action by the agencies, which may include any of the following sanctions:

  ●warning letters, fines, injunctions, consent decrees and civil penalties;
  ●repair, replacement, recall or seizure of the Company’s products;
  ●operating restrictions or partial suspension or total shutdown of production;
  ●refusing the Company’s requests for 510(k) clearance of new products, new intended uses, or modifications to existing products;
  ●withdrawing 510(k) clearance or pre-market approvals that have already been granted; and
  ●criminal prosecution.

Federal  regulatory  reforms  and  changes  occurring  at  the  FDA  could  adversely  affect  the  Company’s  ability  to  sell  its  products  profitably  and
financial condition.

From time to time, legislation is drafted and introduced in Congress that could significantly change the statutory provisions governing the clearance or
approval, manufacture and marketing of a device. It is impossible to predict whether legislative changes will be enacted or FDA regulations, guidance or
interpretations changed, and what the impact of such changes, if any, may be.

32

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

In addition, FDA regulations and guidance are often revised or reinterpreted by the agency in ways that may significantly affect the Company’s business
and  the  Company’s  products.  Changes  in  FDA  regulations  may  lengthen  the  regulatory  approval  process  for  medical  devices  and  require  additional
clinical data to support regulatory clearance for the sale and marketing of the Company’s new products. In addition, it may require additional safety
monitoring, labeling changes, restrictions on product distribution or use, or other measures after the introduction of the Company’s products to market.
Either of these changes lengthen the duration to market, increase the Company’s costs of doing business, adversely affect the future permitted uses of
approved products, or otherwise adversely affect the market for its products.

For instance, on or about July 30, 2018, the FDA issued a public statement and sent letters to a number of companies in the medical aesthetics industry
expressing concerns regarding “vaginal revitalization” procedures using energy-based devices. The Company’s Juliet device is promoted and used by
physicians in procedures that are the subject of the FDA’s public warning. However, neither the Company nor its distribution partner were named in the
announcement, and neither the Company nor its distribution partner have received a letter from the agency as of the date of this filing. Working with the
Company’s  distribution  partner  and  the  FDA,  the  Company  is  assessing  the  potential  parameters  of  an  additional  study  regarding  the
Company’s Juliet device to address the concerns highlighted in the FDA’s statement. However, there can be no assurances that the Company will reach
an agreement with the Company’s distribution partner on the execution details of such a study, or that such a study will be successful in addressing the
FDA’s safety concerns with the Company’s Juliet device.

The Company supports any action that helps ensure patient safety going forward. The Company has a robust, multi-functional process that reviews its
promotional claims and materials to ensure they are truthful, not misleading, fair and balanced, and supported by sound scientific evidence.

Changes in funding or disruptions at the FDA and other government agencies caused by funding shortages or global health concerns could hinder
their ability to hire and retain key leadership and other personnel, or otherwise prevent new or modified products from being developed, approved or
commercialized in a timely manner or at all, or otherwise prevent those agencies from performing normal business functions on which the operation
of the Company's business may rely, which could negatively impact its business.

The ability of the FDA to review and approve new products can be affected by a variety of factors, including government budget and funding levels,
ability to hire and retain key personnel and accept the payment of user fees, and statutory, regulatory, and policy changes, and other events that may
otherwise  affect  the  FDA’s  ability  to  perform  routine  functions.  Average  review  times  at  the  agency  have  fluctuated  in  recent  years  as  a  result.  In
addition,  government  funding  of  other  government  agencies  on  which  the  Company's  operations  may  rely,  including  those  that  fund  research  and
development activities is subject to the political process, which is inherently fluid and unpredictable.

Disruptions at the FDA and other agencies may also slow the time necessary for new product applications to be reviewed and/or approved by necessary
government agencies, which would adversely affect its business. For example, in recent years, including for 35 days beginning on December 22, 2018,
the U.S. government shut down several times and certain regulatory agencies, including the FDA, had to furlough critical employees and stop critical
activities. Separately, in response to the COVID-19 pandemic, the FDA has indicated that it will consider alternative methods for inspections and could
exercise discretion on a case-by-case basis to approve products based on a desk review, if a prolonged government shutdown occurs, or if global health
concerns continue to prevent the FDA or other regulatory authorities from conducting their regular inspections, reviews, or other regulatory activities, it
could significantly impact the ability of the FDA to timely review and process its regulatory submissions, which could have a material adverse effect on
the Company's business.

If  the  Company  fails  to  comply  with  the  FDA’s  Quality  System  Regulation  and  laser  performance  standards,  the  Company’s  manufacturing
operations could be halted, and its business would suffer.

The  Company  is  currently  required  to  demonstrate  and  maintain  compliance  with  the  FDA’s  Quality  System  Regulation  (the  “QSR”).  The  QSR  is  a
complex  regulatory  scheme  that  covers  the  methods  and  documentation  of  the  design,  testing,  control,  manufacturing,  labeling,  quality  assurance,
packaging, storage and shipping of the Company’s products. Because the Company’s products involve the use of lasers, the Company’s products also are
covered by a performance standard for lasers set forth in FDA regulations. The laser performance standard imposes specific record-keeping, reporting,
product testing and product labeling requirements. These requirements include affixing warning labels to laser products, as well as incorporating certain
safety features in the design of laser products.

The FDA enforces the QSR and laser performance standards through periodic unannounced inspections. The Company has had multiple quality system
inspections by the FDA, as well as audits the Company’s Notified Body, and other foreign regulatory agencies, with the most recent inspection by the
FDA occurring under the Medical Device Single Audit Program in January 2021. There were no significant findings or observations as a result of this
audit. Failure to take satisfactory corrective action in response to an adverse QSR inspection or its failure to comply with applicable laser performance
standards could result in enforcement actions, including a public warning letter, a shutdown of the Company’s manufacturing operations, a recall of its
products, civil or criminal penalties, or other sanctions, such as those described in the preceding paragraph, which would cause its sales and business to
suffer.

The Company is a sponsor of Biomedical Research. As such, the BIMO audits the Company and the Company is also subject to FDA regulations relating
to the design and conduct of clinical trials. The Company is subject to unannounced BIMO audits, with the most recent inspection by FDA occurring
over 5 days in August 2016. There were no significant findings and only two observations as a result of this audit. The Company’s responses to these
observations were accepted by the FDA. Failure to take satisfactory corrective action in response to an adverse BIMO inspection or the Company’s
failure to comply with Good Clinical Practices could result in the Company no longer being able to sponsor Biomedical Research, the reversal of 510(k)
clearances previously granted based on the results of clinical trials conducted to gain clinical data to support those 510(k) clearances, or
enforcement actions, including a public warning letter, civil or criminal penalties, or other sanctions, such as those described in the preceding paragraph,
which would cause the Company’s sales and business to suffer.

If the Company modifies one of its FDA-cleared devices, it may need to seek a new clearance, which, if not granted, would prevent the Company
from selling its modified products or cause it to redesign its products.

Any  modifications  to  an  FDA-cleared  device  that  could  significantly  affect  its  safety  or  effectiveness  or  that  would  constitute  a  major  change  in  its
intended  use  would  require  a  new  510(k)  clearance  or  possibly  a  pre-market  approval.  The  Company  may  not  be  able  to  obtain  additional  510(k)
clearance or premarket approvals for new products or for modifications to, or additional indications for, its existing products in a timely fashion, or at
all.  Delays  in  obtaining  future  clearance  would  adversely  affect  its  ability  to  introduce  new  or  enhanced  products  in  a  timely  manner,  which  in  turn
would harm its revenue and future profitability.

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
33

 
Table of Contents

The Company has made modifications to its devices in the past and may make additional modifications in the future that it believes do not or will not
require additional clearance or approvals. If the FDA disagrees, and requires new clearances or approvals for the modifications, the Company may be
required to recall and to stop marketing the modified devices, which could harm the Company’s operating results and require it to redesign its products.

The  Company  may  be  unable  to  obtain  or  maintain  international  regulatory  qualifications  or  approvals  for  its  current  or  future  products  and
indications, which could harm its business.

Sales of the Company’s products outside the U.S. are subject to foreign regulatory requirements that vary widely from country to country. In addition,
exports  of  medical  devices  from  the  U.S.  are  regulated  by  the  FDA.  Complying  with  international  regulatory  requirements  can  be  an  expensive  and
time-  consuming  process  and  approval  is  not  certain.  The  time  required  for  obtaining  clearance  or  approvals,  if  required  by  other  countries,  may  be
longer  than  that  required  for  FDA  clearance  or  approvals,  and  requirements  for  such  clearances  or  approvals  may  significantly  differ  from  FDA
requirements. The Company may be unable to obtain or maintain regulatory qualifications, clearances or approvals in other countries. The Company
may also incur significant costs in attempting to obtain and in maintaining foreign regulatory approvals or qualifications. If the Company experience
delays in receiving necessary qualifications, clearances or approvals to market its products outside the U.S., or if the Company fails to receive those
qualifications, clearances or approvals, the Company may be unable to market its products or enhancements in international markets effectively, or at all,
which could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business and growth strategy.

Any defects in the design, material or workmanship of its products may not be discovered prior to shipment to customers, which could materially
increase its expenses, adversely impact profitability and harm its business.

The  design  of  the  Company’s  products  is  complex.  To  manufacture  them  successfully,  the  Company  must  procure  quality  components  and  employ
individuals with a significant degree of technical expertise. If the Company’s designs are defective, or the material components used in its products are
subject  to  wearing  out,  or  if  suppliers  fail  to  deliver  components  to  specification,  or  if  its  employees  fail  to  properly  assemble,  test  and  package  its
products, the reliability and performance of its products could be adversely impacted.

If the Company’s products contain defects that cannot be repaired easily, inexpensively, or on a timely basis, the Company may experience:

  ●damage to the Company’s brand reputation;
  ●loss of customer orders and delay in order fulfillment;
  ●increased costs due to product repair or replacement;
  ●inability to attract new customers;
  ●diversion of resources from the Company’s manufacturing and research and development departments into the Company’s service department;
  ●changes in share-based compensation; and
  ●legal action.

The  occurrence  of  any  one  or  more  of  the  foregoing  could  materially  increase  expenses,  adversely  impact  profitability  and  harm  the  Company’s
business.

The Company's products may cause or contribute to adverse medical events or be subject to failures or malfunctions that the Company is required to
report to the FDA, and if the Company fails to do so, the Company would be subject to sanctions that could harm its reputation, business, financial
condition and results of operations. The discovery of serious safety issues with its products, or a recall of the Company's products either voluntarily
or at the direction of the FDA or another governmental authority, could have a negative impact on the Company.

The Company is subject to the FDA’s medical device reporting regulations and similar foreign regulations, which require the Company to report to the
FDA  when  the  Company  receives  or  becomes  aware  of  information  that  reasonably  suggests  that  one  or  more  of  its  products  may  have  caused  or
contributed to a death or serious injury or malfunctioned in a way that, if the malfunction were to recur, it could cause or contribute to a death or serious
injury. The timing of its obligation to report is triggered by the date the Company becomes aware of the adverse event as well as the nature of the event.
The Company may fail to report adverse events of which it becomes aware within the prescribed timeframe. The Company may also fail to recognize
that it has become aware of a reportable adverse event, especially if it is not reported to the Company as an adverse event or if it is an adverse event that
is unexpected or removed in time from the use of the product. If the Company fails to comply with its reporting obligations, the FDA could take action,
including warning letters, untitled letters, administrative actions, criminal prosecution, imposition of civil monetary penalties, revocation of its device
clearance or approval, seizure of its products or delay in clearance or approval of future products.

The  FDA  and  foreign  regulatory  bodies  have  the  authority  to  require  the  recall  of  commercialized  products  in  the  event  of  material  deficiencies  or
defects in design or manufacture of a product or in the event that a product poses an unacceptable risk to health. The FDA’s authority to require a recall
must be based on a finding that there is reasonable probability that the device could cause serious injury or death. The Company may also choose to
voluntarily recall a product if any material deficiency is found. A government-mandated or voluntary recall by the Company could occur as a result of
an  unacceptable  risk  to  health,  component  failures,  malfunctions,  manufacturing  defects,  labeling  or  design  deficiencies,  packaging  defects  or  other
deficiencies or failures to comply with applicable regulations. Product defects or other errors may occur in the future.

Depending on the corrective action the Company takes to redress a product’s deficiencies or defects, the FDA may require, or the Company may decide,
that it will need to obtain new clearances or approvals for the device before the Company may market or distribute the corrected device. Seeking such
clearances or approvals may delay its ability to replace the recalled devices in a timely manner. Moreover, if the Company does not adequately address
problems associated with its devices, the Company may face additional regulatory enforcement action, including FDA warning letters, product seizure,
injunctions, administrative penalties or civil or criminal fines.

34

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Companies are required to maintain certain records of recalls and corrections, even if they are not reportable to the FDA. The Company may initiate
voluntary  withdrawals  or  corrections  for  its  products  in  the  future  that  the  Company  determines  do  not  require  notification  of  the  FDA.  If  the  FDA
disagrees with its determinations, it could require the Company to report those actions as recalls and the Company may be subject to enforcement action.
A future recall announcement could harm its reputation with customers, potentially lead to product liability claims against the Company and negatively
affect its sales. Any corrective action, whether voluntary or involuntary, as well as defending itself in a lawsuit, will require the dedication of its time
and capital, will distract management from operating its business and may harm its reputation and financial results.

Our products may in the future be subject to product recalls that could harm its reputation, business and financial results.

Medical  devices  can  experience  performance  problems  in  the  field  that  require  review  and  possible  corrective  action.  The  occurrence  of  component
failures, manufacturing errors, software errors, design defects or labeling inadequacies affecting a medical device could lead to a government-mandated
or voluntary recall by the device manufacturer, in particular when such deficiencies may endanger health. The FDA requires that certain classifications
of recalls be reported to the FDA within 10 working days after the recall is initiated. Companies are required to maintain certain records of recalls, even
if they are not reportable to the FDA. The Company may initiate voluntary recalls involving its products in the future that the Company determines do
not require notification of the FDA. If the FDA disagrees with its determinations, they could require the Company to report those actions as recalls.
Product recalls may divert management attention and financial resources, expose the Company to product liability or other claims, harm its reputation
with customers and adversely impact its business, financial condition and results of operations.

Clinical trials may be necessary to support future product submissions to the FDA. The clinical trial process is lengthy and expensive with uncertain
outcomes, and often requires the enrollment of large numbers of patients, and suitable patients may be difficult to identify and recruit. Delays or
failures in the Company's clinical trials will prevent it from commercializing any modified or new products and will adversely affect its business,
operating results and prospects.

The  Company  has  conducted  clinical  trials  in  the  past  and  will  likely  conduct  clinical  trials  in  the  future.  Initiating  and  completing  clinical  trials
necessary to support any future product candidates, will be time-consuming and expensive and the outcome uncertain. Moreover, the results of early
clinical trials are not necessarily predictive of future results, and any product the Company advances into clinical trials may not have favorable results in
later clinical trials. The results of preclinical studies and clinical trials of its products conducted to date and ongoing or future studies and trials of its
current, planned or future products may not be predictive of the results of later clinical trials, and interim results of a clinical trial do not necessarily
predict final results. The Company's interpretation of data and results from its clinical trials do not ensure that the Company will achieve similar results
in future clinical trials. In addition, preclinical and clinical data are often susceptible to various interpretations and analyses, and many companies that
have believed their products performed satisfactorily in preclinical studies and earlier clinical trials have nonetheless failed to replicate results in later
clinical trials. Products in later stages of clinical trials may fail to show the desired safety and efficacy despite having progressed through nonclinical
studies and earlier clinical trials. Failure can occur at any stage of clinical testing. The Company's clinical studies may produce negative or inconclusive
results,  and  it  may  decide,  or  regulators  may  require  us,  to  conduct  additional  clinical  and  non-clinical  testing  in  addition  to  those  the  Company
has planned.

●the Company may be required to submit an IDE application to the FDA, which must become effective prior to commencing certain human clinical trials

of medical devices, and the FDA may reject the Company's IDE application and notify the Company that it may not begin clinical trials;

  ●regulators and other comparable foreign regulatory authorities may disagree as to the design or implementation of its clinical trials;

●regulators and/or an IRB, or other reviewing bodies may not authorize the Company or its investigators to commence a clinical trial, or to conduct or

continue a clinical trial at a prospective or specific trial site;

●the Company may not reach agreement on acceptable terms with prospective contract research organizations, or CROs, and clinical trial sites, the terms

of which can be subject to extensive negotiation and may vary significantly among different CROs and trial sites;

●clinical trials may produce negative or inconclusive results, and the Company may decide, or regulators may require the Company to conduct additional

clinical trials or abandon product development programs;

●the number of subjects or patients required for clinical trials may be larger than the Company anticipates, enrollment in these clinical trials may be

insufficient or slower than the Company anticipates, and the number of clinical trials being conducted at any given time may be high and result in fewer
available patients for any given clinical trial, or patients may drop out of these clinical trials at a higher rate than the Company anticipates;

●the Company's third-party contractors, including those manufacturing products or conducting clinical trials on the Company's behalf, may fail to comply

with regulatory requirements or meet their contractual obligations to the Company in a timely manner, or at all;

●the Company might have to suspend or terminate clinical trials for various reasons, including a finding that the subjects are being exposed to

unacceptable health risks;

●the Company may have to amend clinical trial protocols or conduct additional studies to reflect changes in regulatory requirements or guidance, which it

may be required to submit to an IRB and/or regulatory authorities for re-examination;

●regulators, IRBs, or other parties may require or recommend that the Company or its investigators suspend or terminate clinical research for various

reasons, including safety signals or noncompliance with regulatory requirements;

  ●the cost of clinical trials may be greater than the Company anticipates;
  ●clinical sites may not adhere to the clinical protocol or may drop out of a clinical trial;
  ●the Company may be unable to recruit a sufficient number of clinical trial sites;

●regulators, IRBs, or other reviewing bodies may fail to approve or subsequently find fault with its manufacturing processes or facilities of third-party

manufacturers with which the Company enters into agreement for clinical and commercial supplies, the supply of devices or other materials necessary to
conduct clinical trials may be insufficient, inadequate or not available at an acceptable cost, or the Company may experience interruptions in supply;
●approval policies or regulations of the FDA or applicable foreign regulatory agencies may change in a manner rendering the Company's clinical data

insufficient for approval;

  ●the Company's current or future products may have undesirable side effects or other unexpected characteristics; and

●impacts of regional or global public health crises including the ongoing COVID-19 pandemic could adversely affect any clinical trials the Company is
conducting or plan to conduct, including delays or difficulties in enrolling or onboarding patients, initiating clinical sites, or obtaining the requisite
regulatory approvals, interruption of key clinical trial activities, or supply chain disruptions that delay or make it more difficult or costly to obtain the
supplies and materials the Company needs for clinical trials.

35

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Any of these occurrences may significantly harm the Company's business, financial condition and prospects. In addition, many of the factors that cause,
or  lead  to,  a  delay  in  the  commencement  or  completion  of  clinical  trials  may  also  ultimately  lead  to  the  denial  of  regulatory  approval  of  its  product
candidates.

Clinical trials must be conducted in accordance with the laws and regulations of the FDA and other applicable regulatory authorities’ legal requirements,
regulations or guidelines, and are subject to oversight by these governmental agencies and IRBs at the medical institutions where the clinical trials are
conducted.  Conducting  successful  clinical  studies  will  require  the  enrollment  of  large  numbers  of  patients,  and  suitable  patients  may  be  difficult  to
identify and recruit. Patient enrollment in clinical trials and completion of patient participation and follow-up depends on many factors, including the
size of the patient population, the nature of the trial protocol, the attractiveness of, or the discomforts and risks associated with, the treatments received
by enrolled subjects, the availability of appropriate clinical trial investigators, support staff, and proximity of patients to clinical sites and able to comply
with the eligibility and exclusion criteria for participation in the clinical trial and patient compliance. For example, patients may be discouraged from
enrolling  in  its  clinical  trials  if  the  trial  protocol  requires  them  to  undergo  extensive  post-treatment  procedures  or  follow-up  to  assess  the  safety  and
effectiveness of its products or if they determine that the treatments received under the trial protocols are not attractive or involve unacceptable risks or
discomforts.

The Company depends on its collaborators and on medical institutions and CROs to conduct its clinical trials in compliance with good clinical practice
("GCP")  requirements.  To  the  extent  its  collaborators  or  the  CROs  fail  to  enroll  participants  for  its  clinical  trials,  fail  to  conduct  the  study  to  GCP
standards or are delayed for a significant time in the execution of trials, including achieving full enrollment, the Company may be affected by increased
costs, program delays or both. In addition, clinical trials that are conducted in countries outside the United States may subject the Company to further
delays and expenses as a result of increased shipment costs, additional regulatory requirements and the engagement of non-U.S. CROs, as well as expose
the Company to risks associated with clinical investigators who are unknown to the FDA, and different standards of diagnosis, screening and medical
care.

Development  of  sufficient  and  appropriate  clinical  protocols  to  demonstrate  safety  and  efficacy  are  required  and  the  Company  may  not  adequately
develop such protocols to support clearance and approval. Further, the FDA may require the Company to submit data on a greater number of patients
than the Company originally anticipated and/or for a longer follow-up period or change the data collection requirements or data analysis applicable to
the Company's clinical trials. Delays in patient enrollment or failure of patients to continue to participate in a clinical trial may cause an increase in costs
and delays in the approval and attempted commercialization of its products or result in the failure of the clinical trial. In addition, despite considerable
time  and  expense  invested  in  its  clinical  trials,  the  FDA  may  not  consider  the  Company's  data  adequate  to  demonstrate  safety  and  efficacy.  Such
increased costs and delays or failures could adversely affect its business, operating results and prospects.

The results of the Company's clinical trials may not support its product candidate claims or may result in the discovery of adverse side effects.

The  Company  cannot  be  certain  that  the  results  of  its  future  clinical  trials  will  support  its  future  product  claims  or  that  the  FDA  will  agree  with
its conclusions regarding them. Success in pre-clinical studies and early clinical trials does not ensure that later clinical trials will be successful, and the
Company  cannot  be  sure  that  the  later  trials  will  replicate  the  results  of  prior  trials  and  pre-clinical  studies.  The  clinical  trial  process  may  fail  to
demonstrate that its product candidates are safe and effective for the proposed indicated uses, which could cause the Company to abandon a product
candidate and may delay development of others. Any delay or termination of the Company's clinical trials will delay the filing of its product submissions
and, ultimately, its ability to commercialize its product candidates and generate revenues. It is also possible that patients enrolled in clinical trials will
experience adverse side effects that are not currently part of the future product’s profile.

Product liability suits could be brought against the Company due to a defective design, material or workmanship or misuse of its products and could
result in expensive and time-consuming litigation, payment of substantial damages and an increase in its insurance rates.

If the Company’s products are defectively designed, manufactured or labeled, contain defective components or are misused, the Company may become
subject  to  substantial  and  costly  litigation  by  the  Company’s  customers  or  their  patients.  Misusing  the  Company’s  products  or  failing  to  adhere  to
operating guidelines could cause significant eye and skin damage, and underlying tissue damage. In addition, if its operating guidelines are found to be
inadequate, the Company may be subject to liability. The Company has been involved, and may in the future be involved, in litigation related to the use
of its products. Product liability claims could divert management’s attention from its core business, be expensive to defend and result in sizable damage
awards against the Company. The Company may not have sufficient insurance coverage for all future claims. The Company may not be able to obtain
insurance in amounts or scope sufficient to provide the Company with adequate coverage against all potential liabilities. Any product liability claims
brought  against  the  Company,  with  or  without  merit,  could  increase  the  Company’s  product  liability  insurance  rates  or  prevent  the  Company  from
securing  continuing  coverage,  could  harm  its  reputation  in  the  industry  and  could  reduce  product  sales.  In  addition,  the  Company  historically
experienced steep increases in its product liability insurance premiums as a percentage of revenue. If its premiums continue to rise, the Company may no
longer be able to afford adequate insurance coverage.

The  Company  is  currently  involved  in  litigation  that  could  adversely  affect  the  Company’s  business  and  financial  results,  divert  management’s
attention from the Company’s business, and subject the Company to significant liabilities.

On January 31, 2020, the Company filed a lawsuit in Federal District Court in California against Lutronic Aesthetics, Inc. and any involved corporate
affiliates (“Lutronic”). The lawsuit claims include misappropriation of trade secrets in violation of the Uniform Trade Secrets Act and the Defend Trade
Secrets  Act;  Racketeer  Influenced  and  Corrupt  Organizations  Act  (“RICO”)  violations;  tortious  interference  with  contractual  relations  and  with
prospective economic advantage; unfair competition as defined by the California Business and Professions Code; and aiding and abetting the breach of
fiduciary duties and/or duty of loyalty owed by certain former Company employees. On January 28, 2020, the Company initiated legal action against
certain  former  employees  for  multiple  claims  involving  violations  of  these  former  employees’  explicit  agreements  with  the  Company,  as  well  as
violations of duties owed to the Company under California law.

In both of these actions, the Company seeks compensatory damages, equitable relief and punitive damages, as well as fees and costs related to the legal
action. At this time, the Company is unable to predict the associated costs, expenses and timeline associated therewith. The Company cannot predict
with certainty the outcome or effect of any claim or other litigation matter, and there can be no assurance as to the ultimate outcome of any litigation or
proceeding. Litigation may have a material adverse effect on the Company because of potential adverse outcomes, defense costs, the diversion of the
Company’s management’s resources, availability of insurance coverage and other factors.

36

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

If customers are not trained and/or the Company’s products are used by non-licensed practitioners, it could result in product misuse and adverse
treatment outcomes, which could harm the Company’s reputation, result in product liability litigation, distract management and result in additional
costs, all of which could harm the Company’s business.

Because  the  Company  does  not  require  training  for  users  of  its  products  and  sell  its  products  at  times  to  non-licensed  practitioners,  there  exists  an
increased  potential  for  misuse  of  the  Company’s  products,  which  could  harm  the  Company’s  reputation  and  the  Company’s  business.  U.S.  federal
regulations allow the Company to sell the Company’s products to or on the order of “licensed practitioners.” The definition of “licensed practitioners”
varies from state to state. As a result, the Company’s products may be purchased or operated by physicians with varying levels of training, and in many
states,  by  non-physicians,  including  nurse  practitioners,  chiropractors  and  technicians.  Outside  the  U.S.,  many  jurisdictions  do  not  require  specific
qualifications or training for purchasers or operators of its products. The Company does not supervise the procedures performed with the Company’s
products,  nor  does  the  Company  require  that  direct  medical  supervision  occur  that  is  determined  by  state  law.  The  Company  and  its  distributors
generally offer but do not require product training to the purchasers or operators of the Company’s products. In addition, the Company sometimes sells
its  systems  to  companies  that  rent  its  systems  to  third  parties  and  that  provide  a  technician  to  perform  the  procedures.  The  lack  of  training  and  the
purchase and use of its products by non-physicians may result in product misuse and adverse treatment outcomes, which could harm the Company’s
reputation  and  its  business,  and,  in  the  event  these  result  in  product  liability  litigation,  distract  management  and  subject  the  Company  to  liability,
including legal expenses.

Adverse conditions in the global banking industry and credit markets may adversely impact the value of the Company’s marketable investments or
impair the Company’s liquidity.

The primary objective of most of the Company’s investment activities is to preserve principal. To achieve this objective, the Company invests its excess
cash  primarily  in  money  market  funds  and  in  highly  liquid  debt  instruments  of  the  U.S.  government  and  its  agencies  and  U.S.  municipalities,  in
commercial paper and high-grade corporate debt. As of December 31, 2019, the Company’s balance in marketable investments was $7.6 million. The
longer the duration of a security, the more susceptible it is to changes in market interest rates and bond yields. As yields increase, those securities with a
lower yield-at-cost show a mark-to-market unrealized loss. For example, assuming a hypothetical increase in interest rates of one percentage point, there
would not have any adverse impact the Company’s earnings. As a result, changes in the market interest rates will affect its future net income (loss).

The  Company’s  manufacturing  operations  are  dependent  upon  third-party  suppliers,  making  its  vulnerable  to  supply  shortages  and  price
fluctuations, which could harm its business.

Many of the components and materials that comprise the Company’s products are currently manufactured by a limited number of suppliers. In addition,
all  of  the  Company’s  skincare  products  are  manufactured  by  its  sole  supplier,  ZO.  A  supply  interruption  or  an  increase  in  demand  beyond  the
Company’s current suppliers’ capabilities could harm the Company’s ability to manufacture its products until a new source of supply is identified and
qualified. The Company’s reliance on these suppliers subjects the Company to a number of risks that could harm its business, including:

  ●interruption of supply resulting from modifications to or discontinuation of a supplier’s operations;
  ●delays in product shipments resulting from uncorrected defects, reliability issues or a supplier’s variation in a component;
  ●lack of long-term supply arrangements for key components with the Company’s suppliers;
  ●inability to obtain adequate supply in a timely manner, or on reasonable terms;

●inability to redesign one or more components in the Company’s systems in the event that a supplier discontinues manufacturing such components and

the Company’s inability to sources it from other suppliers on reasonable terms;

  ●difficulty locating and qualifying alternative suppliers for the Company’s components in a timely manner;

●production delays related to the evaluation and testing of products from alternative suppliers and corresponding regulatory qualifications; and delay in

supplier deliveries.

Any  interruption  in  the  supply  of  components  or  materials,  or  the  Company’s  inability  to  obtain  substitute  components  or  materials  from  alternate
sources at acceptable prices in a timely manner, could impair its ability to meet the demand of the Company’s customers, which would have an adverse
effect on the Company’s business.

Risks related to the reduction or interruption in supply and an inability to develop alternative sources for supply may adversely affect the Company’s
manufacturing operations and related product sales.

The Company maintains manufacturing operations at its facility in Brisbane, California, and purchases many of the components and raw materials used
in manufacturing these products from numerous suppliers in various countries. Any problem affecting a supplier (whether due to external or internal
causes) could have a negative impact on the Company.

In a few limited cases, specific components and raw materials are purchased from primary or main suppliers (or in some cases, a single supplier) for
reasons  related  to  quality  assurance,  cost-effectiveness  ratio  and  availability.  While  the  Company  works  closely  with  its  suppliers  to  ensure  supply
continuity,  the  Company  cannot  guarantee  that  its  efforts  will  always  be  successful.  Moreover,  due  to  strict  standards  and  regulations  governing  the
manufacture and marketing its products, it may not be able to quickly locate new supply sources in response to a supply reduction or interruption, with
negative effects on its ability to manufacture its products effectively and in a timely fashion.

37

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

The Company manufactures its goods at the Brisbane California site, as well as dual sourcing several product platforms at contract manufacturing
shops  for  redundancy.  A  few  of  the  product  platforms  such  as  Enlighten  and  excel  HR  are  only  capable  of  being  produced  at  the  single  site  in
Brisbane, and as such the occurrence of a catastrophic disaster or other similar event could cause damage to its facilities and equipment, which
might require the Company to cease or curtail sales of these sole sourced platforms.

The Company is vulnerable to damage from various types of disasters, including fires, earthquakes, terrorist acts, floods, power losses, communications
failures,  pandemics  and  similar  events.  If  any  such  disaster  were  to  occur,  the  Company  may  not  be  able  to  operate  the  Company’s  business  at  the
Company’s facility in Brisbane, California. Before the Company could manufacture products from a replacement facility, the Company’s manufacturing
facilities which require regulatory agency approval, could require significant delays to obtain regulatory agency’s approval. The insurance the Company
maintains may not be adequate to cover the Company’s losses resulting from disasters or other business interruptions. Therefore, any such catastrophe
could seriously harm the Company’s business and consolidated results of operations.

Intellectual  property  rights  may  not  provide  adequate  protection  for  some  or  all  of  the  Company’s  products,  which  may  permit  third  parties  to
compete against the Company more effectively.

The  Company  relies  on  patent,  copyright,  trade  secret  and  trademark  laws  and  confidentiality  agreements  to  protect  the  Company’s  technology  and
products. As of January 25, 2021, the Company had issued 26 U.S. patents and 5 pending U.S. patent applications. Some of the Company’s components,
such as the Company’s laser module, electronic control system and high-voltage electronics, are not, and in the future may not be, protected by patents.
Additionally, the Company’s patent applications may not issue as patents or, if issued, may not issue in a form that will be advantageous to us. Any
patents the Company obtains may be challenged, invalidated or legally circumvented by third parties. Consequently, competitors could market products
and  use  manufacturing  processes  that  are  substantially  similar  to,  or  superior  to,  the  Company’s.  The  Company  may  not  be  able  to  prevent  the
unauthorized  disclosure  or  use  of  the  Company’s  technical  knowledge  or  other  trade  secrets  by  consultants,  vendors,  former  employees  or  current
employees,  despite  the  existence  generally  of  confidentiality  agreements  and  other  contractual  restrictions.  Monitoring  unauthorized  uses  and
disclosures of the Company’s intellectual property is difficult, and the Company does not know whether the steps it has taken to protect the Company’s
intellectual property will be effective. Moreover, the laws of many foreign countries will not protect the Company’s intellectual property rights to the
same extent as the laws of the U.S. 

The absence of complete intellectual property protection exposes the Company to a greater risk of direct competition. Competitors could purchase one
of the Company’s products and attempt to replicate some or all of the competitive advantages the Company derives from the Company’s development
efforts, design around the Company’s protected technology, or develop their own competitive technologies that fall outside of the Company’s intellectual
property  rights.  If  the  Company’s  intellectual  property  is  not  adequately  protected  against  competitors’  products  and  methods,  the  Company’s
competitive position and its business could be adversely affected.

The Company may be involved in future costly intellectual property litigation, which could impact its future business and financial performance.

The Company’s competitors or other patent holders may assert that the Company’s present or future products and the methods the Company employs are
covered by their patents. In addition, the Company does not know whether its competitors own or will obtain patents that they may claim prevent, limit
or interfere with the Company’s ability to make, use, sell or import the Company’s products. For example, the Company received a letter from InMode
Ltd.’s counsel indicating that the Secret RF product which it distributes in the U.S. on behalf of ILOODA Co. Ltd., a Korean company violates U.S.
Patent No. 10,799,285, which was issued to InMode in October 2020. If the Company is unable to resolve this matter, it may have to discontinue selling
the  Secret  RF  product  and  may  become  involved  in  litigation  or  liable  for  damages  as  a  result  of  its  sales  of  the  Secret  RF  product.  Although  the
Company  may  seek  to  resolve  any  potential  future  claims  or  actions  such  as  this  one,  it  may  not  be  able  to  do  so  on  reasonable  terms,  or  at  all.  If,
following a successful third-party action for infringement, the Company cannot obtain a license or redesign the Company’s products, it may have to
stop  selling  the  applicable  products  and  the  Company’s  business  would  suffer  as  a  result.  In  addition,  a  court  could  require  the  Company  to  pay
substantial  damages,  and  prohibit  the  Company  from  using  technologies  essential  to  the  Company’s  products,  any  of  which  would  have  a  material
adverse effect on the Company’s business, results of operations and financial condition.

The Company may become involved in litigation not only as a result of alleged infringement of a third party’s intellectual property rights but also to
protect the Company’s own intellectual property. For example, the Company has been involved in litigation to protect the trademark rights associated
with its company name or the names of its products. Infringement and other intellectual property claims, with or without merit, can be expensive and
time- consuming to litigate, and could divert management’s attention from its core business.

The expense and potential unavailability of insurance coverage for the Company’s customers could adversely affect its ability to sell its products,
and therefore adversely affect its financial condition.

Some of the Company’s customers and prospective customers have had difficulty procuring or maintaining liability insurance to cover their operation
and  use  of  its  products.  Medical  malpractice  carriers  are  withdrawing  coverage  in  certain  states  or  substantially  increasing  premiums.  If  this  trend
continues or worsens, the Company’s customers may discontinue using the Company’s products and potential customers may opt against purchasing
laser-based products due to the cost or inability to procure insurance coverage. The unavailability of insurance coverage for the Company’s customers
and prospects could adversely affect its ability to sell its products, and that could harm its financial condition.

From time to time the Company may become subject to income tax audits or similar proceedings, and as a result the Company may incur additional
costs and expenses or owe additional taxes, interest and penalties that may negatively impact its operating results.

The  Company  is  subject  to  income  taxes  in  the  U.S.  and  certain  foreign  jurisdictions  where  it  operates  through  a  subsidiary,  including  Australia,
Belgium,  Canada,  France,  Germany,  Hong  Kong,  Japan,  Spain,  Switzerland,  Italy  and  the  United  Kingdom.  The  Company’s  determination  of  its  tax
liability is subject to review by applicable domestic and foreign tax authorities.

The Company is going through sales tax audit as of December 31, 2020 and underwent an income tax audits for its German and Japanese subsidiaries
for the tax years December 31, 2011 through 2018. Although these income tax audits did not result in any adjustments, the final timing and resolution of
any  future  tax  examinations  are  subject  to  significant  uncertainty  and  could  result  in  the  Company’s  having  to  pay  amounts  to  the  applicable  tax
authority in order to resolve examination of its tax positions. An increase or decrease of tax related to tax examination resolution could result in a change
in the Company’s income tax accrual and could negatively impact its financial position, results of operations or cash flows.

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
38

Table of Contents

The  Company  may  be  adversely  affected  by  changes  in  U.S.  tax  laws,  importation  taxes  and  other  changes  that  may  be  imposed  by  the  current
administration.

The Company is subject to taxes in the U.S. and other jurisdictions. Tax rates in these jurisdictions may be subject to significant change due to economic
and/or political conditions. A number of other factors may also impact the Company’s future effective tax rate including:

  ●the jurisdictions in which profits are determined to be earned and taxed;
  ●the resolution of issues arising from tax audits with various tax authorities;
  ●changes in valuation of the Company’s deferred tax assets and liabilities;
  ●increases in expenses not deductible for tax purposes, including write-offs and impairment of goodwill in connection with acquisitions;
  ●changes in availability of tax credits, tax holidays, and tax deductions;
  ●changes in share-based compensation; and
  ●changes in tax laws or the interpretation of such tax laws and changes in generally accepted accounting principles.

In  the  U.S.,  the  Patient  Protection  and  Affordable  Care  Act,  as  amended  by  the  Health  Care  and  Education  Reconciliation  Act  (collectively,  the
“Affordable Care Act”), for example, has the potential to significantly impact the pharmaceutical and medical device industries. The Affordable Care
Act imposed, among other things, an annual excise tax of 2.3% on any entity that manufactures or imports medical devices offered for sale in the U.S.
Due  to  subsequent  legislative  amendments  the  excise  tax  was  suspended  for  the  period  January  1,  2016  to  December  31,  2019.  The  excise  tax  was
repealed at the end of 2019. The repeal of the excise tax had no material impact on the Company’s financial condition and cash flows.

Any  acquisitions  that  the  Company  makes  could  result  in  operating  difficulties,  dilution,  and  other  consequences  that  may  adversely  impact  the
Company’s business and results of operations.

While  the  Company  from  time  to  time  evaluates  potential  acquisitions  of  businesses,  products  and  technologies,  and  anticipates  continuing  to  make
these evaluations, the Company has no present understandings, commitments or agreements with respect to any material acquisitions or collaborative
projects. The Company may not be able to identify appropriate acquisition candidates or strategic partners, or successfully negotiate, finance or integrate
any businesses, products or technologies that the Company acquire.

The Company has limited experience as a team with acquiring companies and products. Furthermore, the integration of any acquisition and management
of any collaborative project may divert management’s time and resources from the Company’s core business and disrupt the Company’s operations and
it may incur significant legal, accounting and banking fees in connection with such a transaction. Acquisitions could diminish the Company’s available
cash  balances  for  other  uses,  result  in  the  incurrence  of  debt,  contingent  liabilities,  or  amortization  expenses,  and  restructuring  charges.  Also,  the
anticipated benefits or value of its acquisitions or investments may not materialize and could result in an impairment of goodwill and/or purchased long-
lived assets.

The  Company’s  failure  to  address  these  risks  or  other  problems  encountered  in  connection  with  the  Company’s  past  or  future  acquisitions  and
investments could cause the Company to fail to realize the anticipated benefits of such acquisitions or investments, incur unanticipated liabilities, and
harm the Company’s business and the Company’s financial condition or results.

The Company’s failure to comply with rules relating to bribery, foreign corrupt practices, and privacy and security laws may subject the Company to
penalties and adversely impact its reputation and business operations.

  The Company’s business is subject to regulation and oversight worldwide including:

●the FCPA, which prohibits corporations and individuals from paying, offering to pay or authorizing the payment of anything of value to any foreign

government official, government staff member, political party or political candidate in an attempt to obtain or retain business or to otherwise influence a
person working in an official capacity;

●the  UK  Bribery  Act,  which  prohibits  both  domestic  and  international  bribery,  as  well  as  bribery  across  both  public  and  private  sectors;  and  bribery
provisions  contained  in  the  German  Criminal  Code,  which,  pursuant  to  draft  legislation  being  prepared  by  the  German  government,  may  make  the
corruption and corruptibility of physicians in private practice and other healthcare professionals a criminal offense;

●Health Insurance Portability and Accountability Act of 1996, as amended by The Health Information Technology for Economic and Clinical Health Act,

which governs the conduct of certain electronic healthcare transactions and protects the security and privacy of protected health information; and

●analogous state and foreign law equivalents of each of the above laws, such as state laws that require device companies to comply with the industry’s
voluntary compliance guidelines and the applicable compliance guidance promulgated by the federal government; and state laws governing the privacy
and security of health information in certain circumstances, many of which differ from each other in significant ways and may not have the same effect,
thus complicating compliance efforts.

39

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

The risk of being found in violation of these laws is increased by the fact that many of them have not been fully interpreted by the regulatory authorities
or  the  courts,  and  their  provisions  are  open  to  a  variety  of  interpretations.  Because  of  the  breadth  of  these  laws  and  the  narrowness  of  the  statutory
exceptions  and  safe  harbors  available  under  such  laws,  it  is  possible  that  some  of  the  Company’s  business  activities,  including  the
Company’s relationships with practitioners and thought leaders worldwide, some of whom recommend, purchase and/or use the Company’s devices, as
well as the Company’s sales agents and distributors, could be subject to challenge under one or more of such laws. The Company is also exposed to the
risk that the Company’s employees, independent contractors, principal investigators, consultants, vendors, independent sales agents and distributors may
engage in fraudulent or other illegal activity. While the Company has policies and procedures in place prohibiting such activity, misconduct by these
parties could include, among other infractions or violations, intentional, reckless and/or negligent conduct or unauthorized activity that violates FDA
regulations, including those laws that require the reporting of true, complete and accurate information to the FDA, manufacturing standards, laws that
require  the  true,  complete  and  accurate  reporting  of  financial  information  or  data  or  other  commercial  or  regulatory  laws  or  requirements.  It  is  not
always possible to identify and deter misconduct by the Company’s employees and other third parties, and the precautions the Company takes to detect
and prevent this activity may not be effective in controlling unknown or unmanaged risks or losses or in protecting the Company from governmental
investigations or other actions or lawsuits stemming from a failure to be in compliance with such laws or regulations.

There  are  similar  laws  and  regulations  applicable  to  the  Company  outside  the  U.S.,  all  of  which  are  subject  to  evolving  interpretations.  Global
enforcement of anti- corruption laws, including but not limited to the UK Bribery Act, the Brazil Clean Companies Act, and continued enforcement in
the  Europe,  Middle  East  and  Asia  Pacific  has  increased  substantially  in  recent  years,  with  more  frequent  voluntary  self-disclosures  by  companies,
aggressive investigations and enforcement proceedings by governmental agencies, and assessment of significant fines and penalties against companies
and individuals. The Company’s operations create the risk of unauthorized payments or offers of payments by one of its employees, consultants, sales
agents, or distributors because these parties are not always subject to its control. It is the Company’s policy to implement safeguards to discourage these
practices; however, its existing safeguards and any future improvements may prove to be less than effective, and its employees, consultants, sales agents,
or  distributors  may  engage  in  conduct  for  which  the  Company  might  be  held  responsible.  Any  alleged  or  actual  violations  of  these  regulations  may
subject the Company to government scrutiny, severe criminal or civil sanctions and other liabilities, and could negatively affect its business, reputation,
operating results, and financial condition.

On  July  27,  2017,  the  United  Kingdom’s  Financial  Conduct  Authority  announced  that  it  intends  to  stop  persuading  or  compelling  banks  to  submit
LIBOR rates after 2021. These reforms may cause LIBOR to cease to exist, new methods of calculating LIBOR to be established or the establishment of
an alternative reference rate(s). These consequences cannot be entirely predicted and could have an adverse impact on the market value for or value of
LIBOR-linked  securities,  loans,  and  other  financial  obligations  or  extensions  of  credit  held  by  the  Company.  Changes  in  market  interest  rates  may
influence returns on financial investments and could reduce its earnings and cash flows.

While the Company believes it has a strong culture of compliance and adequate systems of control, and it seeks continuously to improve its systems of
internal controls and to remedy any weaknesses identified, there can be no assurance that the policies and procedures will be followed at all times or will
effectively  detect  and  prevent  violations  of  the  applicable  laws  by  one  or  more  of  its  employees,  consultants,  agents  or  partners  and,  as  a  result,  the
Company may be subject to penalties and material adverse consequences on its business, financial condition or results of operations.

  Risks Related to the Notes

Although  the  notes  are  referred  to  as  convertible  senior  notes,  they  are  effectively  subordinated  to  any  of  the  Company's  secured  debt  and  any
liabilities of its subsidiaries.

The notes will be the Company's senior unsecured obligations and will rank:

  ●senior in right of payment to all of its indebtedness that is expressly subordinated in right of payment to the notes;
  ●equal in right of payment to all of its unsecured indebtedness that is not so subordinated;

●effectively  junior  to  any  of  its  secured  indebtedness  to  the  extent  of  the  value  of  the  assets  securing  such  indebtedness,  including  any  amount

outstanding under the Company's senior credit facility; and

  ●structurally junior to all indebtedness and other liabilities of its current or future subsidiaries (including trade payables).

In the event of the Company's bankruptcy, liquidation reorganization or other winding up, the Company's assets that secure secured indebtedness will be
available to pay obligations on the notes only after all such secured indebtedness has been repaid in full from such assets. There may not be sufficient
assets remaining to pay amounts due on any or all of the notes then outstanding.

In addition the notes are the Company's obligations exclusively and are not guaranteed by any of its subsidiaries. A portion of the Company's operations
are  conducted  through,  and  a  portion  of  its  consolidated  assets  are  held  by  its  subsidiaries.  Accordingly,  the  Company's  ability  to  service  its  debt,
including  the  notes,  depends,  in  part,  on  the  results  of  operations  of  its  subsidiaries  and  upon  the  ability  of  such  subsidiaries  to  provide  the
Company  with  cash,  whether  in  the  form  of  dividends,  loans  or  otherwise,  to  pay  amounts  due  on  its  obligations,  including  the  notes.  The
Company's subsidiaries are separate and distinct legal entities and have no obligation contingent or otherwise, to make payments on the notes or to make
any funds available for that purpose. The Company's right to receive any assets of any of its subsidiaries upon such subsidiary’s bankruptcy, liquidation
or  reorganization  and,  therefore,  the  right  of  the  holders  of  notes  to  participate  in  those  assets,  will  be  subject  to  prior  claims  of  creditors  of  the
subsidiary,  including  trade  creditors,  and  such  subsidiary  may  not  have  sufficient  assets  remaining  to  make  any  payments  to  the  Company  as  a
shareholder or otherwise. In addition, dividends, loans or other distributions to the Company from such subsidiaries may be subject to contractual and
other  restrictions  and  are  subject  to  other  business  and  tax  considerations.  The  indenture  governing  the  notes  will  not  prohibit  the  Company  from
incurring  additional  senior  debt  or  secured  debt,  nor  will  it  prohibit  any  of  the  Company's  current  or  future  subsidiaries  from  incurring  additional
liabilities.

As of December 31, 2020, the Company had $7.2 million of indebtedness for borrowed money outstanding, all of which would be effectively senior to
the  notes  to  the  extent  of  the  collateral  securing  such  indebtedness,  and  its  subsidiaries  had  no  indebtedness  or  other  liabilities  (after  excluding
intercompany obligations and liabilities of a type not required to be reflected on a balance sheet of such subsidiaries in accordance with GAAP). 

40

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Regulatory actions and other events may adversely affect the trading price and liquidity of the notes.

The Company expects that many investors in, and potential purchasers of, the notes will employ or seek to employ, a convertible arbitrage strategy with
respect  to  the  notes.  Investors  would  typically  implement  such  a  strategy  by  selling  short  the  common  stock  underlying  the  notes  and  dynamically
adjusting  their  short  position  while  continuing  to  hold  the  notes.  Investors  may  also  implement  this  type  of  strategy  by  entering  into  swaps  on  its
common stock in lieu of or in addition to short selling the common stock.

The  SEC  and  other  regulatory  and  self-regulatory  authorities  have  implemented  various  rules  and  taken  certain  actions,  and  may  in  the  future  adopt
additional rules and take other actions, that may impact those engaging in short selling activity involving equity securities (including its common stock).
Such rules and actions include Rule 201 of SEC Regulation SHO, the adoption by the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority, Inc. and the national
securities  exchanges  of  a  “Limit  Up-Limit  Down”  program,  the  imposition  of  market-wide  circuit  breakers  that  halt  trading  of  securities  for  certain
periods following specific market declines, and the implementation of certain regulatory reforms required by the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and
Consumer Protection Act of 2010. Any governmental or regulatory action that restricts the ability of investors in or potential purchasers of, the notes to
effect short sales of the Company's common stock, borrow its common stock or enter into swaps on the Company's common stock could adversely affect
the trading price and the liquidity of the notes.

Volatility in the market price and trading volume of the Company's common stock could adversely impact the trading price of the notes.

The Company expects that the trading price of the notes will be significantly affected by the market price of its common stock. The stock market in
recent years has experienced significant price and volume fluctuations that have often been unrelated to the operating performance of companies. The
market price of the Company's common stock could fluctuate significantly for many reasons, including in response to the risks described in this section,
elsewhere  in  this  offering  memorandum  or  the  documents  incorporated  by  reference  in  this  offering  memorandum  or  for  reasons  unrelated  to
its operations, many of which are beyond the Company's control, such as reports by industry analysts, investor perceptions or negative announcements
by its customers, competitors or suppliers regarding their own performance, as well as industry conditions and general financial, economic and political
instability. A decrease in the market price of the Company's common stock would likely adversely impact the trading price of the notes. The market
price of the Company's common stock could also be affected by possible sales of its common stock by investors who view the notes as a more attractive
means of equity participation in the Company and by hedging or arbitrage trading activity that the Company expects to develop involving its common
stock. This trading activity could, in turn, affect the trading price of the notes.

The Company may still incur substantially more debt or take other actions which would intensify the risks discussed above.

The Company and its subsidiaries may incur substantial additional debt in the future, subject to the restrictions contained in its existing and future debt
agreements,  some  of  which  may  be  secured  debt.  The  Company  will  not  be  restricted  under  the  terms  of  the  indenture  governing  the  notes  from
incurring additional debt, securing existing or future debt, recapitalizing its debt, repurchasing its stock, pledging its assets, making investments, paying
dividends, guaranteeing debt or taking a number of other actions that are not limited by the terms of the indenture governing the notes that could have
the effect of diminishing the Company's ability to make payments on the notes when due.

The  Company  may  not  have  the  ability  to  raise  the  funds  necessary  to  settle  conversions  of  the  notes  in  cash  or  to  repurchase  the  notes  upon  a
fundamental change, and its future debt may contain limitations on its ability to pay cash upon conversion or repurchase of the notes.

Holders of the notes will have the right to require the Company to repurchase all or a portion of their notes upon the occurrence of a fundamental change
before the maturity date at a repurchase price equal to 100% of the principal amount of the notes to be repurchased, plus accrued and unpaid interest, if
any. In addition, upon conversion of the notes, unless the Company elects to deliver solely shares of its common stock to settle such conversion (other
than paying cash in lieu of delivering any fractional share), the Company will be required to settle a portion or all of its conversion obligation in respect
of  the  notes  being  converted  in  cash.  Moreover,  the  Company  will  be  required  to  repay  the  notes  in  cash  at  their  maturity  unless  earlier  converted,
redeemed  or  repurchased.  However,  the  Company  may  not  have  enough  available  cash  or  be  able  to  obtain  financing  at  the  time  the  Company
is required to make repurchases of notes surrendered therefor or pay cash with respect to notes being converted or at their maturity.

In addition, the Company's ability to repurchase notes or to pay cash upon conversions of notes or at their maturity may be limited by law, regulatory
authority or agreements governing its future indebtedness. The Company's failure to repurchase notes at a time when the repurchase is required by the
indenture or to pay cash upon conversions of notes or at their maturity as required by the indenture would constitute a default under the indenture. A
default under the indenture or the fundamental change itself could also lead to a default under agreements governing the Company's existing and future
indebtedness. Moreover, the occurrence of a fundamental change under the indenture could constitute an event of default under any such agreement. If
the payment of the related indebtedness were to be accelerated after any applicable notice or grace periods, the Company may not have sufficient funds
to repay the indebtedness.

The conditional conversion feature of the notes, if triggered, may adversely affect the Company's financial condition and operating results.

In the event the conditional conversion feature of the notes is triggered, holders of the notes will be entitled to convert their notes at any time during
specified  periods  at  their  option.  If  one  or  more  holders  elect  to  convert  their  notes,  unless  the  Company  elects  to  satisfy  the  Company's  conversion
obligation by delivering solely shares of its common stock (other than paying cash in lieu of delivering any fractional share), the Company would be
required to settle a portion or all of its conversion obligation in cash, which could adversely affect the company's liquidity. In addition, even if holders of
notes  do  not  elect  to  convert  their  notes,  the  Company  could  be  required  under  applicable  accounting  rules  to  reclassify  all  or  a  portion  of  the
outstanding principal of the notes as a current rather than long-term liability, which would result in a material reduction of its net working capital.

41

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

The accounting method for the notes could adversely affect the Company's financial condition and operating results.

The  accounting  method  for  initially  reflecting  the  notes  on  the  company's  balance  sheet,  accruing  interest  expense  for  the  notes  and  reflecting  the
underlying shares of the Company's common stock in its reported diluted earnings per share may adversely affect its reported earnings and financial
condition.

The Company expects that, under current accounting principles, the initial liability carrying amount of the notes will be the fair value of a similar debt
instrument that does not have a conversion feature, valued using its cost of capital for straight, unconvertible debt. The Company expects to reflect the
difference  between  the  net  proceeds  from  this  offering  and  the  initial  carrying  amount  as  a  debt  discount  for  accounting  purposes,  which  will  be
amortized into interest expense over the term of the notes. As a result of this amortization, the interest expense that the Company expects to recognize
for  the  notes  for  accounting  purposes  will  be  greater  than  the  cash  interest  payments  the  Company  will  pay  on  the  notes,  which  will  result  in  lower
reported income or higher reported losses. The lower reported income or higher reported losses resulting from this accounting treatment could depress
the trading price of its common stock and the notes.

However,  in  August  2020,  the  Financial  Accounting  Standards  Board  published  an  Accounting  Standards  Update,  or  ASU  2020-06,  eliminating  the
separate accounting for the debt and equity components as described above. ASU 2020-06 will be effective for SEC-reporting entities for fiscal years
beginning after December 15, 2021 (or, in the case of smaller reporting companies, December 15, 2023), including interim periods within those fiscal
years.  However,  early  adoption  is  permitted  in  certain  circumstances  for  fiscal  years  beginning  after  December  15,  2020,  including  interim  periods
within those fiscal years.

When ASU 2020-06 is adopted by the Company, the Company expects the elimination of the separate accounting described above to reduce the interest
expense that the Company expects to recognize for the notes for accounting purposes. In addition, ASU 2020-06 eliminates the use of the treasury stock
method  for  convertible  instruments  that  can  be  settled  in  whole  or  in  part  with  equity,  and  instead  require  application  of  the  “if-converted”  method.
Under that method, diluted earnings per share would generally be calculated assuming that all the notes were converted solely into shares of common
stock  at  the  beginning  of  the  reporting  period,  unless  the  result  would  be  anti-dilutive.  The  application  of  the  if-converted  method  may  reduce  the
Company's reported diluted earnings per share.

Furthermore,  if  any  of  the  conditions  to  the  convertibility  of  the  notes  is  satisfied,  then  the  Company  may  be  required  under  applicable  accounting
standards to reclassify the liability carrying value of the notes as a current, rather than a long-term, liability. This reclassification could be required even
if no noteholders convert their notes and could materially reduce the Company's reported working capital.

Holders of notes will not be entitled to any rights with respect to the Company's common stock, but they will be subject to all changes made with
respect to the Company's common stock to the extent the Company satisfies its conversion obligation, in whole or in part, with shares of its common
stock.

Holders of notes will not be entitled to any rights with respect to the Company's common stock (including, without limitation, voting rights and rights to
receive any dividends or other distributions on its common stock) prior to the conversion date relating to such notes (if the Company has elected to settle
the conversion by delivering solely shares of its common stock (other than paying cash in lieu of delivering any fractional share)) or the last trading day
of the observation period (if the Company elects to pay and deliver, as the case may be, a combination of cash and shares of its common stock in respect
of the relevant conversion), but holders of notes will be subject to all changes affecting the Company's common stock. For example, if an amendment is
proposed to the Company's certificate of incorporation or bylaws requiring stockholder approval and the record date for determining the stockholders of
record entitled to vote on the amendment occurs prior to the conversion date related to a holder’s conversion of its notes (if the Company has elected to
settle the relevant conversion by delivering solely shares of its common stock (other than paying cash in lieu of delivering any fractional share)) or the
last trading day of the observation period (if the Company elects to pay and deliver, as the case may be, a combination of cash and shares of its common
stock in respect of the relevant conversion), such holder will not be entitled to vote on the amendment, although such holder will nevertheless be subject
to any changes affecting its common stock.

The conditional conversion feature of the notes could result in holders receiving less than the value of the Company's common stock into which the
notes would otherwise be convertible.

Prior  to  the  close  of  business  on  the  business  day  immediately  preceding  December  15,  2025,  holders  may  convert  their  notes  only  if  specified
conditions are met. If the specific conditions for conversion are not met, holders will not be able to convert their notes, and holders may be unable to
receive  the  value  of  the  cash,  common  stock  or  a  combination  of  cash  and  common  stock,  as  applicable,  into  which  their  notes  would  otherwise  be
convertible.

Upon conversion of the notes, holders may receive less valuable consideration than expected because the value of the Company's common stock may
decline after holders exercise their conversion right but before the Company satisfies it conversion obligation.

Under the notes, a converting holder will be exposed to fluctuations in the value of the Company's common stock during the period from the date such
holder surrenders notes for conversion until the date the Company satisfies its conversion obligation.

Upon  conversion  of  the  notes,  the  Company  will  satisfy  its  conversion  obligation  by  paying  or  delivering,  as  the  case  may  be,  cash,  shares  of
its common stock, or a combination of cash and shares of its common stock, at the Company's option. If the Company satisfies its conversion obligation
solely in cash or through payment and delivery, as the case may be, of a combination of cash and shares of its common stock, the amount of cash and
shares of common stock, if any, due upon conversion will be based on a daily conversion value calculated on a proportionate basis for each trading day
in a 40 trading day observation period. This period would be: (i) subject to clause (ii), if the relevant conversion date occurs prior to December 15, 2025,
the  40  consecutive  trading  day  period  beginning  on  and  including,  the  second  trading  day  immediately  succeeding  such  conversion  date;  (ii)  if  the
relevant conversion date occurs during a redemption period, the 40 consecutive trading days beginning on and including, the 41st scheduled trading day
immediately preceding the date that is specified as the redemption date in the related notice of redemption; and (iii) subject to clause (ii), if the relevant
conversion  date  occurs  on  or  after  December  15,  2025,  the  40  consecutive  trading  days  beginning  on  and  including,  the  41st  scheduled  trading  day
immediately  preceding  the  maturity  date.  Accordingly,  if  the  price  of  the  Company's  common  stock  decreases  during  this  period,  the  value  of
consideration holders receive will be adversely affected. In addition, if the market price of the Company's common stock at the end of such period is
below  the  average  of  the  daily  volume  weighted-average  prices  of  the  Company's  common  stock  during  such  period,  the  value  of  any  shares  of  the

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Company's common stock that holders will receive in satisfaction of its conversion obligation will be less than the value used to determine the number
of shares that holders will receive.

If  the  Company  elects  to  satisfy  its  conversion  obligation  solely  in  shares  of  the  Company's  common  stock  upon  conversion  of  the  notes,  the
Company will be required to deliver the shares of its common stock, together with cash for any fractional share, on the second business day following
the  relevant  conversion  date.  Accordingly,  if  the  price  of  the  Company's  common  stock  decreases  during  this  period,  the  value  of  the  shares  that
holders receive will be adversely affected and would be less than the conversion value of the notes on the conversion date.

42

 
 
Table of Contents

The notes are not protected by restrictive covenants.

The indenture governing the notes will not contain any financial or operating covenants or restrictions on the payments of dividends, the incurrence of
indebtedness or the issuance or repurchase of securities by the Company or any of its subsidiaries. The indenture will not contain any covenants or other
provisions to afford protection to holders of the notes in the event of a fundamental change or other corporate transaction involving the Company subject
to certain exceptions.

The increase in the conversion rate for notes converted in connection with a make-whole fundamental change or during a redemption period may
not adequately compensate holders for any lost value of their notes as a result of such transaction or redemption.

If a make-whole fundamental change occurs prior to the maturity date or upon its issuance of a notice of redemption the Company will, under certain
circumstances, increase the conversion rate by a number of additional shares of its common stock for notes converted in connection with such make-
whole fundamental change or during the related redemption period. The increase in the conversion rate will be determined based on the date on which
the specified corporate transaction becomes effective or the redemption notice date, as applicable, and the price paid (or deemed to be paid) per share of
the  Company's  common  stock  in  such  transaction  or  on  such  redemption  notice  date.  The  increase  in  the  conversion  rate  for  notes  converted  in
connection with a make-whole fundamental change or during a redemption period may not adequately compensate holders for any lost value of their
notes as a result of such transaction or redemption. Furthermore, if the Company calls only a portion of the outstanding notes for redemption, only those
notes called (or deemed called) for redemption will become convertible as a result of such call for redemption and only the conversion rate of notes
converted in connection with such notice of redemption will be increased. Accordingly, notes not called for redemption will not become convertible if
not otherwise convertible at such time and will remain outstanding, and may have reduced liquidity and a resulting reduced trading price. 

Our obligation to increase the conversion rate for notes converted in connection with a make-whole fundamental change or during a redemption period
could be considered a penalty, in which case the enforceability thereof would be subject to general principles of reasonableness and equitable remedies.

The conversion rate of the notes may not be adjusted for all dilutive events.

The conversion rate of the notes is subject to adjustment for certain events, including, but not limited to, the issuance of certain stock dividends on the
Company's common stock, the issuance of certain rights or warrants, subdivisions, combinations, distributions of capital stock, indebtedness, or assets,
cash dividends and certain issuer tender or exchange offers. However, the conversion rate will not be adjusted for other events, such as a third-party
tender or exchange offer or an issuance of the Company's common stock for cash, that may adversely affect the trading price of the notes or its common
stock. An event that adversely affects the value of the notes may occur, and that event may not result in an adjustment to the conversion rate.

Provisions in the indenture governing the notes may deter or prevent a business combination that may be favorable to holders.

If a fundamental change occurs prior to the maturity date, holders of the notes will have the right, at their option, to require the Company to repurchase
all  or  a  portion  of  their  notes.  In  addition,  if  a  make-whole  fundamental  change  occurs  prior  the  maturity  date,  the  Company  will  in  some  cases  be
required  to  increase  the  conversion  rate  for  a  holder  that  elects  to  convert  its  notes  in  connection  with  such  make-whole  fundamental  change.
Furthermore, the indenture governing the notes will prohibit the Company from engaging in certain mergers or acquisitions unless, among other things,
the surviving entity assumes the Company's obligations under the notes. These and other provisions in the indenture could deter or prevent a third party
from acquiring the Company even when the acquisition may be favorable to holders.

The capped call transactions may affect the value of the notes and the Company's common stock.

In  connection  with  the  pricing  of  the  notes,  the  Company  intend  to  enter  into  capped  call  transactions  with  the  counterparties.  The  capped  call
transactions  will  cover,  subject  to  customary  adjustments,  the  number  of  shares  of  the  Company's  common  stock  initially  underlying  the  notes.  The
capped call transactions are expected generally to reduce the potential dilution to the Company's common stock upon any conversion of the notes. If the
initial  purchasers  exercise  their  option  to  purchase  additional  notes,  the  Company  expects  to  enter  into  additional  capped  call  transactions  with  the
counterparties.

The  Company  expects  that,  in  connection  with  establishing  their  initial  hedge  of  the  capped  call  transactions,  the  counterparties  or  their  respective
affiliates  may  enter  into  various  derivative  transactions  with  respect  to  the  Company's  common  stock  and/or  purchase  shares  of  its  common  stock
concurrently with or shortly after the pricing of the notes, including with certain investors in the notes. This activity could increase (or reduce the size of
any decrease in) the market price of the Company's common stock or the notes at that time.

43

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

In addition, the Company expects that the counterparties or their respective affiliates may modify their hedge positions by entering into or unwinding
various derivatives with respect to its common stock and/or purchasing or selling the Company's common stock or other securities in secondary market
transactions following the pricing of the notes and prior to the maturity of the notes and are likely to do so on each exercise date of the capped call
transactions. This activity could also cause or prevent an increase or a decrease in the market price of the Company's common stock or the notes, which
could affect their ability to convert the notes and, to the extent the activity occurs during any observation period related to a conversion of notes, it could
affect the amount and value of the consideration that holders will receive upon conversion of the notes.

In addition, if any such capped call transactions fail to become effective, whether or not this offering of notes is completed, the counterparties (or their
respective  affiliates)  may  unwind  their  hedge  positions  with  respect  to  the  Company's  common  stock,  which  could  adversely  affect  the  price  of  the
Company's common stock and the value of the notes.

The Company does not make any representation or prediction as to the direction or magnitude of any potential effect that the transactions described
above may have on the price of the notes or the shares of the Company's common stock. In addition, the Company does not make any representation that
the counterparties will engage in these transactions or that these transactions, once commenced, will not be discontinued without notice.

The Company is subject to counterparty risk with respect to the capped call transactions.

The counterparties to the capped call transactions that the Company expects to enter into are financial institutions, and the Company will be subject to
the risk that one or more of the counterparties may default or otherwise fail to perform, or may exercise certain rights to terminate, their obligations
under the capped call transactions. The Company's exposure to the credit risk of the counterparties will not be secured by any collateral.

Global economic conditions have in the past resulted in the actual or perceived failure or financial difficulties of many financial institutions. If a
counterparty to one or more capped call transactions becomes subject to insolvency proceedings, the Company will become an unsecured creditor in
those proceedings with a claim equal to its exposure at the time under such transaction. the Company's exposure will depend on many factors but,
generally, its exposure will increase if the market price or the volatility of the Company's common stock increases. In addition, upon a default or other
failure to perform, or a termination of obligations, by a counterparty, the counterparty may fail to deliver the consideration required to be delivered to the
Company under the capped call transactions and it may experience more dilution than the Company currently anticipates with respect to its common
stock. The Company can provide no assurances as to the financial stability or viability of the counterparties.

Some significant restructuring transactions may not constitute a fundamental change, in which case the Company would not be obligated to offer to
repurchase the notes.

Upon the occurrence of a fundamental change, holders have the right to require the Company to repurchase all or a portion of their notes. However, the
fundamental change provisions will not afford protection to holders of notes in the event of other transactions that could adversely affect the notes. For
example,  transactions  such  as  leveraged  recapitalizations,  refinancings,  restructurings  or  acquisitions  initiated  by  the  Company  may  not  constitute  a
fundamental change requiring the Company to offer to repurchase the notes. In the event of any such transaction the holders would not have the right to
require  the  Company  to  repurchase  the  notes,  even  though  each  of  these  transactions  could  increase  the  amount  of  its  indebtedness,  or  otherwise
adversely affect its capital structure or any credit ratings, thereby adversely affecting the holders of notes.

The Company has not registered the notes or the common stock issuable upon conversion, if any, which will limit their ability to resell them.

The notes and the shares of common stock issuable upon conversion of the notes, if any, have not been registered under the Securities Act or any state
securities laws. Unless the notes and any shares of common stock issuable upon conversion of the notes, if any, have been registered, they may not be
transferred  or  resold  except  in  a  transaction  exempt  from  or  not  subject  to  the  registration  requirements  of  the  Securities  Act  and  applicable  state
securities laws. The Company does not intend to file a registration statement for the resale of the notes and the common stock, if any, into which the
notes are convertible. 

The Company cannot assure holders that an active trading market will develop for the notes.

Prior  to  this  offering,  there  has  been  no  trading  market  for  the  notes,  and  the  Company  does  not  intend  to  apply  to  list  the  notes  on  any  securities
exchange or to arrange for quotation on any automated dealer quotation system. The Company has been informed by the initial purchasers that they
intend to make a market in the notes after the offering is completed. However, the initial purchasers may cease their market-making at any time without
notice. In addition, the liquidity of the trading market in the notes, and the market price quoted for the notes, may be adversely affected by changes in
the overall market for this type of security and by changes in the Company's financial performance or prospects or in the prospects for companies in
its industry generally. As a result, the Company cannot assure holders that an active trading market will develop for the notes. If an active trading market
does not develop or is not maintained, the market price and liquidity of the notes may be adversely affected. In that case holders may not be able to sell
their notes at a particular time or holders may not be able to sell their notes at a favorable price.

Any adverse rating of the notes may cause their trading price to fall.

The Company does not intend to seek a rating on the notes. However, if a rating service were to rate the notes and if such rating service were to lower its
rating on the notes below the rating initially assigned to the notes or otherwise announces its intention to put the notes on credit watch, the trading price
of the notes could decline.

44

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Holders may be subject to tax if the Company makes or fails to make certain adjustments to the conversion rate of the notes even though holders do
not receive a corresponding cash distribution.

The conversion rate of the notes is subject to adjustment in certain circumstances, including the payment of cash dividends. If the conversion rate is
adjusted as a result of a distribution that is taxable to the Company's common stockholders, such as a cash dividend, holders may be deemed to have
received  a  dividend  subject  to  U.S.  federal  income  tax  without  the  receipt  of  any  cash.  In  addition,  a  failure  to  adjust  (or  to  adjust  adequately)  the
conversion rate after an event that increases their proportionate interest in the Company could be treated as a deemed taxable dividend to holders if the
failure to adjust (or to adjust adequately) is made in connection with a distribution of cash or other property to the Company's common stockholders. If a
make-whole  fundamental  change  occurs  prior  to  the  maturity  date  or  the  Company  issues  a  notice  of  redemption  under  some  circumstances,  the
Company will increase the conversion rate for notes converted in connection with the make-whole fundamental change or during the related redemption
period.  Such  increase  may  also  be  treated  as  a  distribution  subject  to  U.S.  federal  income  tax  as  a  dividend.  It  is  unclear  whether  any  such  deemed
dividend  would  be  eligible  for  the  preferential  tax  treatment  generally  available  for  dividends  paid  by  U.S.  corporations  to  certain  U.S.  holders.  If
holders are a non-U.S. holders, any deemed dividend generally would be subject to U.S. federal withholding tax at a 30% rate, or such lower rate as may
be specified by an applicable treaty, which may be set off against subsequent payments with respect to the notes (or common stock into which the notes
convert). The Company do not currently expect to make distributions on its common stock, although no assurance can be given in this regard.

The Company may redeem the notes at its option, which may adversely affect their return.

The Company may not redeem the notes prior to March 20, 2024. On or after March 20, 2024 it may redeem for cash all or any portion of the notes, at
its option if the last reported sale price of its common stock has been at least 130% of the conversion price then in effect for at least 20 trading days
(whether or not consecutive) during any 30 consecutive trading day period (including the last trading day of such period) ending on and including, the
trading day immediately preceding the date on which the Company provides notice of redemption at a redemption price equal to 100% of the principal
amount  of  the  notes  to  be  redeemed,  plus  accrued  and  unpaid  interest  to,  but  excluding,  the  redemption  date.  If  the  Company  calls  any  note  for
redemption,  holders  may  convert  their  note  called  for  redemption  (or  any  portion  thereof)  at  any  time  prior  to  the  close  of  business  on  the  second
scheduled trading day immediately preceding the applicable redemption date. Prevailing interest rates at the time the Company redeem the notes may be
lower than the interest rate on the notes. Upon such redemption or conversion, the cash comprising the redemption price, in the case of a redemption, or
the applicable conversion consideration, in the case of a conversion in connection with a redemption notice, in either case, may not fully compensate
holders for any future interest payments that holders would have otherwise received or for any other lost time value of their notes. 

The notes will initially be held in book-entry form and, therefore, holders must rely on the procedures and the relevant clearing systems to exercise
their rights and remedies.

Unless and until certificated notes are issued in exchange for book-entry interests in the notes, owners of the book-entry interests will not be considered
owners or holders of notes. Instead, DTC, or its nominee, will be the sole holder of the notes. Payments of principal, interest (including any additional
interest), cash amounts due upon conversion and other amounts owing on or in respect of the notes in global form will be made to the paying agent,
which will make the payments to DTC. Thereafter, such payments will be credited to DTC participants’ accounts that hold book-entry interests in the
notes in global form and credited by such participants to indirect participants. Unlike holders of the notes themselves, owners of book-entry interests
will not have the direct right to act upon the Company's solicitations for consents or requests for waivers or other actions from holders of the notes.
Instead, if a holder owns a book-entry interest, such holder will be permitted to act only to the extent such holder has received appropriate proxies to do
so from DTC or, if applicable, a participant. The Company cannot assure holders that the procedures implemented for the granting of such proxies will
be sufficient to enable holders to vote on any requested actions on a timely basis.

Risks Related to Ownership of the Company's Common Stock

Anti-takeover provisions contained in the Company's amended and restated certificate of incorporation and amended and restated bylaws, as well as
provisions of Delaware law, could impair a takeover attempt.

The Company's amended and restated certificate of incorporation, amended and restated bylaws and Delaware law contain provisions which could have
the  effect  of  rendering  more  difficult,  delaying  or  preventing  an  acquisition  deemed  undesirable  by  the  Company's  board  of  directors.  Among  other
things, the Company's amended and restated certificate of incorporation and amended and restated bylaws include provisions:

  ●authorizing a classified board of directors whose members serve staggered three-year terms;

●authorizing “blank check” preferred stock, which could be issued by the Company's board of directors without stockholder approval and may contain

voting, liquidation, dividend and other rights superior to its common stock;

  ●limiting the liability of, and providing indemnification to, its directors and officers;
  ●limiting the ability of its stockholders to call and bring business before special meetings;

●requiring  advance  notice  of  stockholder  proposals  for  business  to  be  conducted  at  meetings  of  the  Company's  stockholders  and  for  nominations  of

candidates for election to its board of directors; and

  ●controlling the procedures for the conduct and scheduling of board of directors and stockholder meetings.

These provisions, alone or together, could delay or prevent hostile takeovers and changes in control or changes in the Company's management.

As a Delaware corporation, the Company is also subject to provisions of Delaware law, including Section 203 of the Delaware General Corporation Law
(the  “DGCL”),  which  prevents  certain  stockholders  holding  more  than  15%  of  its  outstanding  capital  stock  from  engaging  in  certain  business
combinations without approval of the holders of at least two-thirds of the Company's outstanding common stock not held by such stockholder.

Any provision of the Company's amended and restated certificate of incorporation, amended and restated bylaws or Delaware law that has the effect of
delaying,  preventing  or  deterring  a  change  in  control  could  limit  the  opportunity  for  its  stockholders  to  receive  a  premium  for  their  shares  of  the
Company's capital stock, and could also affect the price that some investors are willing to pay for its common stock.

45

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

The Company's business could be negatively affected by activist shareholders.

Responding  to  actions  by  activist  shareholders  could  be  costly  and  time-consuming,  disrupt  the  Company's  operations  and  divert  the  attention  of
management and its employees. Additionally, perceived uncertainties as to the Company's future direction as a result of shareholder activism or changes
to the composition of its board of directors may lead to the perception of a change in the direction of its business or other instability, which may be
exploited by its competitors, cause concern to the Company's current or potential customers, and make it more difficult to attract and retain qualified
personnel. If customers choose to delay, defer or reduce transactions with the Company or do business with its competitors instead of the Company, then
the Company's business, financial condition and operating results would be adversely affected. In addition, the share price of its common stock and the
trading price of the notes could experience periods of increased volatility as a result of shareholder activism.

If  securities  or  industry  analysts  do  not  publish  or  cease  publishing  research  or  reports  about  the  Company,  its  business,  its  market  or
its competitors, or if they adversely change their recommendations regarding the Company's common stock, the market price and trading volume of
its notes and common stock could decline.

The trading market for the Company's notes and common stock will be influenced, to some extent, by the research and reports that securities or industry
analysts publish about the Company, its business, its market or its competitors. If any of the analysts who cover the Company adversely change their
recommendations  regarding  its  common  stock  or  provide  more  favorable  recommendations  about  its  competitors,  the  market  price  of  the
Company's  notes  and  common  stock  would  likely  decline.  If  any  of  the  analysts  who  cover  the  Company  cease  coverage  of  the  company  or  fail  to
regularly publish reports on it, the Company could lose visibility in the financial markets, which in turn could cause the market price and trading volume
of its notes and common stock to decline.

The Company does not expect to declare any dividends on its common stock in the foreseeable future.

The Company does not anticipate declaring any cash dividends to holders of its common stock in the foreseeable future. Consequently, investors may
need  to  rely  on  sales  of  its  common  stock  after  price  appreciation,  which  may  never  occur,  as  the  only  way  to  realize  any  future  gains  on  their
investment. Investors seeking cash dividends should not purchase shares of its common stock.

If the Company raises additional capital through the sale of shares of the Company’s common stock, convertible securities or debt in the future, its
stockholders’ ownership in the Company could be diluted and restrictions could be imposed on the Company’s business.

On April 21, 2020, the Company issued and sold an aggregate of 2,742,750 shares of the Company’s common stock, par value $0.001 per share at a
price  to  the  public  of  $10.50  per  share.  The  shares  include  the  full  exercise  of  the  underwriter’s  option  to  purchase  an  additional  357,750  shares  of
common  stock.  The  Company  received  net  proceeds  from  the  offering  of  approximately  $26.5  million,  after  deducting  underwriting  discounts,
commissions,  and  offering  expenses  of  $2.1  million.  In  addition  to  this  offering,  the  Company  may  issue  shares  of  its  common  stock  or  securities
convertible  into  its  common  stock  to  raise  additional  capital  in  the  future.  To  the  extent  the  Company  issues  such  securities,  its  stockholders  may
experience  substantial  dilution  and  the  trading  price  of  the  Company’s  common  stock  could  decline.  If  the  Company  obtains  funds  through  a  credit
facility or through the issuance of debt or preferred securities, such debt or preferred securities could have rights senior to the existing stockholders’
rights as a common shareholder, which could impair the value of the Company’s common stock.

ITEM 1B.         UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS

Not applicable.

46

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

ITEM 2.           PROPERTIES

The Company occupies 66,000 square feet for its U.S. Corporate office in Brisbane, California, under a lease which extends through January 31, 2028.
The original lease expired on December 31, 2017, and the Company entered into a Second Amendment on July 6, 2017 that extended the term of the lease
to January 31, 2023 and a Third Amendment on July 9, 2020 that extended the term of the lease to January 31, 2028. The amendment provides for the
following: a) The extension of the lease term, with the extended term to begin on February 1, 2023 and continue until January 31, 2028; b) the abatement
of the monthly base rent for the four month period beginning September 1, 2020 and ending December 31, 2020; c) the amendment of monthly base rent
during the extension term to approximately $0.2 million for January 2021 with annual increases of 3.5% thereafter; and d) the waiver by the Company of
its early termination right in the lease. Pursuant to the terms of the Third Amendment to the Lease Agreement, the Company has the option to extend the
term of the lease by an additional 60 months.

In addition, the Company has leased office facilities in certain countries as follows:

Country
Japan

France
Spain

Belgium

Square Footage
Approximately 5,896

Approximately 2,239
Approximately 3,584

Approximately 151

Lease termination or Expiration
Two leases, one of which was amended during fiscal year 2020 and extended to March
2024, and the other which initially expired in December 31, 2019 and was extended for
another two years to December 31, 2021.
One lease which expires in October 2021.
One lease which was set to expire in January 31, 2021 but was extended for another two
years to January 31, 2023.
One lease signed effective March 1, 2020, which expires in November 2023.

The Company believes that these facilities are suitable and adequate for its current and future needs for at least the next twelve months.

ITEM 3.

LEGAL PROCEEDINGS

From time to time, the Company may be involved in legal and administrative proceedings and claims of various types. For a description of material
pending  legal  and  regulatory  proceedings  and  settlements  as  of  December  31,  2020,  please  see  Note  11  to  the  Company’s  consolidated  financial
statements entitled “Commitments and Contingencies,” Part II Item 8, included in this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

ITEM 4.

MINE SAFETY DISCLOSURES

Not applicable.

47

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

PART II

ITEM 5.

MARKET  FOR  THE  REGISTRANT’S  COMMON  EQUITY,  RELATED  STOCKHOLDER  MATTERS  AND  ISSUER
PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES

Stock Exchange Listing

The Company’s common stock trades on The NASDAQ Global Select Market under the symbol “CUTR.” As of March 1, 2021, the closing sale price
of its common stock was $35.12 per share.

Common Stockholders

The Company had 5 stockholders of record as of March 1, 2021. The Company believes the actual number of stockholders is greater than this number
of record holders and includes stockholders who are beneficial owners, but whose shares are held in “street” name by brokers and other nominees. This
number of holders of record also does not include stockholders whose shares may be held in trust by other entities.

Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities

There were no repurchases of the Company’s common stock under the Company’s Stock Repurchase Program in 2020.

Sales of Unregistered Securities

The Company did not sell any unregistered securities during the period covered by this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

Dividends

For a discussion regarding the Company’s intentions with respect to dividends, see the section titled “Stock-based Compensation Expense” set forth in
Part II Item 7 of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

Securities Authorized for Issuance under Equity Compensation Plans

The information required by this Item regarding equity compensation plans is incorporated by reference to the information set forth in Part III Item 12
of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

48

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Performance Graph

The graph below compares Cutera, Inc.'s cumulative 5-Year total shareholder return on common stock with the cumulative total returns of the NASDAQ
Composite index and the NASDAQ Medical Equipment index. The graph tracks the performance of a $100 investment in the Company’s common stock
and in each index (with the reinvestment of all dividends) from December 31, 2015 to December 31, 2020.

In accordance with SEC rules, the information contained under “Performance Graph” shall not be deemed to be “soliciting material,” or to be “filed”
with the SEC or subject to the SEC’s Regulation 14A or 14C, other than as provided under Item 201(e) of Regulation S-K, or to the liabilities of Section
18 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, except to the extent that the Company specifically request that the information be treated as
soliciting material or specifically incorporate it by reference into a document filed under the Securities Act, or the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as
amended.

49

 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

ITEM 6.

SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA

The  following  selected  consolidated  financial  data  should  be  read  in  conjunction  with  the  Company’s  Consolidated  Financial  Statements  and  the
accompanying Notes and “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” included elsewhere in this report.
The selected data in this section is not intended to replace the Consolidated Financial Statements.

Consolidated Statements of Operations Data (in
thousands, except per share data):
Net revenue
Cost of revenue

Gross profit
Operating expenses:

Sales and marketing
Research and development
General and administrative
Lease termination income

Total operating expenses
Income (loss) from operations
Interest and other income, net
Income (loss) before income taxes
Income tax (benefit) provision
Net income (loss)
Net income (loss) per share:

Basic
Diluted

Weighted-average number of shares used in per share
calculations:

Basic
Diluted

Year Ended December 31,

2020*

2019*

2018*

2017

147,683    $
71,911     
75,772     

52,766     
14,322     
31,512     
—     
98,600     
(22,828)    
(579)    
(23,407)    
470     
(23,877)   $

181,712    $
83,549     
98,163     

71,109     
15,085     
24,033     
—     
110,227     
(12,064)    
(199)    
(12,263)    
85     
(12,348)   $

162,720    $
82,338     
80,382     

151,493     
65,383     
86,110     

58,420     
14,359     
20,995     
—     
93,774     
(13,392)    
(123)    
(13,515)    
17,255     
(30,770)   $

52,070     
12,874     
14,090     
(4,000)    
75,034     
11,076     
884     
11,960     
(18,033)    
29,993    $

(1.43)   $
(1.43)   $

(0.88)   $
(0.88)   $

(2.23)   $
(2.23)   $

2.16    $
2.04    $

  $

  $

  $
  $

2016

118,056 
49,921 
68,135 

41,563 
11,232 
12,943 
— 
65,738 
2,397 
323 
2,720 
143 
2,557 

0.19 
0.19 

16,691     
16,691     

14,096     
14,096     

13,771     
13,771     

13,873     
14,728     

13,225 
13,753 

As of December 31,

Consolidated Balance Sheet Data (in
thousands):
Cash, cash equivalents and marketable investments   $
Working capital (current assets less current
liabilities)
Total assets
Total long-term liabilities
Retained earnings (accumulated deficit)
Total stockholders’ equity

2020*

2019*

2018*

2017

2016

47,047    $

33,921    $

35,575    $

35,912    $

54,074 

51,938     
132,733     
21,495     
(60,235)    
56,880     

36,424     
113,738     
9,174     
(36,358)    
45,942     

39,578     
97,637     
3,631     
(24,010)    
46,386     

45,063     
111,238     
3,034     
2,947     
64,893     

59,460 
91,854 
2,455 
(27,046)
61,010 

* Financial results for year ended December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018, as compared to the years ended December 31, 2017 and 2016 reflect the effects of
adopting ASU 2014-09, “Revenue from Contracts with Customers (Topic 606)” and the related amendments, which provided a new basis of accounting for
the  Company’s  revenue  arrangements  during  fiscal  year  2018.  The  adoption  of  ASC  606  limits  the  comparability  of  revenue  and  operating  expenses
presented in the statement of operations for the years ended December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018, when compared to the years ended December 31, 2017
and 2016. The adoption of ASC 606 also limits the comparability of certain balance sheet items, including total assets, for the years ended December 31,
2020, 2019 and 2018 when compared to the years ended December 31, 2017 and 2016. See Note 1, “Revenue Recognition” to the Consolidated Financial
Statements set forth in Item 8 of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

Financial results for year ended December 31, 2020 and 2019, as compared to the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016 also reflect the effects of
adopting ASU 2016-02, "Leases," (also known as ASC Topic 842) which requires, among other items, lease accounting to recognize most leases as assets
and liabilities on the balance sheet. The adoption of ASC 842 limits the comparability of certain balance sheet items for the year ended December 31, 2020
and 2019 when compared to the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016. For additional information regarding the impact from adoption of this
accounting standard, See Note 1, “Leases” to the Consolidated Financial Statements set forth in Item 8 of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

50

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
     
     
     
     
 
   
   
     
       
       
       
       
 
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
     
       
       
       
       
 
     
       
       
       
       
 
   
   
 
 
 
 
   
     
     
     
     
 
   
   
   
   
   
 
 
 
Table of Contents

 ITEM 7.

MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

The following discussion should be read in conjunction with the Company’s  audited  financial  statements  and  notes  thereto  for  the  fiscal  year  ended
December 31, 2020. This Annual Report on Form 10-K, including the following sections, contains forward-looking statements within the meaning of the
Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995. Throughout this Report, and particularly in this Item 7, the forward-looking statements are based upon
the Company’s current expectations, estimates and projections and that reflect the Company’s beliefs and assumptions based upon information available
to  the  Company  at  the  date  of  this  Report.  In  some  cases,  you  can  identify  these  statements  by  words  such  as  “may,”  “might,”  “could,”  “will,”
“should,”  “expects,”  “plans,”  “anticipates,”  “likely,”  “believes,”  “estimates,”  “intends,”  “forecasts,”  “foresees,”  “predicts,”  “potential”  or
“continue,” and other similar terms. These forward-looking statements are not guarantees of future performance and are subject to risks, uncertainties,
and assumptions that are difficult to predict. The Company’s actual results, performance or achievements could differ materially from those expressed
or implied by the forward-looking  statements.  The  forward-looking  statements  include,  but  are  not  limited  to,  statements  relating  to  the  Company’s
future financial performance, the ability to grow the Company’s business, increase the Company’s revenue, manage expenses, generate additional cash,
achieve and maintain profitability, develop and commercialize existing and new products and applications, improve the performance of the Company’s
worldwide sales and distribution network, and to the outlook regarding long term prospects. The Company cautions you not to place undue reliance on
these  forward-looking  statements,  which  reflect  management’s  analysis  only  as  of  the  date  of  this  Annual  Report  on  Form  10-K.  The  Company
undertakes no obligation to update forward-looking statements to reflect events or circumstances occurring after the date of this Form 10-K.

Some of the important factors that could cause the Company’s results to differ materially from those in the Company’s forward-looking statements, and
a discussion of other risks and uncertainties, are discussed in Item 1A—Risk Factors. The Company encourages you to read that section  carefully  as
well as other risks detailed from time to time in the Company’s filings with the SEC.

Introduction

The Management’s Discussion and Analysis (“MD&A”) is organized as follows:

●Executive Summary. This section provides a general description and history of the Company’s business, a brief discussion of the Company’s product

lines and the opportunities, trends, challenges and risks the Company focuses on in the operation of the Company’s business.

  ●Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates. This section describes the key accounting policies that are affected by critical accounting estimates.
  ●Recent Accounting Guidance. This section describes the issuance and effect of new accounting pronouncements that are or may be applicable to us.

●Results  of  Operations.  This  section  provides  the  Company’s  analysis  and  outlook  for  the  significant  line  items  on  the  Company’s  Consolidated

Statements of Operations.

●Liquidity and Capital Resources. This section provides an analysis of the Company’s liquidity and cash flows, as well as a discussion of the Company’s

commitments that existed as of December 31, 2020.

Executive Summary

Company Description

The Company is a leading medical device company specializing in the research, development, manufacture, marketing and servicing of light and other
energy-based  aesthetics  systems  for  practitioners  worldwide.  In  addition  to  internal  development  of  products,  the  Company  distributes  third  party
sourced  products  under  the  Company’s  own  brand  names.  The  Company  offers  easy-to-use  products  which  enable  practitioners  to  perform  safe  and
effective aesthetic procedures, including treatment for body contouring, skin resurfacing and revitalization, tattoo removal, removal of benign pigmented
lesions, vascular conditions, hair removal, toenail fungus and women's intimate health. The Company’s platforms are designed to be easily upgraded to
add additional applications and hand pieces, which provide flexibility for the Company’s customers as they expand their practices. In addition to systems
and upgrade revenue, the Company generates revenue from the sale of post warranty service contracts, providing services for products that are out of
warranty, hand piece refills and other per procedure related revenue on select systems and distribution of third-party manufactured skincare products.
The  Company  also  expands  its  revenues  from  sales  of  third-party  skincare  products  by  utilizing  its  network  and  relationships  with  physicians  and
practitioners.

The  Company’s  ongoing  research  and  development  activities  primarily  focus  on  developing  new  products,  as  well  as  improving  and  enhancing  the
Company’s  portfolio  of  existing  products.  The  Company  also  explores  ways  to  expand  the  Company’s  product  offerings  through  alternative
arrangements  with  other  companies,  such  as  distribution  arrangements.  The  Company  introduced  Juliet,  a  product  for  women’s  intimate  health,  in
December 2017, Secret RF, a fractional RF microneedling device for skin revitalization, in January 2018, enlighten SR in April 2018, truSculpt iD in
July 2018, excel V+ in February 2019 truSculpt flex in June 2019, Secret PRO in July 2020 and excel V+III during the fourth quarter of 2020.

The  Company’s  corporate  headquarters  and  U.S.  operations  are  located  in  Brisbane,  California,  where  the  Company  conducts  manufacturing,
warehousing,  research  and  development,  regulatory,  sales  and  marketing,  service,  and  administrative  activities.  The  Company  markets  sells  and
services the Company’s products through direct sales and service employees in North America (including Canada), Australia, Austria, Belgium, France,
Germany,  Hong  Kong,  Japan,  Spain,  Switzerland  and  the  United  Kingdom.  Sales  and  Services  outside  of  these  direct  markets  are  made  through  a
worldwide distributor network in over 42 countries.

51

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Products and Services

The  Company  derives  revenue  from  the  sale  of  Products  and  Services.  Product  revenue  includes  revenue  from  the  sale  of  systems,  hand  pieces  and
upgrade  of  systems  (collectively  “Systems”  revenue),  replacement  hand  pieces,  truSculpt iD cycle refills,  and  truSculpt  flex  cycle  refills,  as  well  as
single  use  disposable  tips  applicable  to  Juliet  and  Secret  RF  (“Consumables”  revenue),  the  sale  of  third  party  manufactured  skincare  products
(“Skincare” revenue); and the leasing of equipment through a membership program . A system consists of a console that incorporates a universal graphic
user interface, a laser and (or) other energy-based module, control system software and high voltage electronics, as well as one or more hand pieces.
However, depending on the application, the laser or other energy-based module is sometimes contained in the hand piece such as with the Company’s
Pearl and Pearl Fractional applications instead of within the console.

The  Company  offers  customers  the  ability  to  select  the  system  that  best  fits  their  practice  at  the  time  of  purchase  and  then  to  cost-effectively  add
applications to their system as their practice grows. This provides customers the flexibility to upgrade their systems whenever they choose and provides
the  Company  with  a  source  of  additional  Systems  revenue.  The  Company’s  primary  system  platforms  include  excel,  enlighten,  Juliet,  Secret  RF,
truSculpt and xeo.

Skincare revenue relates to the distribution of ZO’s skincare products in Japan. The skincare products are purchased from a third-party manufacturer and
sold to medical offices and licensed physicians. The Company acts as the principal in this arrangement, as the Company determines the price to charge
customers for the skincare products and controls the products before they are transferred to the customer.

Service includes prepaid service contracts, enlighten installation, customer marketing support and labor on out-of-warranty products.

Significant Business Trends

The Company believes that the ability to grow revenue will be primarily impacted by the following:

  ●continuing to expand the Company’s product offerings, both through internal development and sourcing from other vendors;
  ●ongoing investment in the Company’s global sales and marketing infrastructure;
  ●use of clinical results to support new aesthetic products and applications;

●enhanced luminary development and reference selling efforts (to develop a location where Company’s products can be displayed and used to assist in

selling efforts);

  ●customer demand for the Company’s products;
  ●consumer demand for the application of the Company’s products;
  ●marketing to physicians in the core dermatology and plastic surgeon specialties, as well as outside those specialties; and

●generating recurring revenue from the Company’s growing installed base of customers through the sale of system upgrades, services, hand piece refills,

truSculpt cycles, skincare products and replacement tips for Juliet and Secret RF products.

For a detailed discussion of the significant business trends impacting the Company’s business, please see the section titled “Results of Operations” below.

Critical accounting policies, significant judgments and use of estimates

The preparation of the Company’s audited consolidated financial statements and related notes requires the Company to make judgments, estimates and
assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets, liabilities, revenues and expenses, and related disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities. The
Company  has  based  its  estimates  on  historical  experience  and  on  various  other  assumptions  that  the  Company  believes  to  be  reasonable  under  the
circumstances. The Company periodically reviews its estimates and makes adjustments when facts and circumstances dictate. To the extent that there are
material differences between these estimates and actual results, its financial condition or results of operations will be affected.

An accounting policy is considered to be critical if it requires an accounting estimate to be made based on assumptions about matters that are highly
uncertain at the time the estimate is made, and if different estimates that reasonably could have been used, or changes in the accounting estimates that
are  reasonably  likely  to  occur  periodically,  could  materially  impact  the  consolidated  financial  statements.  The  Company  believes  that  its  critical
accounting policies reflect the more significant estimates and assumptions used in the preparation of its audited consolidated financial statements. The
critical accounting policies, judgments and estimates should be read in conjunction with the Company’s audited consolidated financial statements and
the notes thereto and other disclosures included in this report.

For an analysis of the Company’s Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates please refer to Note 1 “Summary of significant accounting policies” to the
Company’s audited consolidated financial statements included in Part II, Item 8 of this report.

The Company believes the following critical accounting policies, estimates and assumptions may have a material impact on reported financial condition
and  operating  performance  and  may  involve  significant  levels  of  judgment  to  account  for  highly  uncertain  matters  or  are  susceptible  to  significant
change:

Revenue Recognition

See  "Part  II,  Item  8.  Revenue  Recognition,  Note  1"  to  the  consolidated  financial  statements  for  the  year  ended  December  31,  2020,  included  in  this
Annual  Report  on  Form  10-K  for  additional  information  about  the  Company’s  revenue  recognition  policy,  significant  judgement  and  criteria  for
recognizing revenue.

The  Company  enters  into  contracts  with  multiple  performance  obligations  where  customers  purchase  a  combination  of  systems  and  services.
Determining whether systems and services are considered distinct performance obligations that should be accounted for separately requires judgment.
The Company determines the transaction price for a contract based on the consideration it expects to receive in exchange for the transferred goods or
services.  To  the  extent  the  transaction  price  includes  variable  consideration,  such  as  expected  price  adjustments  for  returns,  the  Company  applies
judgment when estimating variable consideration and when estimating the extent to which the transaction price is subject to the constraint on variable
consideration. The Company evaluates constraints based on its historical and projected experience with similar customer contracts.

52

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

The  Company  allocates  revenue  to  each  performance  obligation  in  proportion  to  the  relative  standalone  selling  prices  and  recognize  revenue  when
control of the related goods or services is transferred for each performance obligation.

The Company utilizes the observable standalone selling price when available, which represents the price charged for the performance obligation when
sold separately. When standalone selling prices for systems or services are not directly observable, the Company determines the standalone selling prices
using relevant information available and applies suitable estimation methods including, but not limited to, the cost plus a margin approach.

The  Company  determines  the  standalone  selling  price  (“SSP”),  for  systems  based  on  directly  observable  sales  in  similar  circumstances  to  similar
customers. The SSPs for extended service contracts are based on observable prices when sold on a standalone basis.

Under  the  Company’s  loyalty  program,  customers  accumulate  points  based  on  their  purchasing  levels.  Once  a  loyalty  program  member  achieves  a
certain  tier  level,  the  member  earns  a  reward  such  as  the  right  to  attend  the  Company’s  advanced  training  event  for  truSculpt,  or  a  ticket  for  the
Company’s  annual  forum.  A  customer’s  account  must  be  in  good  standing  to  receive  the  benefits  of  the  rewards  program.  Rewards  are  earned  on  a
quarterly  basis  and  must  be  used  in  the  following  quarter.  All  unused  rewards  are  forfeited.  The  fair  value  of  the  reward  earned  by  loyalty  program
members is included in accrued liabilities and recorded as a reduction of net revenue at the time the reward is earned.

Incremental costs of obtaining a contract, including sales commissions, are allocated to the distinct goods and services to which they relate based on the
relative stand-alone selling prices. Incremental costs related to obligations delivered at inception are recognized at contract inception. Those related to
obligations  delivered  over  time  are  capitalized  and  amortized  on  a  straight-line  basis  over  the  expected  customer  relationship  period  if  the  Company
expects to recover those costs. The Company uses the portfolio method to recognize the amortization expense related to these capitalized costs related to
initial contracts and such expense is recognized over a period associated with the revenue of the related portfolio, which is generally two to three years
for the Company’s product and service arrangements.

Valuation of Goodwill

Goodwill represents the excess of the purchase price over the fair value of net identifiable assets and liabilities.

Goodwill is initially valued based on the excess of the purchase price of a business combination over the fair value of acquired net assets recognized
and represents the future economic benefits arising from other assets acquired that could not be individually identified and separately recognized.

Goodwill is not amortized, but is tested for impairment annually, at the reporting unit level, in the fourth quarter and whenever events or circumstances
indicate impairment may exist. An impairment charge is recorded for the amount, if any, by which the carrying amount of goodwill exceeds its implied
fair value. See "Part II, Item 8. Financial Statements, Note 1" in the accompanying Notes to consolidated financial statements for more information.

Capitalized Cloud Computing Costs

The Company capitalizes costs incurred related to implementation costs incurred in a hosting arrangement that is a service contract to develop or obtain
internal-use software in accordance with ASU No. 2018-15, "Intangibles (Topic 350): Customer’s Accounting for Implementation Costs Incurred in a
Cloud Computing Arrangement That Is a Service Contract," which aligns the requirements for capitalizing implementation costs incurred in a hosting
arrangement that is a service contract with the requirements for capitalizing implementation costs incurred to develop or obtain internal-use software.
The capitalized implementation costs are then amortized over the term of the hosting arrangement inclusive of expected contract renewals, which is
generally three to five years. See "Part II, Item 8. Financial Statements, Note 1" in the accompanying Notes to consolidated financial statements for
more  information.  The  Company  periodically  assesses  the  capitalized  implementation  costs  for  impairment.  If  the  Company  determines  that  an
impairment is necessary, the Company records an impairment loss.

Leases

Lessee

The Company is a party to certain operating and finance leases for vehicles, office space and storages. The Company’s material operating leases consist
of office space, as well as storage facilities. The Company’s leases generally have remaining terms of 1 to 10 years, some of which include options to
renew the leases for up to 5 years.

The Company determines if a contract contains a lease at inception. Right of Use Assets and lease liabilities are recognized at the lease commencement
date. Operating lease liabilities represent the present value of lease payments not yet paid. Operating lease Right of Use assets represent the right to use
an  underlying  asset  and  are  based  upon  the  operating  lease  liabilities  adjusted  for  prepayments  or  accrued  lease  payments,  initial  direct  costs,  lease
incentives,  and  impairment  of  operating  lease  assets.  To  determine  the  present  value  of  lease  payments  not  yet  paid,  the  Company  estimates  the
incremental secured borrowing rates corresponding to the maturities of the leases. The Company based the rate estimates on prevailing financial market
conditions, credit analysis and management judgment.

The Company recognizes expense for these leases on a straight-line basis over the lease term. Additionally, tenant incentives used to fund leasehold
improvements are recognized when earned and reduce the Company’s right-of-use asset related to the lease. These are amortized through the right-of-
use asset as reductions of expense over the lease term.

53

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Lessor

Beginning in 2020, the Company also enters into leasing transactions, in which the Company is the lessor, offered through the Company's membership
program.  All  of  the  Company's  leases  for  equipment  rentals  were  initially  accounted  for  as  operating  leases.  The  lease  agreements  are  typically
for three years; however, the customer has the right to terminate the lease after twelve months with no penalty. As such, the Company has determined
that the expected term of the lease is twelve-months. Rental charges are a fixed monthly fee, paid at the beginning of each month, over the term of the
lease. Along with the leased equipment, the membership program provides customers with a warranty service and a fixed amount of consumables per
month for the term of the lease, which are classified as non-lease components. The Company has made an accounting policy election to account for
qualifying lease components and associated non-lease components as a single component; accordingly, a lease component and an associated warranty
service non-lease component are combined and accounted for as an operating lease. The consumables do not qualify for the practical expedient and are
accounted for as a separate non-lease component.

The initial direct costs related to the Company’s operating leases for equipment rentals include the related commissions paid to employees upon the
origination  of  a  lease  agreement.  These  costs  are  included  in  Other  current  assets  and  prepaid  expenses  on  the  consolidated  balance  sheets  and  are
amortized over the lease term of twelve-months.

During  the  fourth  quarter  ended  December  31,  2020,  some  of  the  membership  program  agreements  were  amended  to  grant  the  lessees  an  option  to
purchase the leased system from the Company, at any time during the period of 12 months from signing the amended agreement. For contracts signed
under  the  amended  membership  agreement,  the  Company  classified  and  accounted  for  the  arrangement  as  sales-type  leases,  as  the  Company
determined it is reasonably certain that the customer will exercise the purchase option.

At the commencement of the sales-type leases, the Company derecognized the underlying equipment and recognized a lease receivable if collectability
criteria was met.

The  Company  adopted  ASC  Topic  842  on  January  1,  2019,  applying  the  modified  retrospective  method  to  all  leases  existing  at  the  date  of  initial
application.  The  comparative  information  has  not  been  adjusted  and  continues  to  be  reported  under  the  accounting  standards  in  effect  for  the  prior
period. 

See "Part II, Item 8. Financial Statements, Notes 1 and 11" in the accompanying Notes to consolidated financial statements for more information.

Valuation of Inventories

Inventories are stated at the lower of cost and net realizable value, cost being determined on a standard cost basis which approximates actual cost on a
first-in, first-out basis. Net realizable value is the estimated selling prices in the ordinary course of the Company’s business, less reasonably predictable
costs of completion, disposal, and transportation. Standard costs are monitored and updated quarterly or as necessary, to reflect changes in raw material
costs, labor to manufacture the product and overhead rates.

The cost basis of the Company’s inventory is reduced for any products that are considered excess or obsolete based upon assumptions about future
demand  and  market  conditions.  The  Company  provides  for  excess  and  obsolete  inventories  when  conditions  indicate  that  the  inventory  cost  is  not
recoverable  due  to  physical  deterioration,  forecast  usage,  obsolescence,  reductions  in  estimated  future  demand  and  reductions  in  selling  prices.
Inventory  provisions  are  measured  as  the  difference  between  the  cost  of  inventory  and  net  realizable  value  to  establish  a  lower  cost  basis  for  the
inventories. The Company balances the need to maintain strategic inventory levels with the risk of obsolescence due to changing technology, timing of
new product introductions and customer demand levels. 

The Company includes demonstration units within inventories. Demonstration units are carried at cost and amortized over an estimated economic life
of two years. Amortization expense related to demonstration units is recorded in Products cost of revenue or in the respective operating expense line
based on which function and purpose for which the demonstration units are being used. Proceeds from the sale of demonstration units are recorded as
revenue and all costs incurred to refurbish the systems prior to sale are charged to cost of revenue.

See "Part II, Item 8. Financial Statements, Note 1" in the accompanying Notes to consolidated financial statements for more information.

Stock-based Compensation Expense

The Company’s equity incentive plans are broad-based, long-term programs intended to attract and retain talented employees and align stockholder and
employee interests. The Company’s equity incentive plans provide for the grant of incentive stock options, non-statutory stock options, RSAs, restricted
stock  units  (“RSUs”),  stock  appreciation  rights,  performance  stock  units,  performance  shares,  and  other  stock  or  cash  awards.  See  "Part  II,  Item  8.
Financial Statements, Note 6" in the accompanying Notes to consolidated financial statements for more information.

The Company accounts for stock-based compensation costs in accordance with the accounting standards for share-based compensation, which require
that all share-based payments to employees and non-employees be recognized in the consolidated statements of operations based on their fair values.

54

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

The Company uses the Black-Scholes option-pricing model using the single-option approach to determine the fair value of options granted. Option-
pricing models require the input of highly subjective assumptions, particularly for the expected stock price volatility and the expected term of options.
The risk-free interest rate is based on the U.S. Treasury yield for a duration similar to the expected term at the date of grant. The Company has never
paid any cash dividends on its common stock and it has no intention to pay a dividend at this time; therefore, the Company assumes that no dividends
will be paid over the expected terms of option awards. The Company determines the assumptions to be used in the valuation of option grants as of the
date of grant. As such, the Company uses different assumptions during the year if it grants options at different dates.

The assumptions used in the Black-Scholes-option pricing model to determine the fair value of an award include the following:

Expected  Term:  The  expected  term  represents  the  weighted-average  period  that  the  stock  options  are  expected  to  be  outstanding  prior  to  being
exercised. The Company determines expected term based on historical exercise patterns and its expectation of the time it will take for employees to
exercise options still outstanding.

Expected Volatility: For the underlying stock price volatility of the Company’s stock, the Company estimates volatility solely based on the Company’s
historical volatility of its stock price.

Forfeitures: The amount of stock-based compensation recognized during a period is based on the value of the portion of the awards that are ultimately
expected to vest. Under ASC 718, the Company has made an accounting policy to estimate forfeitures at the time awards are granted and revises, if
necessary, in subsequent periods if actual forfeitures differ from those estimates.

Risk-Free Interest Rate: The risk-free interest rate is based on the U.S. treasury yield curve in effect at the time of grant for the expected term of the
stock option.

The Company grants RSUs to the Company’s directors, officers and management employees and non-employees. The fair value of RSUs is based on
the stock price on the grant date using a single-award approach. The RSUs are subject to a service vesting condition and are recognized on a straight-
line basis over the requisite service period. Shares are issued on the vesting dates, net of applicable tax withholding requirements to be paid by the
Company  on  behalf  of  the  recipient.  As  a  result,  the  actual  number  of  shares  issued  will  be  fewer  than  the  actual  number  of  RSUs  outstanding.
Furthermore, the Company records the obligation for withholding amounts to be paid by the Company as a reduction to additional paid-in capital.

Performance stock units are granted to the Company’s officers and management employees and non-employees. PSU’s with operational measurement
goals are measured at the market price of the Company’s stock on the date of grant. The final number of shares of common stock issuable at the end of
the  performance  measurement  period,  subject  to  the  recipient’s  continued  service  through  that  date,  is  determined  based  on  the  expected  degree  of
achievement of the performance goals. Stock-based compensation expense for PSUs is recognized based on the expected degree of achievement of the
performance goals over the vesting period. On the vesting date of PSU awards, the Company issues fully paid up common stock, net of the minimum
statutory tax withholding requirements to be paid by the Company and records the obligation for withholding amounts as a reduction to additional paid-
in capital.

During 2020 and 2019, the Company’s Board granted to executive officers, senior management and certain employees PSUs that vest subject to the
recipients’ continued service and to the achievement of certain operational goals for the Company’s 2020 and 2019 fiscal year which consist of the
achievement of revenue targets for consumable products, revenue targets for international revenue, and certain operational milestones related to product
performance and business management.

On  April  1,  2020,  the  Company  issued  RSUs  to  settle  bonuses  owed  to  management  under  the  2019  Management  Bonus  Program.  In  the  past,  the
Company paid these bonuses with cash on hand. However, due to the economic conditions resulting from COVID-19, fully vested shares were issued in
lieu  of  cash.  The  Company  issued  209,981  shares  related  to  this  bonus  payment  to  management  and  recognized  $2.6  million  in  stock-based
compensation expense during fiscal year 2020. The Company also recorded an equivalent reduction in bonus expense as a result of the settlement of the
bonus in shares.

For a significant majority of the Company’s awards, share-based compensation expense is recognized on a straight-line basis over the requisite service
period, which ranges from one to four years depending on the award. The Company recognizes share-based compensation expense for the portion of
the equity award that is expected to vest over the requisite service period and develops an estimate of the number of share-based awards which will
ultimately vest, primarily based on historical experience within separate groups of employees and expectations regarding achievement of PSU goals for
PSU  awards.  The  forfeiture  rates  used  in  2020  ranged  from  0%  to  20.8%.  The  estimated  forfeiture  rate  is  reassessed  periodically  throughout  the
requisite  service  period.  Such  estimates  are  revised  if  they  differ  materially  from  actual  forfeitures.  For  the  award  types  discussed  above,  if  the
employee or non-employee terminates employment prior to being vested in an award, then the award is forfeited.

Modifications of the terms of outstanding awards may result in significant increases or decreases in share-based compensation. During the third quarter
of 2020, the Company’s Board modified RSUs awards granted to certain senior management that vest subject to the recipients’ continued service.

55

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

There were no significant modifications to the terms of outstanding options, and PSUs during 2020.

During the quarter ended March 31, 2020, the Company’s Board of Directors granted its executive officers, senior management, and certain employees
98,580 PSUs. The PSUs granted in the quarter ended March 31, 2020 vest subject to the recipients continued service and to the achievement of specific
optional and regulatory milestones.

On  August  2,  2020,  the  Board  awarded  its  new  CFO,  Rohan  Seth,  an  option  grant  for  60,000  shares,  which  vests  over  5  years,  and  a  PSU  award
covering a target of 22,423 shares, which vests over 2.5 years and is subject to performance-based criteria relating to the achievement of certain goals
with 40% based on achievement of Finance department goals and 60% based on the Company’s achievement of financial performance. The maximum
number of shares that may vest under the award is 150% of the target number of shares of Common Stock subject to the award.

See "Part II, Item 8. Financial Statements, Notes 1 and 6" in the accompanying Notes to consolidated financial statements for more information.

Income Taxes

The provision for income taxes is determined using the asset and liability approach of accounting for income taxes. Under this approach, deferred taxes
represent the estimated future tax effects of temporary differences between book and tax treatment of assets and liabilities and carryforwards to the
extent they are realizable.

The  Company  is  subject  to  taxes  on  earnings  in  both  the  U.S.  and  various  foreign  jurisdictions.  On  a  quarterly  basis,  the  Company  assesses  the
realizability  of  its  deferred  tax  assets.  For  those  jurisdictions  where  tax  carryforwards  are  likely  to  expire  unused  or  the  projected  operating  results
indicate  that  realization  is  not  more  likely  than  not,  a  valuation  allowance  is  recorded  to  offset  the  deferred  tax  asset  within  that  jurisdiction.  In
assessing the need for a valuation allowance, the Company considers future taxable income and ongoing prudent and feasible tax planning strategies. In
the  event  that  the  Company  determines  that  it  would  be  able  to  realize  its  deferred  tax  assets  in  the  future  in  excess  of  the  net  recorded  amount,  a
reduction of the valuation allowance would increase income in the period such determination was made. Likewise, should the Company determine that
it would not be able to realize all or part of its net deferred tax asset in the future, a reduction to the deferred tax asset would be charged to income in
the period such determination was made. 

The Company’s net taxable temporary differences and tax carryforwards are recorded using the enacted tax rates expected to apply to taxable income in
the periods in which the deferred tax liability or asset is expected to be settled or realized. Should the expected applicable tax rates change in the future,
an adjustment to the Company’s deferred taxes would be credited or charged, as appropriate, to income in the period such determination was made.

The  Company’s  effective  tax  rates  have  differed  from  the  statutory  rate  primarily  due  to  changes  in  the  valuation  allowance,  foreign  operations,
research and development tax credits, state taxes, and certain benefits realized related to stock option activity. The Company’s current effective tax rate
does not assume U.S. taxes on undistributed profits of foreign subsidiaries. These earnings could become subject to incremental foreign withholding or
U.S. state taxes, should they either be deemed or actually remitted to the U.S. The Company’s future effective tax rates could be adversely affected by
earnings being lower in countries where the Company has lower statutory rates and being higher in countries where the Company has higher statutory
rates, or by changes in tax laws, accounting principles, interpretations thereof, net operating loss carryback, research, and development tax credits, and
due  to  changes  in  the  valuation  allowance  applied  to  its  U.S.  deferred  tax  assets.  In  addition,  the  Company  is  subject  to  the  examination  of  the
Company’s income tax returns by the Internal Revenue Service and other tax authorities. The Company regularly assesses the likelihood of adverse
outcomes resulting from these examinations to determine the adequacy of the Company’s provision for income taxes.

Undistributed earnings of the Company’s foreign subsidiaries as of December 31, 2020 are considered to be indefinitely reinvested and, accordingly, no
provision for income taxes has been provided thereon. Due to the Transition Tax and Global Intangible Low-Tax Income (“GILTI”) regimes as enacted
by the 2017 Tax Act, those foreign earnings will not be subject to federal income taxes when actually distributed in the form of a dividend or otherwise.
The Company, however, could still be subject to state income taxes and withholding taxes payable to various foreign countries. The amounts of taxes
which the Company could be subject to are not material to the accompanying financial statements.

On March 27, 2020, the U.S. federal government enacted the Coronavirus Aid, Relief, and Economic Security Act (“CARES Act”). The CARES Act
changed several of the existing U.S. corporate income tax laws by, among other things, increasing the amount of deductible interest, allowing companies
to  carry  back  certain  Net  Operating  Losses  (“NOLs”)  and  increasing  the  amount  of  NOLs  that  corporations  can  use  to  offset  income.  Further,  in
December 2020, the Consolidated Appropriations Act, 2021 was signed into law. It clarified that gross income does not include any amount that would
otherwise arise from the forgiveness of a PPP loan. The CARES Act did not have a material impact on the Company's income tax provision, deferred tax
assets and liabilities, and related taxes payable. 

56

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

The Company periodically assesses its exposures related to its global provision for income taxes and believe that it has appropriately accrued taxes for
contingencies. Any reduction of these contingent liabilities or additional assessment would increase or decrease income, respectively, in the period such
determination was made.

The  Company  records  a  liability  for  uncertain  tax  positions  that  do  not  meet  the  more  likely  than  not  standard  as  prescribed  by  the  authoritative
guidance  for  income  tax  accounting.  The  Company  records  tax  benefits  for  only  those  positions  that  it  believes  will  more  likely  than  not  be
sustained. For positions that the Company believes that it is more likely than not that it will prevail, the Company records a benefit considering the
amounts  and  probabilities  that  could  be  realized  upon  ultimate  settlement.  If  the  Company  judgment  as  to  the  likely  resolution  of  the  uncertainty
changes,  if  the  uncertainty  is  ultimately  settled  or  if  the  statute  of  limitation  related  to  the  uncertainty  expires,  the  effects  of  the  change  would  be
recognized  in  the  period  in  which  the  change,  resolution  or  expiration  occurs.  The  Company  has  included  in  the  Company’s  Consolidated  Balance
Sheet a long-term income tax liability for unrecognized tax benefits and accrued interest and penalties of $1,864 and $1,461 as of December 31, 2020
and December 31, 2019, respectively. See “Part II, Item 8. Financial Statements, Note 7. Income Taxes” in the accompanying Notes to consolidated
financial statements for more information.

Litigation

The  Company  has  been,  and  may  in  the  future  become,  subject  to  a  number  of  legal  proceedings  involving  securities  litigation,  product  liability,
intellectual property, contractual disputes, trademark and copyright, and other matters. The Company records a liability and related charge to earnings in
its  consolidated  financial  statements  for  legal  contingencies  when  the  loss  is  considered  probable  and  the  amount  can  be  reasonably  estimated.  The
Company’s  assessment  is  reevaluated  each  accounting  period  and  is  based  on  all  available  information,  including  discussion  with  any  outside  legal
counsel that represents us. If a reasonable estimate of a known or probable loss cannot be made, but a range of probable losses can be estimated, the low-
end of the range of losses is recognized if no amount within the range is a better estimate than any other. If a loss is reasonably possible, but not probable
and can be reasonably estimated, the estimated loss or range of loss is disclosed in the notes to the consolidated financial statements.

Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements

The Company does not participate in transactions that generate relationships with unconsolidated entities or financial partnerships, such as entities often
referred  to  as  structured  finance,  variable  interest  or  special  purpose  entities,  which  would  have  been  established  for  the  purpose  of  facilitating  off-
balance  sheet  arrangements  or  other  contractually  narrow  or  limited  purposes.  As  of  December  31,  2020,  the  Company  was  not  involved  in  any
unconsolidated transactions.

Recent Accounting Pronouncement

In addition to the impacts from new accounting pronouncements included above see Note 1 — “Summary of Significant Accounting Pronouncements”
in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements in Part II, Item 8 of this Annual Report on Form 10-K. for a complete discussion of recent accounting
pronouncements adopted and not adopted.

Results of Operations

The following table sets forth selected consolidated financial data expressed as a percentage of net revenue.

Net revenue
Cost of revenue
Gross profit
Operating expenses:

Sales and marketing
Research and development
General and administrative
Total operating expenses

Loss from operations

Interest and other expense, net

Loss before income taxes
Income tax provision

Net loss

2020

Year Ended December 31,
2019

2018

100%    
49%    
51%    

36%    
10%    
20%    
66%    
(15)%   
(1)%   
(16)%   
—%    
(16)%   

100%    
46%    
54%    

39%    
8%    
13%    
61%    
(7)%   
—%    
(7)%   
—%    
(7)%   

100%
51%
49%

36%
9%
13%
58%
(8)%
—%
(8)%
11%
(19)%

57

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
   
   
   
     
 
     
 
     
 
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
 
Table of Contents

Net Revenue

The following table sets forth selected consolidated revenue by major geographic area and product category with changes thereof.

(Dollars in thousands)
Revenue mix by geography:

United States
International

  $

  $
Consolidated total revenue
United States as a percentage of total revenue    
International as a percentage of total revenue    

Revenue mix by product category:
Systems

2020

61,202 
86,481 
147,683 

41%   
59%   

Year Ended December 31,
2019

  % Change  

  % Change  

2018

-42%  $
15%   
-19%  $

106,243 
75,469 
181,712 

58%   
42%   

4%  $
24%   
12%  $

101,862 
60,858 
162,720 

63%
37%

- North America
- Rest of World

Total Systems
Consumables
Skincare

Total Products

Service

Total Net revenue

Total Net Revenue

  $

  $

50,721 
40,045 
90,765 
9,287 
25,061 
125,113 
22,570 
147,683 

-48%  $
-8%   
-35%   
-4%   
194%   
-21%   
-2%   
-19%  $

96,718 
43,760 
140,478 
9,648 
8,512 
158,638 
23,074 
181,712 

3%  $
13%   
6%   
132%   
47%   
11%   
14%   
12%  $

93,977 
38,618 
132,595 
4,162 
5,778 
142,535 
20,185 
162,720 

The Company’s revenue decreased by $34.0 million, or 19%, for the year ended December 31, 2020, compared to 2019, due to significant decline in
sales  in  the  North  America  market  as  a  direct  result  of  the  COVID-19  pandemic.  The  decrease  was  partially  offset  by  increase  in  sales  of  Skincare
products.

Revenue by Geography

The Company’s U.S. revenue decreased by $45.0 million, or 42%, for the year ended December 31, 2020, compared to the same period in 2019. The
decrease was due primarily to the COVID-19 pandemic. In response to the pandemic, government authorities imposed mandatory business closures,
shelter-in place and work-from-home orders and social distancing protocols during 2020 that significantly impacted the Company’s business operation.

The Company’s U.S. revenue increased $4.4 million, or 4%, for the year ended December 31, 2019 compared to 2018. The increase was due primarily
to continued demand of the truSculpt portfolio, including the recently launched truSculpt flex, as well as the Company’s excel V+ system.

The Company’s international revenue increased $11.0 million, or 15%, for the year ended December 31, 2020, compared to the same period in 2019,
driven  primarily  by  an  increase  in  skincare  product  sales  in  Japan  as  a  result  of  increased  marketing  and  promotional  efforts,  as  well  as  changes  in
customers behavior due to the COVID-19 as some consumers opted to purchase skincare products rather than go to a doctor’s office for treatment due to
the COVID 19 pandemic, partially offset by decrease in the Company's distributor business due to the COVID-19 pandemic. 

The Company’s international revenue increased $14.6 million, or 24%, for the year ended December 31, 2019 compared to 2018, driven primarily by
increases in service revenue, systems, skincare products and consumables.

Revenue by Product Type

Systems Revenue

Systems revenue in North America decreased by $46.0 million, or 48%, for the year ended December 31, 2020, compared to the same period in 2019,
due  primarily  to  the  COVID-19  pandemic  that  impacted  system  sales.  The  Rest  of  the  World  systems  revenue  decreased  by  $3.7  million,  or  8%,
compared to the same period in 2019. The decrease in Rest of the World revenue was primarily due to a decrease in the Company’s distributor business
in the Middle East due to the COVID-19 pandemic.

Systems revenue in North America increased $2.7 million, or 3%, for the year ended December 31, 2019, compared to the same period in 2018, due
primarily  to  the  recently  launched  excel V+  and  truSculpt flex  systems.  The  Rest  of  the  World  systems  revenue  increased  by  $5.1  million,  or  13%,
compared to the same period in 2018. The increase in Rest of the World revenue was primarily a result of an increase in the Company’s direct business
in Asia Pacific and Europe, as well as an increase in the Company’s distributor business in the Middle East due to the Company’s expansion to these
markets and new products launches.

58

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
   
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Consumables Revenue

Consumables revenue decreased $0.4 million, or 4%, for the year ended December 31, 2020, compared to the same period in 2019. The decrease in
consumables  revenue  was  primarily  due  to  decreased  sales  in  installed  base  of  truSculpt  iD,  Secret  RF,  and  truSculpt  flex,  each  of  which  have  a
consumable element, as well as the decline in usage of the consumables due to the COVID-19 pandemic.

Consumables revenue increased $5.5 million, or 132%, for the year ended December 31, 2019, compared to the same period in 2018. The increase in
consumables  revenue  was  due  to  the  introduction  of  Secret RF and Juliet during  January  2019,  and  truSculpt  iD  in  July  2019,  each  of  which  have
consumable elements.

Skincare Revenue

The Company’s revenue from Skincare products in Japan increased $16.5 million, or 194%, for the year ended December 31, 2020, compared to the
same period in 2019. This increase was due primarily to increased marketing and promotional efforts, as well as changes in customers behavior due to
the COVID-19 pandemic as some consumers opted to purchase skincare products rather than go to a doctor's office for treatment.

The Company’s revenue from Skincare products in Japan increased $2.7 million, or 47%, for the year ended December 31, 2019, compared to the same
period in 2018. This increase was due primarily to increased marketing and promotional activities, and a temporary increase in consumer demand due to
changes in the Japanese consumption tax rate from 8% to 10% effective October 1, 2019.

Service Revenue

The  Company’s  Service  revenue  decreased  $0.5  million,  or  2%,  for  the  year  ended  December  31,  2020,  compared  to  the  same  period  in  2019.  This
decrease was due primarily to decreased sales of service contracts and support and maintenance services provided on a time and materials basis to the
Company’s network of international distributors due to the COVID-19 pandemic.

The Company’s Service revenue increased $2.9 million, or 14%, for the year ended December 31, 2019, compared to the same period in 2018. This
increase was due primarily to increased sales of service contracts, and support and maintenance services provided on a time and materials basis to the
Company's network of international distributors.

Gross Profit

(Dollars in thousands)
Gross Profit

2020

  % Change

Year Ended December 31,
2019

  % Change

  $

75,772 

(23)%  $

98,163 

22%  $

As a percentage of total revenue

51%   

54%   

2018

80,382 

49%

The Company’s cost of revenue consists primarily of material, personnel expenses, product warranty costs, and manufacturing overhead expenses.

Gross profit as a percentage of revenue for the year ended December 31, 2020 decreased from 54% to 51%, compared to same period in 2019. The
decrease in gross profit as a percentage of revenue was primarily driven by a lower overhead absorption on lower revenue, the decline in the average
sales price of systems due to the COVID-19 pandemic and reduction-in-force and furloughed costs implemented by the Company during the first nine
months of 2020, partially offset by costs savings from the reduction-in-force and furlough and continuous investments in its international direct service
support and operational improvement activities.

Gross  profit  as  a  percentage  of  revenue  for  the  year  ended  December  31,  2019  increased  from  49%  to  54%,  compared  to  same  period  in  2018.  The
increase in gross profit as a percentage of revenue was largely driven by demand for the Company's new products with higher margins, as well as strong
growth  in  consumables  and  skincare  products.  The  year  ended  December  31,  2018  also  included  a  $5  million  product  remediation  charge  when  the
Company recognized a liability for a product remediation plan related to of one of its legacy systems. The accrued expense consisted of the estimated
cost  of  materials  and  labor  to  replace  the  component  in  all  units  that  were  under  the  Company's  standard  warranty  or  were  covered  under  existing
service contracts.

Sales and Marketing

(Dollars in thousands)
Sales and marketing

2020

  % Change

Year Ended December 31,
2019

  % Change

  $

52,766 

(26)%  $

71,109 

22%  $

As a percentage of total revenue

36%   

39%   

2018

58,420 

36%

Sales and marketing expenses consist primarily of personnel expenses, expenses associated with customer-attended workshops and trade shows, post-
marketing studies, advertising and training.

The $18.3 million, or 26%, decrease in sales and marketing expenses for the year ended December 31, 2020 compared to the same period in 2019 was due
primarily to:

● $8.0 million decrease in labor costs due to a decrease in commission as a result of lower sales, salary reduction, furloughs and reductions-in-force

in early 2020;

● $4.8 million decrease in promotional and product demonstration expenses due to cancellation of trade shows and promotional events as a result

of the COVID-19 pandemic;

● $3.3 million decrease in travel related expenses resulting from the travel restrictions due to the COVID-19 pandemic;
● $1.1 million decrease in stock-based compensation due to decreased headcount; and
● $1.1 million decrease in consulting and outside professional fees.

59

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
   
  
   
  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
   
  
   
  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

The $12.7 million, or 22%, increase in sales and marketing expenses for the year ended December 31, 2019 compared to the same period in 2018 was due
primarily to:

● $6.4 million increase in labor costs due to increased headcount;
● $2.4 million increase in stock-based compensation due to increased headcount;
● $1.9 million increase in consulting and outside professional fees;
● $1.2 million increase in software user license fees and other expenses;
● $0.5 million of higher travel related expenses in North America resulting from increased headcount; and
● $0.3 million of higher promotional and product demonstration expenses.

Research and Development (“R&D”)

(Dollars in thousands)
Research and development

As a percentage of total
revenue

2020

  % Change

Year Ended December 31,
2019

  % Change

2018

  $

14,322 

(5)%  $

15,085 

5%  $

14,359 

10%   

8%   

9%

R&D expenses consist primarily of personnel expenses, clinical research, regulatory and material costs. R&D expenses decreased by $0.8 million, or
5%, for the year ended December 31, 2020, compared to the same period in 2019. The decrease in expense for the year ended December 31, 2020 was
due primarily to $0.6 million decrease in salaries and benefits due to cost cutting measures implemented in response to the COVID 19 pandemic, $0.5
million decrease in consulting services and $0.3 million decrease in travel and other costs, offset by a net increase in material and equipment costs used
for research and development activities of $0.6 million.

R&D expenses increased by 5% for the year ended December 31, 2019, compared to the same period in 2018. The increase in expense of $0.7 million
for the year ended December 31, 2019 was due primarily to an increase in stock-based compensation.

General and Administrative (“G&A”)

(Dollars in thousands)
General and administrative

2020

  % Change

Year Ended December 31,
2019

  % Change

  $

31,512 

31%  $

24,033 

14%  $

As a percentage of total revenue

21%   

13%   

2018

20,995 

13%

G&A  expenses  consist  primarily  of  personnel  expenses,  legal,  accounting,  audit  and  tax  consulting  fees,  as  well  as  other  general  and  administrative
expenses. G&A expenses increased by $7.5 million, or 31%, for the year ended December 31, 2020, compared to the same period in 2019. The increase
in  expenses  was  due  primarily  to  $5.2  million  increase  in  professional  fees,  consulting  services  and  legal  fees,  $1.6  million  increase  in  credit  loss
expense, $0.5 million increase in software user license expense and $0.8 million increase due to a write off of capitalized Enterprise Resource Planning
cloud computing costs, partially offset by $0.4 million decrease in personnel related expenses, including stock-based compensation expense, and $0.2
million decrease in travel and other expense.

G&A expenses increased 14% for the year ended December 31, 2019, compared to the same period in 2018. The increase in expenses of $3.0 million
was due primarily to $1.1 million of personnel related expenses, inclusive of a $1.3 million decrease in stock-based compensation, $0.9 million increase
in professional fees, consulting services and legal fees related to the ongoing implementation efforts of a new Enterprise Resource Planning system and
$ 0.6 million related to executive severance costs.

Interest and Other Expense, Net

Interest and other income, net, consists of the following:

(Dollars in thousands)
Total interest and other expense, net

2020

  $

As a percentage of total net revenue

  % Change  

Year Ended December 31,
2019

  % Change

(579)    
0.0%   

191%  $

(199)
(0.1)%   

62%  $

2018

(123)
(0.1)%

Interest and other expense, net increased $0.4 million, or 191%, for the year ended December 31, 2020, compared to 2019. The increase was primarily
due to an amortization of loan costs related to the revolving loan obtained from Silicon Valley Bank during the year ended December 31, 2020 and a
decrease in interest income from marketable investments.

Net interest and other income expense was marginally higher for the year ended December 31, 2019 compared to the year ended December 31, 2018.

Income Tax Provision

(Dollars in thousands)
Income loss before income taxes
Income tax provision

2020

Year Ended December 31,
2019

$ Change

$ Change

2018

  $

(23,407)   $
470     

(11,144)   $
385     

(12,263)   $
85     

1,252    $
(17,170)    

(13,515)
17,255 

During the year ended December 31, 2020, the Company incurred income tax expense in foreign jurisdictions as the Company applied a full valuation
allowance against all U.S. federal and state deferred tax assets. During the year ended December 31, 2019, the Company incurred income tax expense in
foreign jurisdictions which was partially offset by an income tax benefit of $0.3 million related to the release of reserves for uncertain tax positions in
Germany.

60

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
   
  
   
  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
   
  
   
  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
  
   
  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
   
   
 
   
 
 
Table of Contents

Liquidity and Capital Resources

Sources and Uses of Cash

The  Company’s  principal  source  of  liquidity  is  cash  from  maturity  and  sales  of  marketable  investments  and  cash  generated  from  the  issuance  of
common  stock  through  exercise  of  stock  options  and  the  Company’s  employee  stock  purchasing  program.  The  Company  actively  manages  its  cash
usage  and  investment  of  liquid  cash  to  ensure  the  maintenance  of  sufficient  funds  to  meet  its  daily  needs.  The  majority  of  the  Company’s  cash  and
investments are held in U.S. banks and its foreign subsidiaries maintain a limited amount of cash in their local banks to cover their short-term operating
expenses.

As of December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019, the Company had $51.9 million and $36.4 million of working capital, respectively. Cash and cash
equivalents plus marketable investments increased by $13.1 million to $47.0 million as of December 31, 2020, from $33.9 million as of December 31,
2019, primarily as a result of cash obtained from financing activities, including net proceeds from the Company’s secondary offering of $26.5 million
and  proceeds  from  the  PPP  loan  of  $7.1  million,  partially  offset  by  a  decrease  in  sales  caused  by  the  business  disruptions  due  to  the  COVID-19
pandemic. The Company’s $6.4 million cash inflow from investing activities is due primarily to the liquidation of marketable investments.

As of December 31, 2019, and December 31, 2018, the Company had $36.4 million and $39.6 million of working capital, respectively. Cash and cash
equivalents plus marketable investments decreased by $1.7 million to $33.9 million as of December 31, 2019, from $35.6 million as of December 31,
2018, primarily as a result of increased inventory purchases related to the increasing demand of the Company’s products, and an increase in investments
in sales, service, and other management headcount to facilitate continued revenue expansion.

Cash, Cash Equivalents and Marketable Investments

The following table summarizes the Company’s cash and cash equivalents and marketable investments (in thousands):

(Dollars in thousands)
Cash, cash equivalents and marketable securities:

Cash and cash equivalents
Marketable investments

Total

Consolidated Cash Flow Data

In summary, the Company’s cash flows were as follows:

(Dollars in thousands)
Cash flows provided by (used in):

Operating activities
Investing activities
Financing activities

Net increase in cash and cash equivalents

Cash Flows from Operating Activities

2020

Year ended December 31,
2019

Change

47,047    $
—     
47,047    $

26,316    $
7,605     
33,921    $

20,731 
(7,605)
13,126 

2020

Year ended December 31,
2019

2018

(16,934)   $
6,389     
31,276     
20,731    $

(2,217)   $
1,067     
1,414     
264    $

308 
10,773 
787 
11,868 

  $

  $

  $

  $

Net cash used in operating activities was $16.9 million during 2020, which was due primarily to:

● $23.9 million net loss adjusted for non-cash related items consisting primarily of stock-based compensation expense of $10.1 million, $2.6
million amortization of capitalized contract costs, $2.1 million of provision for credit losses and $1.4 million depreciation and amortization.

● $6.0 million cash used as a result of a decrease in accounts payable;
● $3.2 million cash used due to an increase in other current assets and prepaid expenses;
● $3.0 million cash used as a result of a decrease in deferred revenue;
● $2.6 million cash used as a result of an increased accounts receivable;
● $2.1 million cash used due to increase other long-term assets;
● $0.8 million cash used as a result of a decrease in extended warranty liabilities; partially offset by
● $5.4 million cash generated as a result of a decrease in inventories; and
● $0.9 million cash generated as a result of increased accrued liabilities.

Net cash used in operating activities was $2.2 million during 2019, which was due primarily to:

● $12.3 million net loss adjusted for non-cash related items consisting primarily of stock-based compensation expense of $9.8 million, $2.9

million amortization of capitalized contract costs and $1.5 million depreciation and amortization expenses;

● $5.9 million cash used due to an increase in inventories;
● $3.4 million cash used to increase long term assets;
● $2.5 million cash used as a result of increased accounts receivables;
● $1.8 million cash used to increase other current assets and prepaid expenses;
● $1.4 million cash used for increased inventory purchases leading to an increase in accounts payable;
● $1.2 million cash used as a result of a decrease in extended warranty liabilities; partially offset by
● $7.2 million cash generated by an increase in accrued liabilities; and
● $1.7 million cash generated as a result of increased deferred revenue.

61

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
     
       
       
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
     
       
       
 
   
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Net cash provided by operating activities was $0.3 million during 2018, which was due primarily to:

● $30.8 million net loss as adjusted for non-cash related items consisting primarily of valuation allowance against certain U.S. differed tax assets of
● $17.4 million (excluding the $1.2 million tax effect of the ASC 606 Adoption), stock-based compensation expense of $7.2 million, $1.3 million

provision for accounts receivable credit losses and $3.0 million depreciation and amortization expenses;

● $4.3 million cash generated from an increase in accounts payable due primarily to increased inventory related purchases;
● $3.2 million cash generated due to an increase in extended warranty liabilities;
● $1.3 million cash generated as a result of increased deferred revenue;
● $0.8 million cash generated as a result of a decrease in inventories;
● $0.1 million cash generated due to a decrease in other long liabilities; partially offset by
● $3.8 million cash used to settle accrued liabilities;
● $2.8 million cash used to increase other long-term assets;
● $1.1 million cash used to increase other current assets and prepaid expenses; and
● $0.1 million cash used as a result of increased accounts receivables.

Cash Flows from Investing Activities

Net cash provided by investing activities was $6.4 million during 2020, which was attributable primarily to:

● $33.7 million in net proceeds from the maturities of marketable investments; partially offset by
● $26.1 million of cash used to purchase marketable investments; and
● $1.3 million of cash used to purchase property, equipment and software.

Net cash provided by investing activities was $1.1 million during 2019, which was attributable primarily to:

● $14.7 million in net proceeds from the sales and maturities of marketable investments; partially offset by
● $12.7 million of cash used to purchase marketable investments; and
● $1.0 million of cash used to purchase property, equipment and software.

Net cash provided by investing activities was $10.8 million during 2018, which was attributable primarily to:

● $23.1 million in net proceeds from the sales and maturities of marketable investments; partially offset by
● $10.9 million of cash used to purchase marketable investments; and
● $1.5 million of cash used to purchase property, equipment and software.

Cash Flows from Financing Activities

Net cash provided by financing activities was $31.3 million during 2020, which was primarily due to:

● $26.5 million proceeds from the issuance of common stock in connection with public offering, net of issuance costs;
● $7.2 million proceeds from the PPP loan;
● $1.6 million net proceeds from the issuance of common stock due to employee exercising their stock options and purchasing stock through the

Employee Stock Purchase Plan (“ESPP”) program; partially offset by

● $3.4 million of cash used for taxes paid related to net share settlement of equity awards; and
● $0.5 million of cash used to pay capital lease obligations.

Net cash provided by financing activities was $1.4 million during 2019, which was primarily due to:

● $2.9 million proceeds from the issuance of common stock due to employee exercising their stock options and purchasing stock through the ESPP

program; partially offset by

● $0.8 million of cash used for taxes paid related to net share settlement of equity awards; and
● $0.6 million of cash used to pay capital lease obligations.

Net cash provided by financing activities was $0.8 million during 2018, which was primarily due to:

● $4.4 million proceeds from the issuance of common stock due to employee exercising their stock options and purchasing stock through the ESPP

program; offset by

● $3.1 million of cash used for taxes paid related to net share settlement of equity awards; and
● $0.5 million of cash used to pay capital lease obligations.

Adequacy of Cash Resources to Meet Future Needs

The  Company  had  cash  and  cash  equivalents  of  $47.0  million  as  of  December  31,  2020.  For  fiscal  year  2020,  the  Company’s  principal  source  of
liquidity is cash generated from proceeds received from its April 2020 offering, the PPP loan, maturity and sales of marketable investments and cash
generated from the issuance of common stock through exercise of stock options and the Company’s employee stock purchasing program. In addition, on
March 9, 2021, the Company issued and sold $125 million aggregate principal amount of 2.25% Convertible Senior Notes. The Company believes that
the existing cash resources are sufficient to meet the Company’s anticipated cash needs for working capital and capital expenditures for at least the next
several years, but there can be no assurances.

62

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Loan and Security Agreement

On  July  9,  2020,  the  Company  terminated  its  undrawn  revolving  line  of  credit  with  Wells  Fargo  and  subsequently  entered  into  a  Loan  and  Security
Agreement with Silicon Valley Bank for a four-year secured revolving loan facility (“SVB Revolving Line of Credit”) in an aggregate principal amount
of up to $30.0 million. The SVB Revolving Line of Credit matures on July 9, 2024. As of December 31, 2020, there were no borrowings under the SVB
Revolving Line of Credit.

Covenants

On  July  9,  2020,  the  Company  terminated  its  undrawn  revolving  line  of  credit  with  Wells  Fargo  and  subsequently  entered  into  a  Loan  and  Security
Agreement with Silicon Valley Bank. The agreement provides for a four-year secured revolving loan facility (“SVB Revolving Line of Credit”) in an
aggregate principal amount of up to $30.0 million. See "Part II, Item 8. Financial Statements, Note 12. Debt" in the accompanying Notes to consolidated
financial statements for more information.

The  Loan  and  Security  Agreement  with  Silicon  Valley  Bank  contains  customary  affirmative  covenants,  such  as  financial  statement  reporting
requirements  and  delivery  of  borrowing  base  certificates,  as  well  as  customary  covenants  that  restrict  the  Company’s  ability  to,  among  other  things,
incur additional indebtedness, sell certain assets, guarantee obligations of third parties, declare dividends, or make certain distributions, and undergo a
merger or consolidation or certain other transactions. The Loan and Security Agreement also contains certain financial condition covenants, including
maintaining  a  quarterly  minimum  revenue  of  $90.0  million,  determined  in  accordance  with  GAAP  on  a  trailing  twelve-month  basis.  This  quarterly
minimum revenue requirement is subject to renegotiation at the beginning of each fiscal year.

As  of  December  31,  2020,  the  Company  had  not  drawn  on  the  SVB  Revolving  Line  of  Credit  and  the  Company  is  in  compliance  with  all  financial
covenants of the SVB Revolving Line of Credit.

Contractual Obligations

The following are the Company’s contractual obligations, consisting of future minimum lease commitments related to facility and vehicle leases as of
December 31, 2020:

Contractual Obligations
Operating leases
Finance leases
Total leases

Purchase Commitments

Total

21,448    $
635     
22,083    $

  $

  $

Payments Due by Period ($’000’s)

Less Than
1 Year

1-3 Years

3-5 Years

More Than
5 Years

3,062    $
374     
3,436    $

6,319    $
261     
6,580    $

5,759    $
—      
5,759    $

6,308 
— 
6,308 

The Company maintains certain open inventory purchase commitments with its suppliers to ensure a smooth and continuous supply for key components.
The Company’s liability in these purchase commitments is generally restricted to an agreed-upon period. Such time periods can vary among different
suppliers. The Company’s open inventory purchase commitments were not material for the year ended December 31, 2020. The Company believes it has
adequate  funds  to  fulfill  any  such  commitments  in  the  future  using  the  sources  discussed  in  this  Item  7  –  Management’s  Discussion  &  Analysis  of
Financial Condition and Results of Operations.

Other

In  the  normal  course  of  business,  the  Company  enters  into  agreements  that  contain  a  variety  of  representations,  warranties,  and  indemnification
obligations. For example, the Company has entered into indemnification agreements with each of the Company’s directors and executive officers. The
Company’s exposure under the various indemnification obligations is unknown and not reasonably estimable as they involve future claims that may be
made against us. As such, the Company has not accrued any amounts for such obligations.

63

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
   
   
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

ITEM 7A

QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK

Interest Rate and Market Risk

The  primary  objective  of  the  Company’s  investment  activities  is  to  preserve  principal  while  at  the  same  time  maximizing  the  income  the  Company
receives from investments without significantly increasing risk. To achieve this objective, the Company maintains its portfolio of cash equivalents and
short-  and  long-term  investments  in  a  variety  of  high-quality  securities,  including  U.S.  treasuries,  U.S.  government  agencies,  corporate  debt,  cash
deposits,  money  market  funds,  commercial  paper,  non-U.S.  government  agency  securities,  and  municipal  bonds.  The  securities  are  classified  as
available-for-sale  and  consequently  are  recorded  at  fair  value  with  unrealized  gains  or  losses  reported  as  a  separate  component  of  accumulated  other
comprehensive loss. The Company had no marketable securities as of December 31, 2020.

On  July  27,  2017,  the  United  Kingdom’s  Financial  Conduct  Authority  announced  that  it  intends  to  stop  persuading  or  compelling  banks  to  submit
LIBOR rates after 2021. These reforms may cause LIBOR to cease to exist, new methods of calculating LIBOR to be established or the establishment of
an alternative reference rate(s). While the Company expects that reasonable alternatives to LIBOR will be implemented prior to the 2021 target date or
that  the  2021  cessation  date  may  be  extended,  the  Company  cannot  predict  the  consequences  and  timing  of  these  developments,  and  could  have  an
adverse impact on the market value for or value of LIBOR-linked securities, loans, and other financial obligations or extensions of credit held by the
Company. The changes may influence returns on financial investments and could reduce the Company’s earnings and cash flows.

The uncertain financial markets could result in a tightening in the credit markets, a reduced level of liquidity in many financial markets, and extreme
volatility in fixed income and credit markets. The credit ratings of the securities the Company has invested in could further deteriorate and may have an
adverse impact on the carrying value of these investments.

As of December 31, 2020, the Company had not drawn on the SVB Revolving Line of Credit. Overall interest rate sensitivity is primarily influenced by
any amount borrowed on the line of credit and the prevailing interest rate on the line of credit facility. The effective interest rate on the line of credit
facility  is  based  on  a  floating  per  annum  rate  equal  to  the  greater  of  either  1.75%  above  the  Prime  Rate  or  5%.  The  Prime  Rate  was  3.25%  as  of
December 31, 2020, and accordingly the Company may incur additional expenses if the Company has an outstanding balance on the line of credit and
the Prime Rate increases in future periods.

Inflation

The Company does not believe that inflation has had a material effect on the Company’s business, financial condition, or results of operations. If the
Company’s costs were to become subject to significant inflationary pressures, the Company may not be able to fully offset such higher costs through
price increases. The Company’s inability or failure to do so could harm the Company’s business, financial condition, and results of operations.

Foreign Exchange Fluctuations

The Company generates revenue in Japanese Yen, Euros, Australian Dollars, Canadian Dollars, British Pounds and Swiss Francs. Additionally, a portion
of the Company’s operating expenses and assets and liabilities are denominated in each of these currencies. Therefore, fluctuations in these currencies
against  the  U.S.  dollar  could  materially  and  adversely  affect  the  Company’s  results  of  operations  upon  translation  of  the  Company’s  revenue
denominated in these currencies, as well as the re-measurement of the Company’s international subsidiaries’ financial statements into U.S. dollars. The
Company has historically not engaged in hedging activities relating to the Company’s foreign currency denominated transactions.

64

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

ITEM 8.

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA

CUTERA, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY COMPANIES

ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 10-K

INDEX TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

The following Consolidated Financial Statements of the Registrant and its subsidiaries are required to be included in Item 8:

Reports of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

Consolidated Balance Sheets

Consolidated Statements of Operations

Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Loss

Consolidated Statements of Stockholders’ Equity

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Schedule II -Valuation and Qualifying Accounts

    Page    
66

68

69

70

71

72

73

98

All other required schedules are omitted because of the absence of conditions under which they are required or because the required information is
given in the Consolidated Financial Statements or the Notes thereto.

65

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

Stockholders and Board of Directors
Cutera, Inc.
Brisbane, California

Opinion on the Consolidated Financial Statements

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Cutera, Inc. (the “Company”) as of December 31, 2020 and 2019, the related
consolidated statements of operations, comprehensive loss, stockholders’ equity, and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December
31, 2020, and the related notes and schedule (collectively referred to as the “consolidated financial statements”). In our opinion, the consolidated
financial statements present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of the Company at December 31, 2020 and 2019, and the results of its
operations and its cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2020, in conformity with accounting principles generally
accepted in the United States of America.

We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (“PCAOB”), the Company's
internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2020, based on criteria established in Internal Control – Integrated Framework (2013) issued
by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (“COSO”) and our report dated March 23, 2021 expressed an unqualified
opinion thereon.

Change in Accounting Principle

As discussed in Notes 1 and 11 to the consolidated financial statements, the Company has changed its accounting method for accounting for leases in
fiscal year 2019 due to the adoption of Topic 842: Leases using a modified retrospective approach.

Basis for Opinion

These consolidated financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the
Company’s consolidated financial statements based on our audits. We are a public accounting firm registered with the Public Company Accounting
Oversight Board (United States) (“PCAOB”) and are required to be independent with respect to the Company in accordance with the U.S. federal
securities laws and the applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB.

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain
reasonable assurance about whether the consolidated financial statements are free of material misstatement, whether due to error or fraud.

Our audits included performing procedures to assess the risks of material misstatement of the consolidated financial statements, whether due to error or
fraud, and performing procedures that respond to those risks. Such procedures included examining, on a test basis, evidence regarding the amounts and
disclosures in the consolidated financial statements. Our audits also included evaluating the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by
management, as well as evaluating the overall presentation of the consolidated financial statements. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis
for our opinion.

Critical Audit Matter

The critical audit matter communicated below is a matter arising from the current period audit of the consolidated financial statements that was
communicated or required to be communicated to the audit committee and that: (1) relates to accounts or disclosures that are material to the consolidated
financial statements and (2) involved especially challenging, subjective, or complex judgments. The communication of a critical audit matter does not
alter in any way our opinion on the consolidated financial statements, taken as a whole, and we are not, by communicating the critical audit matter below,
providing a separate opinion on the critical audit matter or on the accounts or disclosures to which it relates.

The  Company  recognized  total  net  revenue  of  approximately  $147.7  million  for  the  year  ending  December  31,  2020. As  described  in  Note  1  to  the
consolidated financial statements, the Company recognizes revenue in a manner that best depicts the transfer of control of promised products or services
to the customer, in an amount that reflects the consideration to which the Company expects to be entitled. The Company’s contracts with customers may
include,  individually,  or  in  combination,  systems,  extended  service  contracts,  training,  marketing  support  services  and  accessories.  Certain  of  the
Company’s  contracts,  which  include  some  with  international  distributors,  can  include  non-standard  payment  and  other  sales  terms  that  can  impact
management’s conclusions as to whether it is probable at contract inception that the Company will collect substantially all of the consideration to which it
will be entitled or whether control has transferred to the customer. Management applies significant effort and judgment in evaluating the impact of these
non-standard payment and sales terms on revenue recognition. 

We identified the evaluation of non-standard payment and other sales terms in the Company’s contracts with international distributors as a critical audit
matter. Auditing the impact of non-standard payment and other sales terms on management’s conclusions of whether the transfer of control has occurred
requires significant auditor effort and increased auditor judgment in performing procedures to evaluate management’s judgement.

The primary procedures we performed to address this critical audit matter included:

● Examining certain international distributor contracts, including any amendments or modifications, for non-standard payment terms and,

where such terms are present, evaluating management’s assessment of whether collection is probable, based on a consideration of indicators
of the international distributor’s liquidity and of the collection and credit memo history with the international distributor and with
similar international distributors with similar payment terms.

● Examining certain international distributor contracts, including any amendments or modifications, for non-standard terms governing transfer
of control and, where such terms are present, evaluating management’s conclusions regarding the transfer of control based on an assessment
of considerations including whether the international distributor has physical possession and legal title to the product, whether the Company
has a present right to payment, and other factors relevant to the determination of whether the international distributor has the ability to direct
the use of and obtain substantially all of the remaining benefit from the product.

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ BDO USA, LLP
We have served as the Company's auditor since 2014.
San Francisco, California
March 23, 2021

66

 
Table of Contents

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

Stockholders and Board of Directors
Cutera, Inc.
Brisbane, California

Opinion on Internal Control over Financial Reporting

We have audited Cutera, Inc.’s (the “Company’s”) internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2020, based on criteria established in
Internal Control – Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (the “COSO
criteria”). In our opinion, the Company maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2020,
based on the COSO criteria.

We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (“PCAOB”), the
consolidated balance sheets of the Company as of December 31, 2020 and 2019, the related consolidated statements of operations, comprehensive loss,
stockholders’ equity, and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2020, and the related notes and schedule and our report
dated March 23, 2021 expressed an unqualified opinion thereon.

Basis for Opinion

The Company’s management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness
of internal control over financial reporting, included in the accompanying Item 9A, Management’s Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting.
Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audit. We are a public accounting firm
registered with the PCAOB and are required to be independent with respect to the Company in accordance with U.S. federal securities laws and the
applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB.

We conducted our audit of internal control over financial reporting in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan
and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material
respects. Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, and
testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk. Our audit also included performing such other
procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.

Definition and Limitations of Internal Control over Financial Reporting

A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting
and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal
control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately
and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as
necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of
the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance
regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the
financial statements.

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation
of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of
compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

/s/ BDO USA, LLP
San Francisco, California
March 23, 2021

67

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

CUTERA, INC.
CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS
(in thousands, except share and per share data)

Assets
Current assets:

Cash and cash equivalents
Marketable investments
Accounts receivable, net of allowance for credit losses of $1,598 and $1,354, respectively
Inventories
Other current assets and prepaid expenses

Total current assets
Property and equipment, net
Deferred tax assets
Operating lease right-of-use assets
Goodwill
Other long-term assets

Total assets

Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity
Current liabilities:

Accounts payable
Accrued liabilities
Operating lease liabilities

   PPP Loan Payable

Extended warranty liabilities
Deferred revenue

Total current liabilities

Deferred revenue, net of current portion
Income tax liability
Operating lease liabilities, net of current portion
PPP Loan payable, net of current portion
Other long-term liabilities
Total liabilities

Commitments and contingencies (Note 11)

Stockholders’ equity:
Common stock, $0.001 par value: Authorized: 50,000,000 shares; Issued and outstanding: 17,679,232 and

14,315,586 shares at December 31, 2020 and 2019, respectively
Additional paid-in capital
Accumulated deficit
Accumulated other comprehensive loss
Total stockholders’ equity
Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity

December 31,

2020

2019

47,047    $
—     
21,962     
28,508     
8,779     
106,296     
2,299     
643     
17,076     
1,339     
5,080     
132,733    $

6,684    $
31,079     
2,260     
3,630     
1,216     
9,489     
54,358     
1,748     
—     
15,950     
3,555     
242     
75,853     

18     
117,097     
(60,235)    
—     
56,880     
132,733    $

26,316 
7,605 
21,556 
33,921 
5,648 
95,046 
2,817 
423 
7,702 
1,339 
6,411 
113,738 

12,685 
30,307 
2,800 
— 
1,999 
10,831 
58,622 
3,391 
93 
5,112 
— 
578 
67,796 

14 
82,346 
(36,358)
(60)
45,942 
113,738 

  $

  $

  $

  $

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

68

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
     
       
 
     
       
 
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
     
       
 
     
       
 
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
 
     
        
 
     
       
 
   
   
   
   
   
 
 
Table of Contents

Net revenue:
Products
Service

Total net revenue

Cost of revenue:

Products
Service

Total cost of revenue
Gross profit
Operating expenses:

Sales and marketing
Research and development
General and administrative

Total operating expenses

Loss from operations
Interest and other expense, net
Loss before income taxes
Income tax provision
Net loss

Net loss per share:
Basic and diluted

CUTERA, INC.
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS
(in thousands, except per share data)

2020

Year Ended December 31,
2019

2018

125,113    $
22,570     
147,683     

58,325     
13,586     
71,911     
75,772     

52,766     
14,322     
31,512     
98,600     
(22,828)    
(579)    
(23,407)    
470     
(23,877)   $

158,638    $
23,074     
181,712     

64,693     
18,856     
83,549     
98,163     

71,109     
15,085     
24,033     
110,227     
(12,064)    
(199)    
(12,263)    
85     
(12,348)   $

142,535 
20,185 
162,720 

66,843 
15,495 
82,338 
80,382 

58,420 
14,359 
20,995 
93,774 
(13,392)
(123)
(13,515)
17,255 
(30,770)

(1.43)   $

(0.88)   $

(2.23)

16,691     

14,096     

13,771 

  $

  $

  $

Weighted-average number of shares used in per share calculations:

Basic and diluted

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

69

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
     
       
       
 
   
   
     
       
       
 
   
   
   
   
     
       
       
 
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
 
     
       
       
 
     
       
       
 
     
       
       
 
   
 
 
Table of Contents

Net loss
Other comprehensive income (loss):
Available-for-sale investments

CUTERA, INC.
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF COMPREHENSIVE LOSS
(in thousands)

2020

Year Ended December 31,
2019

2018

  $

(23,877)   $

(12,348)   $

(30,770)

Net change in unrealized gain (loss) on available-for-sale investments
Less: Reclassification adjustment for net losses on investments recognized
during the year
Total change in unrealized gain (loss) on available-for-sale investments

Other comprehensive income, net of tax

Comprehensive loss

(3)    

9     

63     
60     
60     
(23,817)   $

—     
9     
9     
(12,339)   $

14 

9 
23 
23 
(30,747)

  $

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

70

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
     
       
       
 
     
       
       
 
   
   
   
   
 
 
Table of Contents

CUTERA, INC.
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY
(in thousands, except share amounts)

Balance at December 31, 2017
Adjustment to opening balance for ASC 606

adoption

Issuance of common stock for employee

purchase plan

Exercise of stock options
Issuance of common stock in settlement of

restricted and performance stock units, net
of shares withheld for employee taxes, and
stock awards

Stock-based compensation expense
Net loss
Net change in unrealized gain on available-

for-sale investments

Balance at December 31, 2018

Issuance of common stock for employee

purchase plan

Exercise of stock options
Issuance of common stock in settlement of

restricted and performance stock units, net
of shares withheld for employee taxes, and
stock awards

Stock-based compensation expense
Net loss
Net change in unrealized gain on available-

for-sale investments

Balance at December 31, 2019
Issuance of common stock for employee

purchase plan

Exercise of stock options
Issuance of common stock in connection with
public offering, net of issuance costs of
$2,303

Issuance of common stock in settlement of

restricted and performance stock units, net
of shares withheld for employee taxes, and
stock awards

Stock-based compensation expense
Net loss
Net change in unrealized gain on available-

for-sale investments

Balance at December 31, 2020

Common Stock

Shares

    Amount

Additional
Paid-in
Capital

Retained
Earnings
(Accumulated   
Deficit)

Accumulated
Other
Comprehensive   
Income (loss)    

Total
Stockholders’  
Equity

13,477,973    $

13    $

62,025    $

2,947    $

(92)   $

64,893 

-     

64,511     
271,902     

154,466     
-     
-     

-     
13,968,852    $

-     

1     
-     

-     
-     
-     

-     
14    $

-     

3,813     

1,680     
2,718     

-     
-     

(3,129)    
7,157     
-     

-     
-     
(30,770)    

-     

-     
-     

-     
-     
-     

-     
70,451    $

-     
(24,010)   $

23     
(69)   $

82,810     
160,798     

-     
-     

1,281     
1,613     

-     
-     

103,126     
-     
-     

-     
14,315,586    $

56,751     
73,227     

-     
-     
-     

-     
14    $

-     

(831)    
9,832     
-     

-     
-     
(12,348)    

-     
82,346    $

-     
(36,358)   $

632     
947     

-     
-     

2,742,750     

3     

26,492     

490,918     
-     
-     

1     
-     
-     

(3,429)    
10,109     
-     

-     
-     
(23,877)    

-     
17,679,232    $

-     
18    $

-     
117,097    $

-     
(60,235)   $

-     
-     

-     
-     
-     

9     
(60)   $

-     
-     

-     
-     
-     

60     
-    $

3,813 

1,681 
2,718 

(3,129)
7,157 
(30,770)

23 
46,386 

1,281 
1,613 

(831)
9,832 
(12,348)

9 
45,942 

632 
947 

26,495 

(3,428)
10,109 
(23,877)

60 
56, 880 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

71

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
 
   
   
   
 
 
     
       
       
       
       
       
 
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
 
     
       
       
       
       
       
 
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
     
   
     
     
   
   
   
   
   
 
 
Table of Contents

CUTERA, INC.
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
(in thousands)

Cash flows from operating activities:

Net loss
Adjustments to reconcile net loss to net cash provided by (used in) operating
activities:

2020

Year Ended December 31,
2019

2018

  $

(23,877)   $

(12,348)   $

(30,770)

Stock-based compensation
Depreciation and amortization
Amortization of contract acquisition costs
Impairment of capitalized cloud computing costs
Change in deferred tax assets
Provision for credit losses
Change in right-of-use asset
Other

Changes in assets and liabilities:
Accounts receivable
Inventories
Other current assets and prepaid expenses
Other long-term assets
Accounts payable
Accrued liabilities
Extended warranty liabilities
Other long-term liabilities
Operating lease liabilities
Deferred revenue
Income tax liability

Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities

Cash flows from investing activities:

   Acquisition of property and equipment
   Disposal of property and equipment
   Proceeds from sales of marketable investments
   Proceeds from maturities of marketable investments
   Purchase of marketable investments

Net cash provided by investing activities

Cash flows from financing activities:

Proceeds from exercise of stock options and employee stock purchase plan
Proceeds from long-term debt
Gross proceeds from issuance of common stock in connection with public
offering
Issuance costs on the public offering
Taxes paid related to net share settlement of equity awards
Payments on capital lease obligation
Net cash provided by financing activities

Net increase in cash and cash equivalents
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year
Cash and cash equivalents at end of year
Supplemental cash flow information:

Cash paid for interest
Cash paid (refunded) for income taxes, net of (refunds) payments

Supplemental non-cash investing and financing activities:

   Assets acquired under finance lease
   Assets acquired under operating lease

  $

  $
  $

  $
  $

10,109     
1,394     
2,593     
805     
(220)    
2,144     
2,522     
513     

(2,550)    
5,413     
(3,164)    
(2,067)    
(6,034)    
944     
(783)    
—     
(1,598)    
(2,985)    
(93)    
(16,934)    

(1,279)    
30     
5,648     
28,050     
(26,060)    
6,389     

1,579     
7,167     

28,798     
(2,303)    
(3,428)    
(537)    
31,276     
20,731     
26,316     
47,047    $

63    $
(1)   $

43    $
11,735    $

9,832     
1,548     
2,915     
—     
34     
590     
2,502     
(83)    

(2,509)    
(5,907)    
(1,762)    
(3,355)    
1,406     
7,157     
(1,160)    
(140)    
(2,292)    
1,656     
(301)    
(2,217)    

(991)    
45     
—     
14,700     
(12,687)    
1,067     

2,894     
—     

—     
—     
(831)    
(649)    
1,414     
264     
26,052     
26,316    $

81    $
59    $

738    $
—    $

7,157 
1,209 
1,834 
— 
17,438 
1,257 
— 
241 

(117)
768 
(1,070)
(2,754)
4,277 
(3,781)
3,159 
140 

1,305 
15 
308 

(1,488)
41 
13,044 
10,050 
(10,874)
10,773 

4,399 
— 

— 
— 
(3,129)
(483)
787 
11,868 
14,184 
26,052 

85 
472 

610 
— 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

72

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
     
       
       
 
     
       
       
 
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
     
       
       
 
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
 
   
   
   
     
       
       
 
   
   
   
   
   
   
     
       
       
 
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
     
       
       
 
     
       
       
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

CUTERA, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

NOTE 1—SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES

Description of Operations and Principles of Consolidation

Cutera, Inc. (“Cutera” or the “Company”) provides energy-based aesthetic systems for practitioners worldwide. The Company develops, manufactures,
distributes, and markets energy-based product platforms for use by physicians and other qualified practitioners, enabling them to offer safe and effective
aesthetic treatments to their customers. The Company currently markets the following system platforms: enlighten, excel, Secret PRO, Juliet, Secret RF,
truSculpt and xeo.  Several  of  the  Company’s  systems  offer  multiple  hand  pieces  and  applications,  providing  customers  the  flexibility  to  upgrade  their
systems.  The  sales  of  (i)  systems,  system  upgrades,  and  hand  pieces  (collectively  “Systems”  revenue);  (ii)  replacement  hand  pieces,  Titan,  truSculpt
3D,truSculpt  iD  and truSculpt flex cycle  refills,  as  well  as  single  use  disposable  tips  applicable  to Secret PRO,  Juliet  and  Secret  RF  (“Consumables”
revenue);  (iii)  the  distribution  of  third  party  manufactured  skincare  products  (“Skincare”  revenue);  and  (iv)  the  leasing  of  equipment  through  a
membership program; are collectively classified as “Products” revenue. In addition to Products revenue, the Company generates revenue from the sale of
post-warranty  service  contracts,  parts,  detachable  hand  piece  replacements  (except  for  Titan, truSculpt 3D,  truSculpt  iD  and  truSculpt flex  and  service
labor for the repair and maintenance of products that are out of warranty, all of which are collectively classified as “Service” revenue.

The  Company’s  corporate  headquarters  and  U.S.  operations  are  located  in  Brisbane,  California,  where  the  Company  conducts  manufacturing,
warehousing,  research  and  development,  regulatory,  sales  and  marketing,  service,  and  administrative  activities.  The  Company  also  maintains  regional
distribution centers (“RDCs”) in selection locations across the U.S. These RDCs serve as forward warehousing for systems and service parts in various
geographies. The Company markets sells and services the Company’s products through direct sales and service employees in North America (including
Canada), Australia, Austria, Belgium, France, Germany, Hong Kong, Japan, Spain, Switzerland, and the United Kingdom. Sales and services outside of
these direct markets are made through a worldwide distributor network in over 42 countries. The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of
the Company and its subsidiaries. All inter-company transactions and balances have been eliminated.

Use of Estimates

The preparation of consolidated financial statements in conformity with GAAP requires the Company’s management to make estimates and assumptions
that  affect  the  amounts  reported  of  assets  and  liabilities  and  disclosure  of  contingent  assets  and  liabilities  at  the  date  of  the  consolidated  financial
statements  and  the  accompanying  notes,  and  the  reported  amounts  of  revenue  and  expenses  during  the  reported  periods.  Actual  results  could  differ
materially from those estimates.

On an ongoing basis, management evaluates its estimates, including those related to warranty obligations, sales commission, allowance for credit losses,
sales  allowances,  valuation  of  inventories,  fair  value  of  goodwill,  useful  lives  of  property  and  equipment,  impairment  testing  for  long-lived-assets,
implicit  and  incremental  borrowing  rates  related  to  the  Company’s  leases,  assumptions  regarding  variables  used  in  calculating  the  fair  value  of  the
Company's equity awards, expected achievement of performance based vesting criteria, management performance bonuses, assumptions used in operating
and  sales-type  lease  classification,  the  standalone  selling  price  of  the  Company's  products  and  services,  the  period  of  benefit  used  to  capitalize  and
amortize contract acquisition costs, variable consideration, contingent liabilities, recoverability of deferred tax assets, residual value of leased equipment,
lease term and effective income tax rates. Management bases estimates on historical experience and on various other assumptions that are believed to be
reasonable, the results of which form the basis for making judgments about the carrying values of assets and liabilities.

Risks and Uncertainties

The Company's future results of operations involve a number of risks and uncertainties. Factors that could affect the Company's future operating results
and  cause  actual  results  to  vary  materially  from  expectations  include,  but  are  not  limited  to,  rapid  technological  change,  continued  acceptance  of  the
Company's  products,  stability  of  global  financial  markets,  cybersecurity  breaches  and  other  disruptions  that  could  compromise  the  Company’s
information or results, business disruptions that are caused by natural disasters or pandemic events, management of international activities, competition
from substitute products and larger companies, ability to obtain and maintain regulatory approvals, government regulations and oversight, patent and other
types of litigation, ability to protect proprietary technology from counterfeit versions of the Company's products, strategic relationships and dependence
on key individuals.

In March 2020, the World Health Organization declared the COVID-19 outbreak a pandemic. The COVID-19 outbreak has negatively affected the United
States and global economies. The spread of the coronavirus, which caused a broad impact in 2020 globally, including restrictions on travel, shifting work
force to work remotely and quarantine policies put into place by businesses and governments, had a material economic effect on the Company’s business
during  the  year  ended  December  31,  2020.  Notably,  healthcare  facilities  in  many  countries  effectively  banned  elective  procedures.  Many  of  the
Company’s products are used in aesthetic elective procedures and as such, the bans on elective procedures substantially reduced the Company’s sales and
marketing  efforts  in  the  early  months  of  the  pandemic  and  led  the  Company  to  implement  cost  control  measures.  While  the  Company  hopes  that  the
customers will return and the amount of revenue will increase in 2021 as the economic environment outlook due to the COVID-19 pandemic improves,
the COVID-19 outbreak continues to be fluid and the aftermath of the business and economic disruptions due to the COVID-19 is still uncertain, making
it difficult to forecast the final impact it could have on the Company’s future operations, including disruptions in the Company's supply chain and contract
manufacturing operations. The Company cannot presently predict the scope and severity of any impacts in future periods from the business shutdowns or
disruptions due to the COVID-19 pandemic, but the impact on economic activity such as the possibility of recession or financial market instability could
have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business, revenue, operating results, cash flows and financial condition. As a result of the events and
impact surrounding the COVID-19 pandemic, the Company assessed whether any impairment of its goodwill or its long-lived assets had occurred, and
has determined that no charges other than an impairment loss of $0.8 million on capitalized cloud computing costs related to the indefinite delay of the
implementation  of  cloud-based  enterprise  resource  planning  software  had  occurred  during  2020.  The  Company’s  assumptions  about  future  conditions
important to its assessment of potential impairment of its long-lived assets, and goodwill, including the impacts of the COVID–19 pandemic and other
ongoing  impacts  to  its  business,  are  subject  to  uncertainty,  and  the  Company  will  continue  to  monitor  these  conditions  in  future  periods  as  new
information becomes available, and will update its analyses accordingly. 

Comparability

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
The Company adopted the new lease standard effective January 1, 2019, using  the  modified  retrospective  method.  Prior  period  financial  statements
were not retrospectively restated. The financial results for the years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019 were prepared using the new lease accounting
standard whereas the financial results for the year ended December 31, 2018 were prepared using prior effective guidance. As a result, the consolidated
statement of operations for the years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019 is not directly comparable to the consolidated statements of operations for the
year ended December 31, 2018.

73

 
 
Table of Contents

Recently Adopted Accounting Pronouncements

In June 2016, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) issued Accounting Standards Update (“ASU”) No. 2016-13, Financial Instruments-
Credit Losses (Topic 326):"Measurement of Credit Losses on Financial Instruments", which replaces the incurred loss methodology with an expected
credit loss methodology that is referred to as the current expected credit loss (CECL) methodology. ASU 2016-13 is effective for fiscal years beginning
after December 15, 2019, with early adoption permitted. The amendments in this update are required to be applied using the modified retrospective
method with an adjustment to accumulated deficit and are effective for the Company beginning with fiscal year 2020, including interim periods. The
measurement  of  expected  credit  losses  under  the  CECL  methodology  is  applicable  to  financial  assets  measured  at  amortized  cost,  including  loan
receivables, available for sale securities and held-to-maturity debt securities. An entity with available for sale securities and trade receivables will be
required to use historical loss information, current conditions, and reasonable and supportable forecasts to determine expected lifetime credit losses.
Pooling of assets with similar risk characteristics is also required. The Company adopted ASU 2016-13 on January 1, 2020 on a modified retrospective
basis. Upon adoption, the standard did not have a material impact on the consolidated financial statements.

The Company identified trade receivables and available-for-sale debt securities as impacted by the new guidance. However, the Company determined
that the historical losses related to these available-for-sale debt securities are not material as the Company invests in high grade short-term securities.

The Company establishes an allowance for credit losses on trade receivables based on the credit quality of clients, current economic conditions, the age
of the accounts receivable balances, historical loss information, and current conditions and forecasted information, and write-off amounts against the
allowance when they are deemed uncollectible.

The Company’s allowance for credit losses increased from $1.4 million at January 1, 2020 to $1.6 million at December 31, 2020, due to increase in
aged accounts receivable. During the year ended December 31, 2020, the Company recognized a provision for credit losses of $2.1 million and wrote
off $1.2 million against the allowance for credit losses.

In  August  2018,  the  FASB  issued  ASU  No.  2018-13,  “Fair  Value  Measurement  (Topic  820):  Disclosure  Framework-  Changes  to  the  Disclosure
Requirements for Fair Value Measurement”, to improve the fair value measurement reporting of financial instruments. The amendments in this update
require, among other things, added disclosure of the range and weighted average of significant unobservable inputs used to develop Level 3 fair value
measurements. The amendments in this update eliminate, among other things, disclosure of the reasons for and amounts of transfers between Level 1
and  Level  2  for  assets  and  liabilities  that  are  measured  at  fair  value  on  a  recurring  basis  and  an  entity's  valuation  processes  for  Level  3  fair  value
measurements.  The  amendments  in  this  update  are  effective  for  the  Company  beginning  with  fiscal  year  2020,  with  early  adoption  permitted.
Retrospective  application  is  required  for  all  amendments  in  this  update  except  the  added  disclosures,  which  should  be  applied  prospectively.  The
adoption of the amendments in this update did not have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial position and results of operations.

Recently Issued Accounting Pronouncements Not Yet Adopted by the Company

In December 2019, the FASB issued ASU No. 2019-12 “Income Taxes (Topic 740)-Simplifying the Accounting for Income Taxes”, to remove certain
exceptions and improve consistency of application, including, among other things, requiring that an entity reflect the effect of an enacted change in tax
laws or rates in the annual effective tax rate computation in the interim period that includes the enactment date. The amendments in this update will be
effective  for  the  Company  beginning  with  fiscal  year  2021,  with  early  adoption  permitted.  Most  amendments  within  the  standard  are  required  to  be
applied  on  a  prospective  basis,  while  certain  amendments  must  be  applied  on  a  retrospective  or  modified  retrospective  basis.  The  adoption  of  the
amendments in this update is not expected to have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial position and results of operations.

In March  2020,  the  FASB  issued  ASU  No. 2020-04,  “Reference  Rate  Reform  (Topic  848):  Facilitation  of  the  Effects  of  Reference  Rate  Reform  on
Financial Reporting.” ASU No. 2020-04 provides optional expedients and exceptions for applying U.S. GAAP to contract modifications and hedging
relationships, subject to meeting certain criteria that reference LIBOR or another rate that is expected to be discontinued. The amendments in ASU No.
2020-04 are effective for all entities as of March 12, 2020 through December 31, 2022. The Company is currently assessing the impact of ASU No.
2020-04 and the LIBOR transition on its consolidated financial statements.
In August 2020, the FASB issued ASU No. 2020-06,  "Debt  –  Debt  with  Conversion  and  Other  Options  (Topic  470)  and  Derivatives  and  Hedging  –
Contracts in Entity’s Own Equity (Topic 815)." This amendment simplifies the accounting for convertible debt instruments by removing the beneficial
conversion and cash conversion separation models for convertible instruments. Under the amendment, the embedded conversion features are no longer
separated from the host contract for convertible instruments with conversion features that are not required to be accounted for as derivatives or that do
not result in substantial premiums accounted for as paid-in capital. The update also amends the accounting for certain contracts in an entity’s own equity
that  are  currently  accounted  for  as  derivatives  because  of  specific  settlement  provisions.  In  addition,  the  new  guidance  modifies  how  particular
convertible  instruments  and  certain  contracts  that  may  be  settled  in  cash  or  shares  impact  the  computation  of  diluted  earnings  per  share.  The
amendments in this update are effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2021, including interim periods within those fiscal years. Early
adoption  is  permitted,  but  no  earlier  than  fiscal  years  beginning  after  December  15,  2020.  The  Company  is  currently  evaluating  the  impact  of  this
guidance on its consolidated financial statements.

The Company reviewed all other recently issued, but not yet effective, accounting pronouncements and does not expect the future adoption of any such
pronouncements will have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

74

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Revenue recognition

Revenue is recognized upon transfer of control of promised products or services to customers in an amount that reflects the consideration to which the
Company expects to be entitled in exchange for promised goods or services. The Company’s performance obligations are satisfied either over time or at
a  point  in  time.  Revenue  from  performance  obligations  that  are  transferred  to  customers  over  time  accounted  for  approximately  15%,  13%  and
12%, respectively, of the Company’s total revenue for the years ended December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018.

The  Company  has  certain  system  sale  arrangements  that  contain  multiple  products  and  services.  For  these  bundled  sale  arrangements,  the  Company
accounts for individual products and services as separate performance obligations if they are distinct. The Company’s products and services are distinct
if a customer can benefit from the product or service on its own or with other resources that are readily available to the customer, and if the Company’s
promise  to  transfer  the  products  or  service  to  the  customer  is  separately  identifiable  from  other  promises  in  the  sale  arrangements.  The  Company’s
system sale arrangements can include all or a combination of the following performance obligations: the system and software license (considered as one
performance  obligation),  system  accessories  (hand  pieces),  training,  other  accessories,  extended  service  contracts,  marketing  services,  and  time  and
materials services.

For  the  Company’s  system  sale  arrangements  that  include  an  extended  service  contract,  the  period  of  service  commences  at  the  expiration  of  the
Company’s standard warranty offered at the time of the system sale. The Company considers the extended service contracts terms in the arrangements
that are legally enforceable to be performance obligations. Other than extended service contracts and marketing services, which are satisfied over time,
the Company generally satisfies all performance obligations at a point in time. Systems, system accessories (hand pieces), service contracts, training,
and time and materials services are also sold on a stand-alone basis, and these performance obligations are satisfied at a point in time. For contracts with
multiple performance obligations, the Company allocates the transaction price of the contract to each performance obligation on a relative standalone
selling price basis.

Nature of Products and Services

Systems

Systems revenue is generated from the sale of systems and from the sale of upgrades to existing systems. A system consists of a console that incorporates
a universal graphic user interface, a laser or other energy-based module, control system software and high voltage electronics, as well as one or more hand
pieces.  In  certain  applications,  the  laser  or  other  energy-based  module  is  contained  in  the  hand  piece,  such  as  with  the  Company’s  Pearl  and  Pearl
Fractional applications, rather than within the console.

The  Company  offers  customers  the  ability  to  select  the  system  that  best  fits  their  practice  at  the  time  of  purchase  and  then  to  cost-effectively  add
applications to their system as their practice grows. This provides customers the flexibility to upgrade their systems whenever they choose and provides
the Company with a source of additional Systems revenue.

The system or upgrade and the right to use the embedded software represent a single performance obligation as the software license is integral to the
functionality of the system or upgrade.

For  systems  sold  directly  to  end-customers  that  are  credit  approved,  revenue  is  recognized  when  the  Company  transfers  control  to  the  end-customer,
which occurs when the product is shipped to the customer or when the customer receives the product, depending on the nature of the arrangement. When
collectability is not established in advance of receipt of payment from the customer, revenue is recognized upon the later of the receipt of payment or the
satisfaction of the performance obligation. For systems sold through credit approved distributors, revenue is recognized at the time of shipment to the
distributor.

The  Company  typically  receives  payment  for  its  system  consoles  and  other  accessories  within  30  days  of  shipment.  Certain  international  distributor
arrangements allow for longer payment terms. 

Skincare products

The Company sells third-party manufactured skincare products in Japan. The skincare products are purchased from a third-party manufacturer and sold to
medical offices and licensed physicians. The Company warrants that the skincare products are free of significant defects in workmanship and materials for
90 days from shipment. These are typically sold in a separate contract as the only performance obligations. The Company acts as the principal in this
arrangement, as the Company determines the price to charge customers for the skincare products and controls the products before they are transferred to
the customer. The Company recognizes revenue for skincare products at a point in time upon shipment.

Consumables and other accessories

The Company classifies its customers' purchases of replacement cycles for truSculpt iD and truSculpt flex, as well as replacement hand pieces, Titan and
truSculpt 3D hand pieces, and single use disposable tips applicable to Secret PRO, Juliet, and Secret RF,  as  Consumable  revenue,  which  provides  the
Company with a source of recurring revenue from existing customers. The Juliet and Secret RF products’ single use disposable tips must be replaced after
every treatment. Sales of these consumable tips further enhance the Company’s recurring revenue. The Company’s systems offer multiple hand pieces and
applications, which allow customers to upgrade their systems.

Equipment leasing

The  Company  leases  equipment  to  customers  through  membership  programs  and  receives  a  fixed  monthly  fee  over  the  term  of  the  arrangement.  The
Company classifies its lease income as product revenue. The Company recognizes lease income over the term of the lease if the lease is classified as an
operating lease. For agreements that grant customers the right to purchase the leased system, the Company typically classifies the lease as a sales-type
lease as the Company has determined it is reasonably certain that the customer will exercise the purchase option. On the commencement of sales-type
leases,  the  Company  recognizes  revenue  upfront  in  product  revenue  and  the  corresponding  receivables  recorded  in  Other  current  assets  and  prepaid
expenses on the consolidated balance sheets (Notes 1 and 11). Revenue from equipment leases was not material in the year ended December 31, 2020.

75

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Extended contract services

The Company offers post-warranty services to its customers through extended service contracts that cover parts and labor for a term of one, two, or three
years. Service contract revenue is recognized over time, using a time-based measure of progress, as customers benefit from the service throughout the
service period. The Company also offers services on a time-and-materials basis for systems and detachable hand piece replacements. Revenue related to
services performed on a time-and-materials basis is recognized when performed. These post-warranty services serve as additional sources of recurring
revenue from the Company’s installed product base.

Training

Sales of systems to customers include training on the use of the system to be provided within 180 days of purchase. The Company considers training a
separate  performance  obligation  as  customers  can  immediately  benefit  from  the  training  together  with  the  customer’s  system.  Training  is  also  sold
separately from systems. The Company recognizes revenue for training when the training is provided. Training is not required for customers to use the
systems.

Customer Marketing Support

In North America, the Company offers marketing and consulting phone support to its customers across all system platforms. These customer marketing
support services include a practice development model and marketing training, performed remotely with ongoing phone consultations for six months from
date of purchase. The Company considers customer marketing support a separate performance obligation and recognizes revenue over the six-month term
of the contracts.

The Company classifies as product revenue the sales of systems, system upgrades, hand pieces, hand piece refills (applicable to Titan® and truSculpt) and
the distribution of third-party manufactured skincare products.

Significant Judgments

The determination of whether two or more contracts entered into at or near the same time with the same customer should be combined and accounted for
as one contract may require the use of significant judgment. In making this determination, the Company considers whether the contracts are negotiated as
a package with a single commercial objective, have price interdependencies, or promise goods or services that represent a single performance obligation.

While  the  Company’s  purchase  agreements  do  not  provide  customers  with  a  contractual  right  of  return,  the  Company  maintains  a  sales  allowance  to
account for potential returns or refunds as a reduction in transaction price at the time of sale.

The Company determines standalone selling price ("SSP") for each performance obligation as follows:

● Systems: The SSPs for systems are based on directly observable sales in similar circumstances to similar customers.
● Extended service contracts: SSP is based on observable price when sold on a standalone basis to similar customers.

Loyalty Program

The Company launched a customer loyalty program during the third quarter of 2018 for qualified customers located in the U.S. and Canada. Under the
loyalty  program,  customers  accumulate  points  based  on  their  purchasing  levels  which  can  be  redeemed  for  such  rewards  as  the  right  to  attend  the
Company’s advanced training event for truSculpt, or a ticket for the Company’s annual forum. A customer’s account must be in good standing to receive
the benefits of the rewards program. Rewards are earned on a quarterly basis and must be used in the following quarter. All unused rewards are forfeited.
The fair value of the reward earned by loyalty program members is included in accrued liabilities and recorded as a reduction. of net revenue at the time
the reward is earned. As of December 31, 2020, the accrual for the loyalty program included in accrued liabilities was $0.3 million.

Deferred Sales Commissions

Incremental costs of obtaining a contract, which consist primarily of commissions and related payroll taxes, are capitalized, and amortized on a straight-
line  basis  over  the  expected  period  of  benefit,  except  for  costs  that  are  recognized  when  product  is  sold.  The  Company  uses  the  portfolio  method  to
recognize the amortization expense related to these capitalized costs related to initial contracts and such expense is recognized over a period associated
with the revenue of the related portfolio, which is generally two to three years.

Total capitalized costs for the year ended December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019 were $3.4 million and $4.6 million, respectively, and are included in
Other  long-term  assets  in  the  Company’s  consolidated  balance  sheet.  Amortization  expenses  for  these  assets  were  $2.6  million,  $2.9  million  and  $1.8
million, respectively, during the years ended December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018 and were included in sales and marketing expense in the Company’s
consolidated statement of operations.

Cash Equivalents, and Marketable Investments

The Company invests its cash primarily in money market funds, U.S. Treasury bills and in highly liquid debt instruments of U.S. federal and municipal
governments and their agencies, commercial paper, and corporate debt securities. All highly liquid investments with stated maturities of three months or
less from date of purchase are classified as cash equivalents; all highly liquid investments with stated maturities of greater than three months are classified
as marketable investments. The majority of the Company’s cash and investments are held in U.S. banks and the Company's foreign subsidiaries maintain
a limited amount of cash in their local banks to cover short term operating expenses.

The  Company  determines  the  appropriate  classification  of  its  investments  in  marketable  securities  at  the  time  of  purchase  and  re-evaluates  such
designation at each balance sheet date. The Company’s marketable securities are classified and accounted for as available-for-sale securities. Investments
with remaining maturities of more than one year are viewed by the Company as available to support current operations and are classified as current assets
under the caption marketable investments in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets. Investments in marketable securities are carried at fair value,
with the unrealized gains and losses reported as a component of stockholders’ equity. Any realized gains or losses on the sale of marketable securities are
determined on a specific identification method, and such gains and losses are reflected as a component of Interest and other income (expense), net.

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
76

 
Table of Contents

Fair Value of Financial Instruments

Fair  value  is  an  exit  price  representing  the  amount  that  would  be  received  to  sell  an  asset  or  paid  to  transfer  a  liability  in  the  principal  or  most
advantageous market for the asset or liability in an orderly transaction between market participants on the measurement date. The fair value hierarchy
contains three levels of inputs that may be used to measure fair value, in accordance with ASC 820, as follows:

● Level 1: inputs, which include quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities;
● Level 2:  inputs,  which  include  observable  inputs  other  than  Level  1  inputs,  such  as  quoted  prices  for  similar  assets  or  liabilities,  quoted  prices  for
identical or similar assets or liabilities in markets that are not active, or other inputs that are observable or can be corroborated by observable market data
for  substantially  the  full  term  of  the  asset  or  liability.  For  available-for-sale  securities,  the  Company  reviews  trading  activity  and  pricing  as  of  the
measurement date. When sufficient quoted pricing for identical securities is not available, the Company uses market pricing and other observable market
inputs  for  similar  securities  obtained  from  various  third-party  data  providers.  These  inputs  either  represent  quoted  prices  for  similar  assets  in  active
markets or have been derived from observable market data; and
● Level 3: inputs, which include unobservable inputs that are supported by little or no market activity and that are significant to the fair value of the
underlying asset or liability. Level 3 assets and liabilities include those whose fair value measurements are determined using pricing models, discounted
cash flow methodologies, or similar valuation techniques, as well as significant management judgment or estimation.

In determining fair value, the Company utilizes valuation techniques that maximize the use of observable inputs and minimize the use of unobservable
inputs to the extent possible as well as considers counterparty credit risk in its assessment of fair value.

Impairment of Marketable Investments

After determining the fair value of available-for-sales debt instruments, gains or losses on these securities are recorded to other comprehensive income,
until either the security is sold, or the Company determines that the decline in value is other-than-temporary. The primary differentiating factors that the
Company considers in classifying impairments as either temporary or other-than-temporary impairments are the Company’s intent and ability to retain the
investment in the issuer for a period of time sufficient to allow for any anticipated recovery in market value or the maturity of the investment, the length
of the time and the extent to which the market value of the investment has been less than cost and the financial condition and near-term prospects of the
issuer. The Company had no investments as of December 31, 2020. There were no other-than-temporary impairments in the years ended December 31,
2020, 2019 and 2018.

Allowance for Sales Returns and Credit Losses

The allowance for sales returns is based on the Company’s estimates of potential future product returns and other allowances related to current period
product revenue. The Company analyzes historical returns, current economic trends and changes in customer demand and acceptance of the Company's
products.

The  allowance  for  credit  losses  on  trade  receivables  is  based  on  the  credit  quality  of  clients,  current  economic  conditions,  the  age  of  the  accounts
receivable  balances,  historical  loss  information,  and  current  conditions  and  forecasted  information.  The  Company  writes  off  amounts  against  the
allowance when they are deemed uncollectible.

Concentration of Credit Risk and Other Risks and Uncertainties

The  Company  operates  in  markets  that  are  highly  competitive  and  rapidly  changing.  Significant  technological  changes,  shifting  customer  needs,  the
emergence of competitive products or services with new capabilities and other factors could negatively impact the Company’s operating results.

The Company is also subject to risks related to changes in the value of the Company’s significant balance of financial instruments. Financial instruments
that  potentially  subject  the  Company  to  concentrations  of  risk  consist  principally  of  cash,  cash  equivalents,  marketable  investments,  and  accounts
receivable. The Company’s cash and cash equivalents are primarily invested in deposits and money market accounts with three major financial institutions
in the U.S. In addition, the Company has operating cash balances in banks in each of the international locations in which it operates. Deposits in these
banks  may  exceed  the  federally  insured  limits  or  any  other  insurance  provided  on  such  deposits,  if  any.  Management  believes  that  these  financial
institutions are financially sound and, accordingly, believes that minimal credit risk exists. To date, the Company has not experienced any losses on its
deposits of cash and cash equivalents.

The Company invests in debt instruments, including bonds of the U.S. Government, its agencies, and its municipalities. The Company has also invested in
other high grade investments such as commercial paper and corporate debt securities. The Company has established guidelines relative to credit ratings,
diversification and maturities that seek to maintain safety and liquidity. By policy, the Company restricts its exposure to any single issuer by imposing
concentration  limits.  To  minimize  the  exposure  due  to  adverse  shifts  in  interest  rates,  the  Company  maintains  investments  at  an  average  maturity  of
generally less than twelve months.

Accounts receivable are recorded net of an allowance for credit losses and are typically unsecured and are derived from revenue earned from worldwide
customers.  The  Company  controls  credit  risk  through  credit  approvals,  credit  limits,  and  monitoring  procedures.  The  Company  performs  credit
evaluations of its customers and maintains an allowance for potential credit losses. As of December 31, 2020, and 2019, no customer represented more
than 10% of the Company’s net accounts receivable. During the years ended December 31, 2020, 2019, and 2018, domestic revenue accounted for 41%,
58%  and  62%,  respectively,  of  total  revenue,  while  international  revenue  accounted  for  59%,  42%  and  38%,  respectively,  of  total  revenue.  No single
customer represented more than 10% of total revenue for any of the years ended December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018.

Supplier concentration

The  Company  relies  on  third  parties  for  the  supply  of  components  of  its  products,  as  well  as  third-party  logistics  providers.  In  instances  where  these
parties fail to perform their obligations, the Company may be unable to find alternative suppliers or satisfactorily deliver its products to its customers. The
Company relies on one supplier for its Secret and Secret PRO products and one supplier for its skincare products.

77

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Inventories

Inventories are stated at the lower of cost and net realizable value, cost being determined on a standard cost basis which approximates actual cost on a
first-in, first-out basis. Net realizable value is the estimated selling prices in the ordinary course of the Company’s business, less reasonably predictable
costs of completion, disposal, and transportation. The cost basis of the Company’s inventory is reduced for any products that are considered excessive or
obsolete based upon assumptions about future demand and market conditions.

The Company includes demonstration units within inventories. Demonstration units are carried at cost and amortized over an estimated economic life of
two years. Amortization expense related to demonstration units is recorded in products cost of revenue or in the respective operating expense line based
on which function and purpose for which the demonstration units are being used. Proceeds from the sale of demonstration units are recorded as revenue
and all costs incurred to refurbish the systems prior to sale are charged to product cost of revenue.

During the year ended December 31, 2020, the Company wrote-off $0.8 million of inventory on hand related to its Juliet platform due to declining sales.
Sales related to Juliet have been declining due to the COVID-19 pandemic and the FDA letter issued on July 30, 2018 expressing concerns regarding
“vaginal  rejuvenation”  procedures  using  energy-based  devices. As  of  December  31,  2020  and  2019,  demonstration  inventories,  net  of  accumulated
depreciation, included in finished goods inventory was $2.2 million and $4.1 million, respectively.

Property and Equipment

Property and equipment are stated at cost, net of accumulated depreciation. Depreciation expense recognized is on a straight-line basis over the estimated
useful lives of the assets, generally as follows:

Leasehold improvements
Equipment leasing
Office equipment and furniture
Machinery and equipment

  Useful Lives
  Lesser of useful life or term of lease 
  4.5
  3
  3

Upon sale or retirement of property and equipment, the costs and related accumulated depreciation and amortization are removed from the balance sheet
and the resulting gain or loss is reflected in operating expenses. Maintenance and repairs are charged to operations as incurred.

Depreciation  expense  related  to  property  and  equipment  for  2020,  2019  and  2018,  was  $1.4  million,  $1.5  million,  and  $1.2  million,  respectively.
Amortization  expense  for  vehicles  leased  under  capital  leases  is  included  in  depreciation  expense.  Amortization  expense  related  to  equipment  leasing
accounted for as sales type is included in cost of revenue and was immaterial as of December 31, 2020.

Capitalized Cloud Computing Set-up Cost

The  Company  capitalizes  certain  set-up  costs  for  the  Company’s  cloud  computing  arrangements.  The  capitalized  implementation  costs  are  then
amortized  over  the  term  of  the  cloud  computing  arrangement  inclusive  of  expected  contract  renewals,  which  are  generally  three  to  five  years.  The
Company  periodically  assesses  the  capitalized  asset  for  impairment  and,  when  required,  will  record  an  associated  impairment  loss.  During  the  year
ended December 31, 2020, the Company recognized in general and administrative expense an impairment loss of $0.8 million for capitalized cloud
computing costs related to a cloud-based enterprise resource planning software.

Goodwill and Intangible Assets

Goodwill and intangible assets with indefinite useful lives are not amortized but are tested for impairment at least annually during the fourth quarter of
the Company’s fiscal year, or if circumstances indicate their value may no longer be recoverable. Goodwill represents the excess of the purchase price
over the fair value of net identifiable assets and liabilities.

The Company continues to operate in one segment, which is considered to be the sole reporting unit and, therefore, goodwill was tested for impairment
at the enterprise level. As of December 31, 2020, there has been no impairment of goodwill. All acquired intangible assets have been fully amortized as
of December 31, 2020.

Warranty Obligations

The Company offers post-warranty services to its customers through extended service contracts that cover replacement parts and labor for a term of
one, two, or three years. For sales to distributors, the Company generally provides a 14 to 16 month warranty for parts only, with labor being provided
to the end customer by the distributor.

The Company also offers services on a time-and-materials basis for detachable hand piece replacements, parts, and labor.

Leases

Effective January 1, 2019, the Company adopted ASC 842,  which  established  a  right-of-use  ("ROU")  model  requiring  lessees  to  record  a  right-of-use
asset  ("ROU  asset")  and  lease  obligations  on  the  balance  sheet  for  all  leases  with  terms  longer  than  12  months.  The  Company  determines  if  an
arrangement  is  a  lease  at  inception.  Where  an  arrangement  is  a  lease  the  Company  determines  if  it  is  an  operating  lease  or  a  finance  lease.  At  lease
commencement, the Company records a lease liability and corresponding ROU asset. Lease liabilities represent the present value of the Company’s future
lease payments over the expected lease term which includes options to extend or terminate the lease when it is reasonably certain those options will be
exercised. The present value of the Company’s lease liability is determined using its incremental collateralized borrowing rate at lease inception. ROU
assets represent its right to control the use of the leased asset during the lease and are recognized in an amount equal to the lease liability for leases with
an initial term greater than 12 months. Over the lease term (operating leases only), the Company uses the effective interest rate method to account for the
lease liability as lease payments are made and the ROU asset is amortized to consolidated statement of operations in a manner that results in straight-line
expense  recognition.  The  Company  does  not  apply  lease  recognition  requirements  for  short-term  leases.  Instead,  the  Company  recognizes  payments
related to these arrangements in the consolidated statement of operations as lease costs on a straight-line basis over the lease term.

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
78

 
Table of Contents

Accounting for Leases as a Lessor

During the second quarter of 2020, the Company began leasing equipment to customers through a membership program where the customer pays a fixed
monthly  fee  over  the  lease  term.  Along  with  the  leased  equipment,  the  membership  program  provides  customers  with  a  warranty  service  and  a  fixed
amount  of  consumables  per  month  for  the  term  of  the  lease.  The  Company  has  made  an  accounting  policy  election  to  account  for  qualifying  lease
components and associated non-lease components as a single component; accordingly, a lease component and an associated warranty service non-lease
component are combined and accounted for as an operating lease. The consumables do not qualify for the practical expedient and are accounted for as a
separate  non-lease  component  in  accordance  with  Topic  606  on  Revenue  from  Contracts  with  Customers.  The  Company  allocates  the  membership
program contract consideration to each component proportionately on a relative standalone selling price basis.

The lease agreements are typically for three years; however, the customer has the ability to terminate the lease after twelve months with no penalty. As
such, the Company has determined the initial term of the lease to be twelve-months, after which the lease converts to a month-to-month lease for up to an
additional two years. Rental charges are a fixed monthly fee, paid at the beginning of each month, over the term of the lease. Except when modified to
include a purchase option as discussed below, all leases entered into under the membership program during the year were classified as operating leases.

The  initial  direct  costs  related  to  the  Company’s  operating  leases  for  equipment  rentals  include  the  related  commissions  paid  to  employees  upon  the
origination  of  a  lease  agreement.  These  costs  are  included  in  Other  current  assets  and  prepaid  expenses  on  the  consolidated  balance  sheets  and  are
amortized  over  the  lease  term  of  twelve-months.  The  amount  of  initial  direct  costs  and  the  related  amortization  recognized  during  the  year  ended 
December 31, 2020 was immaterial.

During the fourth quarter of 2020, the Company modified certain membership agreements under the program to grant the lessee the exclusive right and
option to purchase the leased system from the Company, at any time during the period of 12 months from signing the amended agreement. The option will
expire if it remained unexercised by the customer within that time frame. Upon the expiration of the option, the agreement will revert back to the original
membership agreement, with no  purchase  option.  For  contracts  signed  under  the  amended  membership  agreement,  and  that  met  the  Company’s  credit
approval  policy,  the  Company  classified  the  lease  agreements  as  sales-type  leases  due  to  the  purchase  option.  Under  the  sales-type  lease,  both  the
consumables and warranty services are accounted for as a separate non-lease component in accordance with Topic 606 on Revenue from Contracts with
Customers.

At the commencement of these sales-type leases, the Company recognizes revenue up-front, and amounts due from the customer under the lease contract
are recognized as lease receivables on the consolidated balance sheets. Interest income is recognized as net revenue over the term of the lease based on the
effective interest method. The Company has elected not to include sales and other taxes collected from the lessee as part of lease revenue.

For  these  sales-type  leases,  the  Company  derecognized  the  underlying  assets  under  the  lease  and  recorded  the  net  investment  in  the  lease.  As  the
Company  determined  at  the  commencement  of  the  sales-type  lease  that  it  is  reasonably  certain  the  customer  will  exercise  its  purchase  option,  the
Company does not expect to derive any additional value from the underlying assets and thus recognizes no unguaranteed residual assets.

In  determining  the  proper  classification  and  treatment  of  the  equipment  leases,  the  Company  used  significant  judgment  in  forming  the  following
assumptions and estimates: lease term, implicit rate, fair value of equipment at option exercise date, useful life, residual value of the leased equipment,
and the likelihood that lessees will exercise the purchase option.

See Note 11 to the consolidated financial statements for more information regarding leasing arrangements.

Cost of Revenue

Cost  of  revenue  consists  primarily  of  material,  finished  and  semi-finished  products  purchased  from  third-party  manufacturers,  labor,  stock-based
compensation  expenses,  overhead  involved  in  the  Company's  internal  manufacturing  processes,  service  contracts,  technology  license  amortization  and
royalties, costs associated with equipment leasing, costs associated with product warranties and any inventory write-downs.

The  Company's  system  sales  include  a  control  console,  universal  graphic  user  interface,  control  system  software,  high  voltage  electronics  and  a
combination  of  applications  (referred  to  as  “hand  pieces”).  Hand  pieces  are  programmed  to  have  a  limited  number  of  uses  to  ensure  the  safety  of  the
device  to  patients.  The  Company  sells  refurbished  hand  pieces,  or  "refills,"  of  its  Titan  and  truSculpt  3D  products  and  provides  for  the  cost  of
refurbishment of these hand pieces as part of cost of revenue. When customers purchase a replacement hand piece or are provided a replacement hand
piece under a warranty or service contract, the Company ships the customer a previously refurbished unit. Upon the receipt of the expended hand piece
from the customer, the Company capitalizes the expended hand piece as inventory at the estimated fair value. Cost of service revenue includes the costs
incurred to refurbish hand pieces.

Research and Development Expenditures

Research and development costs are expensed as incurred and include costs related to research, design, development, testing of products, salaries, benefits
and other headcount related costs, facilities, material, third party contractors, regulatory affairs, clinical and development costs.

Advertising Costs

Advertising costs are included as part of sales and marketing expense and are expensed as incurred. Advertising expenses for 2020, 2019 and 2018 were
$1.2 million, $2.8 million and $2.8 million, respectively.

79

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Stock-based Compensation

The Company accounts for share-based employee compensation plans using the fair value recognition and measurement provisions under U.S. GAAP.
The Company’s share-based compensation cost is measured at the grant date, based on the fair value of the award, and is recognized as expense on a
straight- line basis over the requisite service period.

Expected Term: The expected term represents the weighted-average period that the stock options are expected to be outstanding prior to being exercised.
The Company determines expected term based on historical exercise patterns and its expectation of the time it will take for employees to exercise options
still outstanding.

Expected Volatility: For the underlying stock price volatility of the Company’s stock, the Company estimates volatility solely based on the Company’s
historical volatility of its stock price.

Forfeitures: The amount of stock-based compensation recognized during a period is based on the value of the portion of the awards that are ultimately
expected to vest. Under ASC 718 (Stock Based Compensation), the Company has made an accounting policy to estimate forfeitures at the time awards are
granted and revises, if necessary, in subsequent periods if actual forfeitures differ from those estimates.

Risk-Free Interest Rate: The risk-free interest rate is based on the U.S. treasury yield curve in effect at the time of grant for the expected term of the stock
option.

c

The fair value of stock options ("options") on the grant date using the closing price of the Company's common shares on the grant date is estimated using
the Black-Scholes option-pricing model using the single-option approach. The Black-Scholes option pricing model requires the use of highly subjective
and complex assumptions, including the option's expected term and the price volatility of the underlying stock, to determine the fair value of award. The
Company recognizes the expense associated with options using a single award approach over the requisite service period. The Company accounts for all
stock options awarded to non-employees at the fair value of the award issued on the day of the grant.

The fair value of restricted stock units (“RSUs”) granted are measured on the grant date. The quantity of the RSUs units granted is calculated by dividing
a fixed award amount determined by the Board on the grant date by the average closing price of the Company’s common stock over the 50-day period
ending on the day of the grant.

The fair value of Performance Stock Units (“PSUs”) that have operational measurement goals are measured on the grant date using the closing price of
the Company’s common shares on the grant date. The quantity of the PSUs units granted is calculated by dividing a fixed award amount determined by
the Board on the grant date by the average closing price of the Company’s common stock over the 50-day period ending on the day of the grant.

See Note 6 - "Stockholders’ Equity, Stock Plans and Stock-Based Compensation Expense" for a detailed discussion of the Company’s stock plans and
share-based compensation expense.

Income Taxes

The  Company  is  subject  to  income  taxes  in  the  United  States  and  several  foreign  jurisdictions.  Significant  judgment  is  required  in  determining  the
Company’s provision (benefit) for income taxes and income tax assets and liabilities, including evaluating uncertainties in the application of accounting
principles and complex tax laws.

The Company records a provision (benefit) for income taxes for the anticipated tax consequences of the reported results of operations using the asset and
liability  method.  Under  this  method,  the  Company  recognizes  deferred  income  tax  assets  and  liabilities  for  the  expected  future  tax  consequences  of
temporary differences between the financial reporting and tax bases of assets and liabilities, as well as for loss and tax credit carryforwards. Deferred tax
assets and liabilities are measured using the tax rates that are expected to apply to taxable income for the years in which those tax assets and liabilities are
expected  to  be  realized  or  settled.  The  Company  recognizes  the  deferred  income  tax  effects  of  a  change  in  tax  rates  in  the  period  of  enactment.  The
Company records a valuation allowance to reduce the Company’s deferred tax assets to the net amount that the Company believes is more likely than not
to be realized.

The Company recognizes tax benefits from uncertain tax positions if the Company believes that it is more likely than not that the tax position will be
sustained  upon  examination  by  the  taxing  authorities  based  on  the  technical  merits  of  the  position.  Although  the  Company  believes  it  has  adequately
reserved  for  the  Company’s  uncertain  tax  positions  (including  net  interest  and  penalties),  the  Company  can  provide  no  assurance  that  the  final  tax
outcome of these matters will not be different. The Company makes adjustments to these reserves in accordance with income tax accounting guidance
when facts and circumstances change, such as the closing of a tax audit. To the extent that the final tax outcome of these matters is different from the
amounts recorded, such differences may impact the provision (benefit) for income taxes in the period in which such determination is made. The Company
records interest and penalties related to the Company’s uncertain tax positions in the Company’s provision (benefit) for income taxes.

The Company’s effective tax rates have differed from the statutory rate primarily due to changes in the valuation allowance, foreign operations, research
and development tax credits, state taxes, and certain benefits realized related to stock option activity. The Company’s current effective tax rate does not
assume  U.S.  taxes  on  undistributed  profits  of  foreign  subsidiaries.  These  earnings  could  become  subject  to  incremental  foreign  withholding  or  U.S.
federal and state taxes, should they either be deemed or actually remitted to the U.S. The Company’s future effective tax rates could be adversely affected
by earnings being lower in countries where the Company has lower statutory rates and being higher in countries where the Company has higher statutory
rates, or by changes in tax laws, accounting principles, interpretations thereof, net operating loss carryback, research and development tax credits, and due
to changes in the valuation allowance of its U.S. deferred tax assets. In addition, the Company is subject to the examination of the Company’s income tax
returns  by  the  Internal  Revenue  Service  and  other  tax  authorities.  The  Company  regularly  assesses  the  likelihood  of  adverse  outcomes  resulting  from
these examinations to determine the adequacy of the Company’s provision for income taxes.

80

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Undistributed  earnings  of  the  Company’s  foreign  subsidiaries  at  December 31, 2020 are  considered  to  be  indefinitely  reinvested  and,  accordingly,  no
provision  for  state  income  taxes  has  been  provided  thereon.  Due  to  the  Transition  Tax  and  Global  Intangible  Low-Tax  Income  (“GILTI”)  regimes  as
enacted by the 2017 Tax Act, those foreign earnings will not be subject to federal income taxes when actually distributed in the form of a dividend or
otherwise. The Company, however, could still be subject to state income taxes and withholding taxes payable to various foreign countries. The amounts of
taxes which the Company could be subject to are not material to the accompanying financial statements.

On March 27, 2020, the U.S. federal government enacted the Coronavirus Aid, Relief, and Economic Security Act (“CARES Act”). The CARES Act
changed several of the existing U.S. corporate income tax laws by, among other things, increasing the amount of deductible interest, allowing companies
to carry back certain Net Operating Losses (“NOLs”) and increasing the amount of NOLs that corporations can use to offset income. The CARES Act did
not have a material impact on the Company's income tax provision, deferred tax assets and liabilities, and related taxes payable. The Company is currently
assessing the future implications of these provisions within the CARES Act on the Company's consolidated financial statements but does not expect the
impact to be material.

Computation of Net Income (Loss) per Share

Basic net income (loss) per share is computed by dividing net income (loss) by the weighted average number of common shares outstanding. Diluted net
income  per  share  is  computed  by  dividing  net  income  by  the  weighted  average  number  of  common  shares  and  the  dilutive  effect  of  potential  future
issuances  of  common  stock  from  outstanding  stock  options,  RSUs,  PSUs  and  employee  stock  purchase  plan  contributions  for  the  period  outstanding
determined by applying the treasury stock method. Also, the issuance of the Convertible Senior Notes on March 9, 2021 will have a dilutive effect on the
diluted  net  income  per  share.  In  accordance  with  ASC  718,  the  assumed  proceeds  under  the  treasury  stock  method  include  the  average  unrecognized
compensation expense of in-the-money stock options, RSUs and PSUs. This results in the assumed buyback of additional shares, thereby reducing the
dilutive impact of equity awards.

Diluted  earnings  per  share  is  the  same  as  basic  earnings  per  share  for  the  periods  in  which  the  Company  had  a  net  loss  because  the  inclusion  of
outstanding common stock equivalents would be anti-dilutive.

Comprehensive Income (Loss)

Comprehensive income (loss) includes all changes in stockholders’ equity except those resulting from investments or contributions by stockholders. For
the periods presented, the accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) consisted solely of the unrealized gains or losses on the Company's available
for- sale investments, net of tax.

Foreign Currency

The financial statements of the Company’s foreign subsidiaries are translated in accordance with ASC 830, Foreign Currency Matters. The U.S. Dollar is
the functional currency of the Company’s subsidiaries and the Company’s reporting currency. Monetary assets and liabilities are re-measured into U.S.
Dollars at the applicable period end exchange rate. Sales and operating expenses are re-measured at average exchange rates in effect during each period.
Gains  or  losses  resulting  from  foreign  currency  transactions  are  included  in  net  income  (loss)  and  are  insignificant  for  each  of  the  three  years  ended
December 31, 2020. The effect of exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents was insignificant for each of the three years ended December 31,
2020.

Segments

The  Company  operates  in  one  segment  and  reports  segment  information  in  accordance  with  ASC  280,  Segment  Reporting.  Management  uses  one
measurement of profitability and does not segregate its business for internal reporting. As of December 31, 2020 and 2019, 98.0% and 89.3% of long-
lived assets were in the United States, respectively. Revenue is attributed to a geographic region based on the location of the end customer. See Note 10 –
"Segment Information and Revenue by Geography and Products" for details relating to revenue by geography.

NOTE 2-INVESTMENT SECURITIES

The following tables summarize cash, cash equivalents and marketable securities (in thousands):

Cash and cash equivalents:

Cash
Cash equivalents:

Money market funds

Total cash and cash equivalents

Marketable securities:

U.S. government notes
Commercial paper

Total marketable securities

December 31,

2020

2019

  $

47,047    $

—     
47,047     

—     
—     
—     

Total cash, cash equivalents and marketable securities

  $

47,047    $

81

20,005 

6,311 
26,316 

4,114 
3,491 
7,605 

33,921 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
     
       
 
     
       
 
   
   
 
     
       
 
     
       
 
   
   
   
 
     
       
 
 
Table of Contents

The following tables summarize the components, and the unrealized gains and losses position, related to the Company’s cash, cash equivalents and
marketable investments as of December 31, 2020 and 2019 (in thousands):

December 31, 2020
Cash and cash equivalents

Total cash, cash equivalents and marketable securities

December 31, 2019
Cash and cash equivalents

Marketable investments

U.S. government notes
Commercial paper

Total marketable securities
Total cash, cash equivalents and marketable securities

Amortized
Cost

  $

  $

47,047    $

47,047    $

Gross
Unrealized
Gains

Gross
Unrealized
Losses

Fair
Market
Value

—    $

—    $

—    $

47,047 

—    $

47,047 

Amortized
Cost

Gross
Unrealized
Gains

Gross
Unrealized
Losses

Fair
Market
Value

  $

26,316    $

—    $

—    $

26,316 

4,114     
3,491     
7,605     
33,921    $

  $

—     
—     
—     
—    $

—     
—     
—     
—    $

4,114 
3,491 
7,605 
33,921 

As of December 31, 2019, there were no gross unrealized gains and losses. The Company had no marketable securities as of December 31, 2020.

Fair Value Measurements

As of December 31, 2020, the Company had no financial assets measured and recognized at fair value. As of December 31, 2019, financial assets
measured and recognized at fair value on a recurring basis and classified under the appropriate level of the fair value hierarchy as described above were as
follows (in thousands):

December 31, 2019
Cash equivalents:

Money market funds

Short term marketable investments:

Available-for-sale securities

Total assets at fair value

Level 1

Level 2

Level 3

Total

  $

  $

6,311    $

—    $

4,114     
10,425    $

3,491     
3,491    $

—    $

—     
—    $

6,311 

7,605 
13,916 

Money market funds are highly liquid investments and are actively traded. The pricing information on these investment instruments is readily available
and can be independently validated as of the measurement date. This approach results in the classification of these securities as Level 1 of the fair value
hierarchy.

Corporate debt, U.S. government-backed securities and commercial paper are measured at fair value using Level 2 inputs. The Company reviews trading
activity  and  pricing  for  these  investments  as  of  each  measurement  date.  When  sufficient  quoted  pricing  for  identical  securities  is  not  available,  the
Company uses market pricing and other observable market inputs for similar securities obtained from various third-party  data  providers.  These  inputs
represent quoted prices for similar assets in active markets or these inputs have been derived from observable market data. This approach results in the
classification of these securities as Level 2 of the fair value hierarchy. The Company had no Level 1 or Level 2 investments as of December 31, 2020. The
Company recognizes transfers between levels of the fair value hierarchy as of the end of the reporting period.

NOTE 3—BALANCE SHEET DETAIL

Inventories

Valuation adjustments for excess and obsolete inventory, reflected as a reduction of inventory at December 31, 2020 and 2019, were $3.9 million and $2.5
million, respectively. Inventories, net of these adjustments, consist of the following (in thousands):

Raw materials
Work in process
Finished goods

Total

December 31,

2020

2019

  $

  $

14,874    $
1,030     
12,604     
28,508    $

17,935 
2,016 
13,970 
33,921 

82

 
 
 
   
   
   
 
 
     
       
       
       
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
   
 
 
     
       
       
       
 
     
       
       
       
 
   
   
   
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
   
 
     
       
       
       
 
     
       
       
       
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
   
 
 
Table of Contents

Property and Equipment, net

Property and equipment, net, consists of the following (in thousands):

Leasehold improvements
Equipment leasing
Office equipment and furniture
Machinery and equipment

Less: Accumulated depreciation

Property and equipment, net

December 31,

2020

2019

  $

  $

1,051    $
186     
3,407     
7,683     
12,327     
(10,028)    
2,299    $

867 
— 
3,110 
7,805 
11,782 
(8,965)
2,817 

Included  in  machinery  and  equipment  are  financed  vehicles  used  by  the  Company’s  sales  employees.  As  of  December  31,  2020  and 2019,  the  gross
capitalized value of the leased vehicles was $1.6 million and $2.0 million, respectively, and the related accumulated depreciation was $1.2 million and
$1.1 million, respectively. Included in Property and equipment as of December 31, 2020 and 2019 is construction in progress of $0.4 million that is yet to
be depreciated.

Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets

Goodwill and other intangible assets comprise a patent sublicense acquired from Palomar in 2006, intangible assets and goodwill related to the acquisition
of Iridex’s aesthetic business unit, and customer relationships in the Benelux countries acquired from a former distributor in 2013. Goodwill was $1,339
as of December 31, 2020 and 2019  and  there  were  no  changes  to  Goodwill  during  the  years  then  ended.  Intangible  assets  were  fully  amortized  as  of
December 31, 2020 and 2019 and there were no additions during the years then ended. As such, the Company did not incur any amortization expense for
intangible assets during the years ended December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018. There were no impairments or additions to goodwill during the years ended
December 31, 2020 or 2019.

Accrued Liabilities

Accrued liabilities consist of the following (in thousands):

Accrued payroll and related expenses
Sales and marketing accruals
Warranty liability
Accrued sales tax
Other accrued liabilities
Total

Product Remediation Liability

December 31,

2020

2019

12,197    $
2,352     
2,908     
5,343     
8,279     
31,079    $

14,341 
2,527 
4,401 
3,922 
5,116 
30,307 

  $

  $

During the fourth quarter of 2018, the Company recognized a liability for a product remediation plan related to one of its legacy systems. This was related
to a voluntary action initiated by the Company to replace a component in one of the Company’s legacy products. The remediation plan consists primarily
of replacement of a component in the system. The accrued liability consists of the estimated cost of materials and labor to replace the component in all
units that were under the Company's standard warranty or were covered under the existing extended warranty contracts. The Company recorded a liability
of approximately $5.0 million in 2018.

As of December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019, approximately $0.4 million and $0.5 million, respectively, of the total product remediation liability
balance was accrued as a component of the Company’s product warranty liability and included in accrued liabilities, and $1.2 million and $2.0 million,
respectively, was separately recorded as extended warranty liabilities. In the year ended December 31, 2020, the Company settled $0.6 million related to
extended warranty liability and recorded $0.2 million of the reversal of excess reserve during the fourth quarter of 2020 and $0.1 million in product
remediation warranty, respectively.

83

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
   
   
 
   
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
   
   
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

NOTE 4— WARRANTY AND EXTENDED SERVICES CONTRACT

The Company has a direct field service organization in North America (including Canada). Internationally, the Company provides direct service support
in Australia, Belgium, France, Germany, Hong Kong, Japan, and Switzerland, as well as through third-party service providers in Spain and the United
Kingdom.  In  several  other  countries,  where  the  Company  does  not  have  a  direct  presence,  the  Company  provides  service  through  a  network  of
distributors and third-party service providers.

After  the  original  warranty  period,  maintenance  and  support  are  offered  on  an  extended  service  contract  basis  or  on  a  time  and  materials  basis.  The
Company provides for the estimated cost to repair or replace products under standard warranty at the time of sale. Costs in connection with extended
service contracts are recognized at the time when costs are incurred. The following table provides the changes in the product standard warranty accrual
for the years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019 (in thousands):

December 31,

2020

2019 (1)

Balance at beginning of year
Add: Accruals for warranties issued during the period
Less: Settlements made during the period
Balance at end of year

4,666 
7,629 
(7,894)
4,401 
(1)          Presentation  of  the  2019  warranty  liability  rollforward  table  has  been  changed  for  consistency.  The  $4.6  million  as  of  the  beginning  of  2019
excluded one-time extended service contracts costs of $3.2 million to replace components in one of the Company’s legacy products.

4,401    $
4,475     
(5,968)    
2,908    $

  $

  $

The settlements presented in the table exclude costs related to extended service contracts cost, which were $0.6 million and $1.1 million for the
years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019, respectively, to replace a component in one of the Company's legacy products.

NOTE 5— DEFERRED REVENUE

The  Company  records  deferred  revenue  when  revenue  is  to  be  recognized  subsequent  to  invoicing.  For  extended  service  contracts,  the  Company
generally invoices customers at the beginning of the extended service contract term. The Company’s extended service contracts typically have one, two-
or  three-year  terms.  Deferred  revenue  also  includes  payments  for  training  and  extended  marketing  support  service.  Approximately  84%  of  the
Company’s deferred revenue balance of $11.2 million as of December 31, 2020 will be recognized over the next 12 months.

The following table provides changes in the deferred contract revenue balance for the years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019 (in thousands):

Balance at beginning of year
Add: Payments received
Less: Revenue
Less: Revenue included in the beginning balance and recognized as revenue in the current year

Balance at end of year

December 31,

2020

2019

  $

  $

14,222    $
14,131     
(6,337)    
(10,779)    
11,237    $

12,566 
17,127 
(6,020)
(9,451)
14,222 

Costs for extended service contracts were $8.2 million, $9.3 million and $7.8 million, respectively, for the years ended December 31, 2020, 2019 and
2018.

NOTE 6—STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY, STOCK PLANS AND STOCK-BASED COMPENSATION EXPENSE

As  of  December  31,  2020,  the  Company  had  one  class  of  issued  common  stock  with  a  par  value  of  $0.001.  Authorized  capital  stock  consists  of
55,000,000  shares  comprised  of  two  classes:  (i)  50,000,000  shares  of  Common  Stock,  of  which  17,679,232  shares  are  issued  and  outstanding  as  of
December 31, 2020, and  (ii)  5,000,000  shares  of  preferred  stock,  par  value  $0.001  per  share  (“Preferred  Stock”),  of  which  no  shares  are  issued  and
outstanding.

Issuances of Common Stock

On April 21, 2020, the Company issued and sold an aggregate of 2,742,750 shares of the Company’s common stock, par value $0.001 per share at a
price  to  the  public  of  $10.50  per  share.  The  shares  include  the  full  exercise  of  the  underwriter’s  option  to  purchase  an  additional  357,750  shares  of
common  stock.  The  Company  received  net  proceeds  from  the  offering  of  approximately  $26.5  million,  after  deducting  underwriting  discounts,
commissions and offering expenses of $2.3 million.

As of December 31, 2020, the Company had the following stock-based employee compensation plans:

2004 Equity Incentive Plan

In 1998, the Company adopted the 1998 Stock Plan, or 1998 Plan, under which 4,650,000 shares of the Company’s common stock were reserved for
issuance to employees, directors and consultants.

On January 12, 2004, the Board of Directors (“the Board”) adopted the 2004 Equity Incentive Plan. A total of 1,750,000 shares of common stock were
originally reserved for issuance pursuant to the 2004 Equity Incentive Plan. In addition, the shares reserved for issuance under the 2004 Equity Incentive
Plan  included  shares  reserved  but  un-issued  under  the  1998  Plan  and  shares  returned  to  the  1998  Plan  as  the  result  of  termination  of  options  or  the
repurchase  of  shares.  In  2012  the  stockholders  approved  a  “fungible  share”  provision  whereby  each  full-value  award  issued  under  the  2004  Equity
Incentive Plan results in a requirement to subtract 2.12 shares from the shares reserved under the Plan.

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
   
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
84

 
Table of Contents

2019 Equity Incentive Plan

At the Company’s Annual Meeting of Stockholders on June 14, 2019, the Company’s stockholders approved the 2019 Equity Incentive Plan, which is an
amendment  and  restatement  of  the  2004  Equity  Incentive  Plan.  The  2004  Equity  Incentive  Plan  was  amended  to:  (i)  increase  the  number  of  shares
available for future grant by 700,000 (in addition to the 9,701,192 shares provided under the 2004 Equity Incentive Plan; (ii) extend the term of the 2004
Equity Incentive Plan to the date of the Annual Meeting of the Company’s stockholders in 2029; (iii) amend the 2004 Equity Incentive Plan to eliminate
the requirement for awards granted on or after June 14, 2019 that any shares subject to awards with an exercise price less than fair market value on the
date of such grant will be counted against the Plan as 2.12 shares for each full value share awarded in accordance with the 2004 Equity Incentive Plan;
(iv) amend the 2004 Equity Incentive Plan to remove the requirement that any shares subject to awards with an exercise price less than fair market value
on the date of such grant will be counted against the Plan as 2.12 shares for each full value share awarded; (v) amend the 2004 Equity Incentive Plan to
remove certain provisions relating to the “performance based compensation” exception under Section 162(m) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as
amended; (vi) include a minimum one-year vesting period with respect to awards granted under the 2004 Equity Incentive Plan.

On June 11, 2019, the Board also approved amended and restated the Company’s Stock Ownership Guidelines adopted on July 28, 2017 in their entirety,
to require all officers (as defined by Rule 16a-1(f) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended) to hold at least 50% of any shares received
pursuant  to  stock  options,  stock  appreciation  rights,  vested  restricted  stock  awards  (“RSAs”),  restricted  stock  units  (“RSUs”),  performance  shares  or
performance units (net of taxes) for a minimum of one year following vesting and delivery.

On June 11, 2019, the Board also adopted a clawback policy to permit recovery of certain compensation paid to Named Executive Officers (as defined in
Item 402 of Regulation S-K) of the Company if the Compensation Committee of the Board determines that a Named Executive Officer (i) has violated
law,  the  Company’s  Code  of  Business  Conduct  and  Ethics,  or  any  significant  ethics  or  compliance  policies,  and  (ii)  such  conduct  results  in  material
financial or reputational harm, or results in a need for a restatement of the Company’s consolidated financial statements. The Amended and Restated
Plan  provides  for  the  grant  of  incentive  stock  options,  non-statutory  stock  options,  RSAs,  RSUs,  stock  appreciation  rights,  performance  units,
performance shares, and other stock or cash awards.

In June 2020, stockholders approved an amendment and restatement of the 2019 Equity Incentive Plan (the “Prior Plan”) as the Amended and Restated
2019 Equity Incentive Plan (the “Restated Plan”) and approved an additional 600,000 shares, available for future grants. The Restated Plan provides for
the grant of incentive stock options, non-statutory stock options, RSAs, RSUs, stock appreciation rights, performance stock units, performance shares,
and other stock or cash awards.

In accordance with the 2019 Restated Plan and 2004 Equity Incentive Plans, prior to 2012, the Company’s non-employee directors were granted $60,000
of grant date fair value, fully vested, stock awards annually on the date of the Company’s Annual Meeting of stockholders. The quantity of units granted
is determined by dividing the award amount by the 50-day moving average stock price ending on the day of the award. Following Board of Directors
action on October 31, 2017, the Company’s nonemployee directors receive $60,000 of RSUs granted annually that cliff-vest on the one-year anniversary
of the grant date. In the years ended December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018, the Company issued 35,735, 42,236 and 13,392 RSUs, respectively, to its non-
employee directors.

In the years ended December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018, the Company’s Board of Directors granted 650,964, 517,402 and 210,532 RSUs, respectively, to
its executive officers, directors and certain members of the Company’s management. 25% of the RSUs granted to the employees vest on each of the first
four anniversaries of the vest date subject to the recipients’ continued service. The Company measured the fair market values of the underlying stock on
the dates of grant and recognizes the stock-based compensation expense over the vesting period. On the vesting date, the Company issues fully paid up
common stock, net of stock withheld to settle the recipient’s minimum statutory tax liability.

In the years ended December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018 the Company’s Board of Directors granted its executive officers and certain senior management
employees 98,580, 387,172, and 47,824 of PSUs, respectively. The PSUs vest over 12 or 24 months subject to the recipient’s continued service and the
achievement of pre-established performance goals. The PSUs granted in 2020 vest subject to the recipients continued service and the achievement of
certain  performance  goals  for  the  Company’s  2020  fiscal  year  established  by  the  Board  and  relating  to  the  achievement  of  specific  operational  and
regulatory milestones. During the years ended December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018,  219,549  shares,  23,053  shares  97,418  shares  of  the  PSUs  vested,
respectively.

During the quarter ended September 30, 2019 the Company's Board awarded its new CEO, David H. Mowry, 67,897 shares, which are scheduled to vest
over 4 years from 2019 through 2022 (the 2019 tranche is 15% of the award, or 10,185 PSUs; the 2020 tranche is 25% of the award, or 16,974 PSUs; the
2021  tranche  is  30%  of  the  award,  or  20,369  PSUs;  and  the  2022  tranche  is  30%  of  the  award,  or  20,369  PSUs).  These  PSUs  are  subject  to  certain
performance-based  criteria  related  to  achieving  financial  metrics  in  the  Board  approved  annual  budgets  for  the  years  2019  through  2022.  As  of
December 31, 2020, the Company concluded that the 2019 and 2020 tranches met the criteria for measurement and recognition. The 8,657 shares of the
2019 tranche vested during the year ended December 31, 2020. None of the shares for the 2020 tranche vested. The 2021 and 2022 tranches do not meet
the criteria for measurement and recognition as of December 31, 2020 and will meet the criteria for measurement and commencement of recognition
when the Company’s Board of Directors establishes the financial metrics for each fiscal year.

On August 2, 2020, the Board awarded its new CFO, Rohan Seth, an option grant for 60,000 shares, which vests over 5 years, and a PSU award covering
a target of 22,423 shares, which vests over 2.5 years and is subject to performance-based criteria relating to the achievement of certain goals with 40%
based  on  achievement  of  Finance  department  goals  and  60%  based  on  the  Company’s  achievement  of  financial  performance  goals.  The  maximum
number of Shares that may vest under the award is 150% of the target number of shares of Common Stock subject to the award.

On April  1,  2020,  the  Company  issued  RSUs  to  settle  bonuses  owed  to  management  under  the  2019  Management  Bonus  Program.  In  the  past,  the
Company  has  paid  these  bonuses  with  cash  on  hand.  However,  due  to  the  economic  conditions  resulting  from  COVID-19,  fully  vested  shares  were
issued in lieu of cash. The Company issued 209,981 shares related to this bonus payment to management and recognized $2.6 million in stock-based
compensation expense. The Company also recorded an equivalent reduction in bonus expense as a result of the settlement of the bonus in shares.

85

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

On January 12, 2004, the Board of Directors adopted the 2004 Employee Stock Purchase Plan. Under the 2004 Employee Stock Purchase Plan, or 2004
ESPP,  eligible  employees  are  permitted  to  purchase  common  stock  at  a  discount  through  payroll  deductions.  The  2004  ESPP  offering  and  purchase
periods are for approximately six months. The 2004 ESPP has an evergreen provision based on which shares of common stock eligible for purchase are
increased on the first day of each fiscal year by an amount equal to the lesser of:

● 600,000 shares;

● 2.0% of the outstanding shares of common stock on such date; or an amount as determined by the Board of Directors.

The Company’s Board of Directors did not increase the shares available for future grant on January 1, 2021, 2020 and 2019. The price of the common
stock purchased is the lower of 85% of the fair market value of the common stock at the beginning or end of a six-month offering period. In the years
ended December 31, 2020, 2019, and 2018, under the 2004 ESPP, the Company issued 56,751, 82,810, and 64,511 shares, respectively. At December 31,
2020, 704,954 shares remained available for future issuance.

Option and Award Activity

Activity under the 2004 Plan and 2019 Equity Incentive Plan is summarized as follows:

Options Outstanding

Balances as of December 31, 2017
Options granted
Options exercised
Options cancelled (expired or forfeited)
Stock awards granted
Stock awards cancelled (expired or forfeited)   
Balances as of December 31, 2018
Additional shares reserved(2)
Options exercised
Options cancelled (expired or forfeited)
Stock awards granted
Stock awards cancelled (expired or forfeited)   
Balances as of December 31, 2019
Additional shares reserved(2)
Options granted
Options exercised
Options cancelled (expired or forfeited)
Stock awards granted
Stock awards cancelled (expired or forfeited)   
Balances as of December 31, 2020
Exercisable as of December 31, 2020
Vested and expected to vest, net of
estimated forfeitures, as of December 31,
2020

Shares
Available
For Grant

Number of
Shares

Weighted-
Average
Exercise
Price

1,494,866     
(21,010)    
—     
81,322     
(562,070)    
148,197     
1,141,305     
700,000     
—     
51,208     
(1,538,128)    
407,320     
761,705     
600,000     
(71,088)    
—     
76,553     
(804,949)    
522,949     
1,085,170     

839,919    $
21,010    $
(271,902)   $
(81,322)   $
—     
—     
507,705    $

(160,798)   $
(51,208)   $
—     
—     
295,699    $

71,088    $
(73,227)   $
(76,553)   $
—     
—     
217,007    $
132,641    $

16.46     
50.65     
9.99     
21.55     
—     
—     
20.52     

10.03     
24.61     
—     
—     
25.52     

14.85     
12.91       
36.65     
—     
—     
22.35     
24.60     

212,025    $

22.31     

Weighted-
Average
Remaining
Contractual
Life
(in years)

3.99

Aggregate
Intrinsic
Value
(in millions ) (1) 
24.4 

     $

3.52

     $

2.00 

3.19

     $

3.04 

3.75
2.84

3.63

     $
     $

     $

1.47 
1.47 

1,451 

(1) Based on the closing stock price of $24.11 of the Company’s stock on December 31, 2020, $35.81 on December 31, 2019, $17.02 on December 31,

2018 and $45.35 on December 31, 2017.

(2) Approved by the board of directors and stockholders in 2019 and 2020.

The  aggregate  intrinsic  value  in  the  table  above  represents  the  total  pre-tax  intrinsic  value  (the  aggregate  difference  between  the  Company’s  closing
stock price on the last trading day of the fiscal year and the exercise price, multiplied by the number of in-the-money options) that would have been
received by the option holders had all option holders exercised their options on December 31, 2020. The aggregate intrinsic amount changes based on
the fair market value of the Company’s common stock. Total intrinsic value of options exercised in 2020, 2019 and 2018 was $0.4 million, $1.0 million,
and $8.3 million, respectively. The options outstanding and exercisable at December 31, 2020 were in the following exercise price ranges:

$15.32

$18.55

$9.65
$10.80

$10.79
$14.04

Exercise Prices
-
-
$14.01  
-
$18.93  
$19.55  
$25.70  
$39.30  
$47.40  
$53.90  
-

$9.65

$53.9

Number Outstanding

Contractual Life
(in years)

Number
Exercisable

22,319     
34,459     
60,000     
8,396     
11,088     
10,000     
11,000     
45,000     
7,745     
7,000     
217,007     

1.08     
2.23     
4.59     
2.64     
9.83     
3.32     
3.59     
3.83     
3.96     
4.20     
3.75     

22,319 
34,459 
— 
8,271 
— 
9,375 
9,730 
37,292 
6,132 
5,063 
132,641 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
 
 
 
   
   
   
 
   
   
   
 
      
  
   
 
      
  
   
 
      
  
   
 
      
  
 
      
  
   
   
      
      
 
      
  
   
 
      
  
   
 
      
  
   
 
      
  
 
      
  
   
   
      
      
 
      
  
   
 
      
  
   
      
  
   
 
      
  
   
 
      
  
 
      
  
   
   
      
   
      
 
 
 
   
 
   
   
 
     
     
 
     
     
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
     
     
86

 
Table of Contents

Stock Awards (RSU and PSU) Activity Table

Information with respect to RSUs and PSUs activity is as follows (in thousands):

Number of
Shares

Weighted-
Average
Grant-
Date Fair
Value

Aggregate
Fair Value(1)  
    (in thousands) 

Outstanding at December 31, 2017
Granted
Vested (3)
Forfeited
Outstanding at December 31, 2018
Granted
Vested (3)
Forfeited
Outstanding at December 31, 2019
Granted
Vested (3)
Forfeited
Outstanding at December 31, 2020

510,587    $
265,124    $
(231,515)   $
(69,905)   $
474,291    $
963,814    $
(172,281)   $
(161,022)   $
1,104,802    $
667,694    $
(684,491)   $
(308,248)   $
779,757    $

24.88     
44.57     
21.10    $
20.01     
38.44     
18.68     
33.66    $
37.91     
22.10     
20.66     
17.82    $
23.24     
23.96     

Aggregate
Intrinsic
Value
(2)
  (in thousands) 
23,155 
  $

9,483(4)     

  $

8,072 

6,169(5)     

  $

37,442 

12,036(6)     

  $

18,800 

(1)  Represents the value of the Company’s stock on the date that the restricted stock units and performance stock units vest.
(2)  Based on the closing stock price of the Company’s stock of $24.11 on December 31, 2020, $35.81 on December 31, 2019, $17.02 on December 31,
2018, and $45.35 on December 31, 2017.
(3)  The number of restricted stock units vested includes shares that the Company withheld on behalf of the employees to satisfy the statutory tax
withholding requirements.
(4)  On the grant date, the fair value for these vested awards was $4.9 million.
(5)  On the grant date, the fair value for these vested awards was $5.9 million.
(6)  On the grant date, the fair value for these vested awards was $12.2 million.      

Stock-Based Compensation

Stock-based compensation expense for the years ended December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018 was as follows (in thousands):

Stock options
RSUs
PSUs
ESPP
Total stock-based compensation expense

2020

Year Ended December 31,
2019

2018

  $

  $

370    $
8,849     
666     
224     
10,109    $

622    $
4,786     
3,948     
476     
9,832    $

838 
4,648 
1,105 
566 
7,157 

As of December 31, 2020, the unrecognized compensation cost, net of expected forfeitures, was $0.7 million for stock options, which will be recognized
over an estimated weighted-average remaining amortization period of 3.9 years. The unrecognized compensation cost, net of expected forfeitures, for
stock  awards,  including  performance-based  awards,  was  $12.3  million,  which  will  be  recognized  over  an  estimated  weighted-average  remaining
amortization  period  of  2.3  years.  For  the  ESPP,  the  unrecognized  compensation  cost,  net  of  expected  forfeitures,  was  $0.1  million,  which  will  be
recognized over an estimated weighted-average amortization period 0.33 years.

The Company issues new shares of common stock upon the exercise of stock options, vesting of RSUs and PSUs, and the issuance of ESPP shares. The
amount of cash received through exercise of options and shares purchased through ESPP, net of taxes withheld and paid, in 2020, 2019 and 2018 was
$1.6 million, $3.9 million and $1.3 million.

Total  stock-based  compensation  expense  recognized  during  the  year  ended  December  31,  2020,  2019  and  2018  was  recorded  in  the  Consolidated
Statement of Operations as follows (in thousands):

Cost of revenue
Sales and marketing
Research and development
General and administrative

Total stock-based compensation expense

2020

Year Ended December 31,
2019

2018

1,665    $
3,385     
1,669     
3,390     
10,109    $

1,572    $
4,510     
1,536     
2,214     
9,832    $

743 
2,105 
824 
3,485 
7,157 

  $

  $

87

 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
 
 
 
   
   
  
   
  
   
  
   
 
   
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
   
 
   
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
   
 
   
  
   
  
   
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
   
   
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
   
   
   
 
Table of Contents

Valuation Assumptions and Fair Value of Stock Options and ESPP Grants

The Company uses the Black-Scholes option pricing model to estimate the fair value of options granted under its equity incentive plans and rights to
acquire  stock  granted  under  its  employee  stock  purchase  plan.  The  weighted  average  estimated  fair  values  of  the  employee  stock  options  and  rights
granted under the employee stock purchase plan and the weighted average assumptions used to calculate the grant date fair values, are as follows:

Expected term (in years) (1)
Risk-free interest rate (2)
Volatility(3)
Dividend yield(4)

Weighted average
estimated fair value at
grant date

2020

Stock Options
2019

2018

Stock Purchase Plan (ESPP)
2019

2018

2020

4.84 
0.15%   
63%   
—%   

3.65 
1.64%   
54%   
—%   

3.70 
2.60%   
44%   
—%   

0.50 
0.11%   
76%   
—%   

0.50 
2.49%   
70%   
—%   

0.50 
2.34%
61%
—%

  $

7.63 

  $

14.83 

  $

18.00 

  $

6.13 

  $

9.60 

  $

9.60 

  (1) The expected term represents the period during which the Company’s stock-based awards are expected to be outstanding. The estimated term is
based  on  historical  experience  of  similar  awards,  giving  consideration  to  the  contractual  terms  of  the  awards,  vesting  requirements  and
expectation  of  future  employee  behavior,  including  post-vesting  terminations.  The  expected  term  of  groups  of  employees  that  have  similar
historical exercise patterns has been considered separately for valuation purposes.

  (2) The risk-free interest rate is based on U.S. Treasury debt securities with maturities close to the expected term of the option or ESPP participation

right as of the date of grant.

  (3) Estimated volatility is based on historical volatility. The Company estimates volatility based on the Company’s historical volatility of its stock

price. 

  (4) The Company has not paid dividends since its inception.

The  Company  periodically  estimates  forfeiture  rates  based  on  its  historical  experience  for  separate  groups  of  employees  and  adjusts  the  stock-based
compensation expense accordingly. The forfeiture rates used in 2020 ranged from 0% to 20.8%.

Stock Awards Withholdings

For Stock Awards granted to employees, the number of shares issued on the date the Stock Awards vest is net of the tax withholding requirements paid
on  behalf  of  the  employees.  In  2020, 2019,  and  2018,  the  Company  withheld  193,573,  42,695  and  77,049  shares  of  common  stock,  respectively,  to
satisfy  its  employees’  tax  obligations  of  $3.4  million,  $0.8  million  and  $3.1  million,  respectively.  The  Company  paid  this  amount  in  cash  to  the
appropriate  taxing  authorities.  Although  shares  withheld  are  not  issued,  they  are  treated  as  common  stock  repurchases  for  accounting  and  disclosure
purposes, as they reduce the number of shares that would have been issued upon vesting.

88

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

NOTE 7—INCOME TAXES

The Company files income tax returns in the U.S. federal and various state and local jurisdictions and foreign jurisdictions. The Company’s income (loss)
before provision for income taxes consisted of the following (in thousands):

U.S.
Foreign

Loss before income taxes

2020

Year Ended December 31,
2019

2018

  $

  $

(25,793)   $
2,386     
(23,407)   $

(13,037)   $
774     
(12,263)   $

(14,177)
662 
(13,515)

The components of the provision (benefit) for income taxes are as follows (in thousands):

Current:

Federal
State
Foreign
Total Current

Deferred:

Federal
State
Foreign
Total Deferred

Tax provision

The Company’s net deferred tax assets consist of the following (in thousands):

Net operating loss carryforwards
Stock-based compensation
Other accruals and reserves
Credits
Accrued warranty
Depreciation and amortization
Other
Operating Lease Liability

Deferred tax asset before valuation allowance

Valuation allowance

Deferred tax asset after valuation allowance

Deferred contract acquisition costs
Goodwill
Right of Use Asset

Net deferred tax asset

89

  $

  $

2020

Year Ended December 31,
2019

2018

—    $
(53)    
747     
694     

2     
1     
(227)    
(224)    
470    $

  $

  $

—    $
101     
(76)    
25     

2     
1     
57     
60     
85    $

(15)
123 
303 
411 

15,674 
1,230 
(60)
16,844 
17,255 

December 31,

2020

2019

18,270    $
869     
3,670     
12,653     
976     
2,191     
979     
4,311     
43,919     
(38,321)    
5,598     
(803)    
(110)    
(4,042)    
643    $

14,507 
1,111 
2,202 
11,887 
924 
2,354 
897 
3,949 
37,831 
(32,350)
5,481 
(1,076)
(97)
(3,885)
423 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
     
       
       
 
   
   
   
     
       
       
 
   
   
   
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
 
Table of Contents

The differences between the U.S. federal statutory income tax rates to the Company’s effective tax rate are as follows:

U.S. federal statutory income tax rate
State tax rate
Meals and entertainment
Permanent differences
Stock-based compensation
SAB 118 Change in Estimate
Foreign rate differential
Other
General business credit
Valuation allowance
Change in prior year reserves
Deferred true-up
Effective tax rate

2020

Year Ended December 31,
2019

2018

21.00%    

2.77 
(0.65)
(2.87)
(1.07)
— 
(1.05)
0.15 
2.74 
(25.51)
0.40 
2.08 
(2.01)%   

21.00%    

2.82 
(2.83)
(2.58)
3.78 
— 
(0.34)
(0.33)
8.14 
(38.60)
2.53 
5.71 
(0.70)%   

21.00%
(4.95)
(2.66)
— 
13.66 
(2.43)
0.11 
(1.21)
4.31 
(155.49)
— 
— 

(127.66)%

As of December 31, 2020, the Company recorded a valuation allowance of $38.3 million for the portion of the deferred tax asset that it does not expect to
be realized. The valuation allowance on the Company’s net deferred taxes increased by $6.0 million and $4.5 million during the years ended December 31,
2020 and 2019,  respectively.  The  changes  in  valuation  allowance  are  primarily  due  to  additional  U.S.  deferred  tax  assets  and  liabilities  incurred  in  the
respective year. The Company has $0.6 million of net deferred tax assets in foreign jurisdictions, which management believes are more-likely-than-not to
be  realized  given  the  expectation  of  future  earnings  in  these  jurisdictions.  The  Company  continues  to  monitor  the  realizability  of  the  U.S.  deferred  tax
assets taking into account multiple factors, including the results of operations and magnitude of excess tax deductions for stock-based compensation. The
Company intends to continue maintaining a full valuation allowance on its U.S. deferred tax assets until there is sufficient evidence to support the reversal
of all or some portion of these allowances. Release of all, or a portion, of the valuation allowance would result in the recognition of certain deferred tax
assets and a decrease to income tax expense for the period the release is recorded.

At December 31, 2020, the Company had approximately $76.6 million and $36.6 million of federal and state net operating loss carryforwards, respectively,
available  to  offset  future  taxable  income.  The  federal  and  state  net  operating  loss  carryforwards,  if  not  utilized  will  generally  begin  to  expire  in
2029 through 2039. Approximately $34.9 million of total federal net operating loss carryforwards were generated post December 31, 2017 and  have  no
expiration. At December 31, 2020, the Company had research and development tax credits available to offset federal, California and Massachusetts tax
liabilities in the amount of $6.3 million, $7.8 million and $0.2 million, respectively. Federal credits will begin to expire in 2024, California state tax credits
have no expiration, and Massachusetts tax credits begin to expire in 2021.

On March  27,  2020,  the  U.S.  federal  government  enacted  the  Coronavirus  Aid,  Relief,  and  Economic  Security  Act  (“CARES  Act”).  The  CARES  Act
changed several of the existing U.S. corporate income tax laws by, among other things, increasing the amount of deductible interest, allowing companies to
carry back certain Net Operating Losses (“NOLs”) and increasing the amount of NOLs that corporations can use to offset income. Further, in December
2020, the Consolidated Appropriations Act, 2021 was signed into law. It clarified that gross income does not include any amount that would otherwise arise
from  the  forgiveness  of  a  PPP  loan.  The  CARES  Act  did  not  have  a  material  impact  on  the  Company's  income  tax  provision,  deferred  tax  assets  and
liabilities, and related taxes payable. 

Federal and state laws can impose substantial restrictions on the utilization of net operating loss and tax credit carryforwards in the event of an “ownership
change,”  as  defined  in  Section  382  of  the  Internal  Revenue  Code.  The  Company  has  determined  that  no  significant  limitation  would  be  placed  on  the
utilization of the Company’s net operating loss and tax credit carryforwards due to prior ownership changes.

No  deferred  tax  liabilities  have  been  recorded  relating  to  the  earnings  of  the  Company’s  foreign  subsidiaries  since  all  such  earnings  are  intended  to  be
indefinitely reinvested. The amount of the unrecognized deferred tax liability associated with these earnings is immaterial.

Uncertain Tax Positions

The Company establishes reserves for uncertain tax positions based on the largest amount that is more-likely-than-not to be sustained. An uncertain income
tax position will not be recognized if it has less than a 50% likelihood of being sustained. The Company performs a two-step approach to recognizing and
measuring uncertain tax positions. The first step is to evaluate the tax position for recognition by determining if the weight of available evidence indicates
that it is more likely than not that the position will be sustained on audit, including resolution of related appeals or litigation processes, if any. The second
step is to measure the tax benefit as the largest amount that is more than 50% likely of being realized upon settlement.

Although the Company believes it has adequately reserved for its uncertain tax positions, no assurance can be given that the final tax outcome of these
matters will not be different. The Company adjusts these reserves in light of changing facts and circumstances, such as the closing of a tax audit or the
refinement of an estimate. To the extent that the final tax outcome of these matters is different than the amounts recorded, such differences will impact the
provision for income taxes in the period in which such determination is made. The provision for income taxes includes the impact of reserve provisions and
changes to reserves that are considered appropriate, as well as the related net interest and penalties.

The  Company  files  U.S.,  state,  and  foreign  income  tax  returns  in  jurisdictions  with  varying  statutes  of  limitations.  The  2005  through  2020  tax  years
generally  remain  subject  to  examination  by  U.S.  federal  and  California  state  tax  authorities  due  to  the  Company’s  net  operating  loss  and  credit
carryforwards.  For  significant  foreign  jurisdictions,  the  2015  through  2020  tax  years  generally  remain  subject  to  examination  by  their  respective  tax
authorities.

90

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

The  following  table  summarizes  the  activity  related  to  the  Company’s  gross  unrecognized  tax  benefits,  excluding  related  interest  and  penalties,  in
December 31, 2018 to December 31, 2020 (in thousands):

Balance at beginning of year
Decreases related to prior year tax positions
Increases related to prior year tax positions
Increases related to current year tax positions
Balance at end of year

2020

Year Ended December 31,
2019

2018

1,426    $
(32)    
—     
470     
1,864    $

1,563    $
(291)    
25     
129     
1,426    $

1,519 
(70)
— 
114 
1,563 

  $

  $

It is the Company’s policy to recognize interest and penalties related to income tax matters in income tax expense. The amount of interest and penalties
recognized in income tax expense was immaterial for the years ended December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019. As of December 31, 2020, the Company
had no accrued interest and penalties related to uncertain tax positions.

NOTE 8—NET LOSS PER SHARE

Basic  net  loss  per  share  is  computed  by  dividing  the  net  loss  by  the  weighted-average  number  of  shares  outstanding  during  the  period,  without
consideration for potential dilutive shares of common stock, such as in-the-money equity awards (stock options, RSUs, PSUs and employee stock purchase
plan  contributions).  Shares  of  common  stock  subject  to  repurchase  are  excluded  from  the  weighted-average  shares.  Since  the  Company  was  in  a  loss
position for all periods presented, basic net loss per share is the same as diluted net loss per share since the effects of potentially dilutive securities are
antidilutive.

The following table sets forth the computation of basic and diluted net loss and the weighted average number of shares used in computing basic and diluted
net loss per share (in thousands, except per share data):

Numerator:
Net loss (in thousands)
Denominator:
Weighted average shares of common stock outstanding used in computing net loss
per share, basic and diluted
Net loss per share:
Net loss per share, basic and diluted

2020

Year Ended December 31,
2019

2018

  $

(23,877)   $

(12,348)   $

(30,770)

16,691     

14,096     

  $

(1.43)   $

(0.88)   $

13,771 

(2.23)

On March 9, 2021, the Company issued and sold $125 million aggregate principal amount of 2.25% Convertible Senior Notes. Such issuance will have the
impact on the number of potential common shares outstanding in the future periods. See Note 13 – "Subsequent Events" for detailed discussion.

The following numbers of shares outstanding, prior to the application of the treasury stock method, were excluded from the computation of diluted net loss
per common share for the period presented because including them would have had an anti-dilutive effect (in thousands):

Options to purchase common stock
Restricted stock units
Employee stock purchase plan shares
Performance stock units

Total

NOTE 9—DEFINED CONTRIBUTION PLAN

2020

Year Ended December 31,
2019

2018

244     
724     
87     
68     
1,123     

417     
559     
111     
178     
1,265     

664 
432 
133 
43 
1,272 

In the U.S., the Company has an employee savings plan (“401(k) Plan”) that qualifies as a deferred salary arrangement under Section 401(k) of the Internal
Revenue Code. Eligible employees may make voluntary contributions to the 401(k)  Plan  up  to  100%  of  their  annual  compensation,  subject  to  statutory
annual limitations. In 2020, 2019 and 2018, the Company made discretionary contributions under the 401(k) Plan of $0.2 million, $0.4 million and $0.4
million, respectively.

For  the  Company’s  Japanese  subsidiary,  a  discretionary  employee  retirement  plan  has  been  established.  In  addition,  for  some  of  the  Company’s  other
foreign subsidiaries, the Company deposits funds with insurance companies, third-party trustees, or into government-managed accounts consistent with the
requirements of local laws. The Company has fully funded or accrued for its obligations as of December 31, 2020, and the related expense for each of the
three years then ended was not significant.

NOTE 10—SEGMENT INFORMATION AND REVENUE BY GEOGRAPHY AND PRODUCTS

Segment  reporting  is  based  on  the  “management  approach,”  following  the  method  that  management  organizes  the  company’s  reportable  segments  for
which separate financial information is made available to, and evaluated regularly by, the chief operating decision maker in allocating resources and in
assessing performance. The Company’s chief operating decision makers ("CODM") are its Chief Executive Officer ("CEO") and Chief Financial Officer
(“CFO”), who make decisions on allocating resources and in assessing performance. The CEO and CFO review the Company's consolidated results as one
operating  segment.  In  making  operating  decisions,  the  CODM  primarily  considers  consolidated  financial  information,  accompanied  by  disaggregated
information about revenues by geography and product. All of the Company’s principal operations and decision-making functions are located in the U.S.

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
   
   
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
     
       
       
 
     
       
       
 
   
     
       
       
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
   
   
   
   
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
The Company’s CODM view its operations, manages its business, and uses one measurement of profitability for the one operating segment - which sells
aesthetic medical equipment and services, and distributes skincare products, to qualified medical practitioners. Substantially all of the Company’s long-
lived assets are located in the U.S.

91

 
Table of Contents

The following table presents a summary of revenue by geography for the year ended December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018 (in thousands):

Revenue mix by geography:
United States
Japan
Asia, excluding Japan
Europe
Rest of the world

Total Consolidated revenue

Revenue mix by product category:

Systems
Consumables
Skincare

Total product revenue

Service

Total Consolidated revenue

NOTE 11– COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES

LEASES

2020

Year Ended December 31,
2019

2018

  $

  $

  $

  $

61,202    $
43,265     
11,900     
9,503     
21,813     
147,683    $

90,765    $
9,287     
25,061     
125,113     
22,570     
147,683    $

106,243    $
24,142     
16,110     
10,596     
24,621     
181,712    $

140,478    $
9,648     
8,512     
158,638     
23,074     
181,712    $

101,862 
17,819 
15,467 
8,875 
18,697 
162,720 

132,595 
4,162 
5,778 
142,535 
20,185 
162,720 

The Company is a party to certain operating and finance leases for vehicles, office space and storages facilities. The Company’s material operating leases
consist of office space, as well as storage facilities and finance leases consist of automobiles. The Company’s leases generally have remaining terms of 1 to
10  years,  some  of  which  include  options  to  renew  the  leases  for  up  to  5  years.  The  Company  leases  space  for  operations  in  the  United  States,  Japan,
Belgium,  France,  and  Spain.  In  addition  to  the  above  facility  leases,  the  Company  also  routinely  leases  automobiles  for  certain  sales  and  field  service
employees under finance leases.

In February  2016,  the  FASB  issued  ASU  2016-02,  "Leases,"  (also  known  as  ASC  Topic  842)  which  requires,  among  other  items,  lease  accounting  to
recognize  most  leases  as  assets  and  liabilities  on  the  balance  sheet.  Qualitative  and  quantitative  disclosures  are  enhanced  to  better  present  the  amount,
timing and uncertainty of cash flows arising from leases. In July 2018, the FASB issued ASU 2018-11, "Targeted Improvements," which gives the option to
apply the transition provisions of ASU 2016-02 at its adoption date instead of at the earliest comparative period presented in its financial statements. In
addition, ASU 2018 2018-11 provides a practical expedient that permits lessors to not separate non-lease components from the associated lease component
if certain conditions are met. Also in July 2018, the FASB issued ASU 2018-10, "Codification Improvements to ASC Topic 842, Leases," which clarifies
certain aspects of ASU 2016-02.

The Company adopted ASU 2016-02, as of January 1, 2019, using the modified retrospective method, to all leases existing at the date of initial application.
The comparative period information has not been restated and continues to be reported under the accounting standards in effect for the period presented.
The  new  standard  provides  a  number  of  optional  practical  expedients  in  transition.  The  Company  elected  the  package  of  practical  expedients  permitted
under  the  transition  guidance  within  the  new  standard,  which  allowed  the  Company  to  carry  forward  the  Company’s  historical  conclusions  about  lease
identification,  lease  classification  and  initial  direct  costs.  The  Company  also  elected  the  practical  expedient  related  to  land  easements,  allowing  the
Company  to  carry  forward  the  Company’s  accounting  treatment  for  land  easements  on  existing  agreements.  The  Company  did  not  elect  the  practical
expedient to use hindsight in determining the lease term.

The adoption of the new standard resulted in the recording of additional lease assets and lease liabilities of $10.2 million and $10.1 million, respectively, as
of January 1, 2019, based on the present value of the remaining minimum rental payments under current leasing standards for existing operating leases. The
difference  between  the  additional  lease  assets  and  lease  liabilities  resulted  from  rent-free  periods  which  were  previously  recorded  as  deferred  rent.  The
Company’s  accounting  for  finance  leases  remained  substantially  unchanged.  The  standard  had  no  material  impact  on  the  Company’s  consolidated  net
earnings, results of operations, comprehensive loss, statements of changes in equity, and cash flows.

92

 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
     
       
       
 
   
   
   
   
     
       
       
 
   
   
   
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Effect of Adoption of the New Lease Standard (ASC Topic 842) on Consolidated Financial Statements

The following table summarizes the effects of adopting Topic 842 on the Company’s consolidated balance sheet as of January 1, 2019 (in thousands):

Operating lease right-of-use assets
Operating lease liabilities
Other long-term liabilities*
Operating lease liabilities, net of current portion

*Deferred rent included in other long-term liabilities

As reported under
Topic 842

Adjustments

Balances under
Prior GAAP

  $

10,049    $
(2,430)    
—     
(7,759)    

(10,049)   $
2,430     
140     
7,759     

— 
— 
140 
— 

The Company determines if a contract contains a lease at inception. Operating lease assets and liabilities are recognized at the lease commencement date.
Operating lease liabilities represent the present value of lease payments not yet paid. Operating lease assets represent the right to use an underlying asset
and are based upon the operating lease liabilities adjusted for prepayments or accrued lease payments, initial direct costs, lease incentives, and impairment
of operating lease assets. To determine the present value of lease payments not yet paid, the Company estimates the incremental secured borrowing rates
corresponding  to  the  maturities  of  the  leases.  The  Company  based  the  rate  estimates  on  prevailing  financial  market  conditions,  credit  analysis,  and
management judgment.

The  Company  recognizes  expense  for  these  leases  on  a  straight-line  basis  over  the  lease  term.  Additionally,  tenant  incentives  used  to  fund  leasehold
improvements are recognized when earned and reduce the Company’s right-of-use asset related to the lease. These are amortized through the right-of-use
asset as reductions of expense over the lease term. 

Below is supplemental balance sheet information related to leases (in thousands):

Assets
Right-of-use assets
Finance lease

Total leased assets

Classification
Operating lease right-of-use assets
Property and equipment, net(1)

(1) Finance lease assets included in Property and equipment, net (in thousands):

Liabilities
Operating lease liabilities
Operating lease liabilities, current
Operating lease liabilities , non-current

Total operating lease liabilities

Classification

Operating lease liabilities
Operating lease liabilities, net of current portion

Finance lease liabilities
Finance lease liabilities, current
Finance lease liabilities, non-current

Total finance lease liabilities

Classification

Accrued liabilities
Other long-term liabilities

Lease costs during the twelve months ended  December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019 (in thousands): 

Finance lease cost
Finance lease cost
Operating lease cost

Amortization expense
Interest for finance lease
Operating lease expense

93

Year Ended December 31,
2019
2020

17,076    $
467     
17,543    $

7,702 
1,008 
8,710 

Year Ended December 31,
2019
2020

2,260    $
15,950     
18,210    $

Year Ended December 31,
2019
2020

370    $
241     
611    $

Year Ended December 31,
2019
2020

431    $
63    $
3,275    $

2,800 
5,112 
7,912 

541 
578 
1,119 

704 
88 
2,892 

  $

  $

  $

  $

  $

  $

  $
  $
  $

 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
   
   
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
     
       
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
     
       
 
 
     
       
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
     
       
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
Table of Contents

Cash paid for amounts included in the measurement of lease liabilities during the twelve months ended December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019 were as
follows (in thousands):

Operating cash flow
Financing cash flow
Operating cash flow

Maturities of lease liabilities 

Finance lease
Finance lease
Operating lease

Maturities of operating lease liabilities were as follows as of December 31, 2020 (in thousands):

2021
2022
2023
2024
2025
Thereafter

Total lease payments

Less: imputed interest

Present value of lease liabilities

Vehicle Leases

Year Ended December 31,
2019
2020

  $
  $
  $

63    $
537    $
2,139    $

88 
649 
2,820 

Amount

3,062 
3,112 
3,207 
2,884 
2,875 
6,308 
21,448 
(3,238)
18,210 

  $

  $

As of December 31, 2020, the Company was committed to minimum lease payments for vehicles leased under long-term non-cancelable finance leases as
follows (in thousands):

2021
2022
2023

Total lease payments

Less: imputed interest

Present value of lease liabilities

94

Amount

374 
249 
12 
635 
(24)
611 

  $

  $

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
  
 
 
 
 
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
   
   
 
Table of Contents

Weighted-average remaining lease term and discount rate, as of December 31, 2020, were as follows:

Lease Term and Discount Rate
Weighted-average remaining lease term (years)

Operating leases
Finance leases

Weighted-average discount rate

Operating leases
Finance leases

Lessor Information related to the Company’s system leasing

6.7 
2.2 

4.7%
5.6%

The  Company  also  enters  into  leasing  transactions,  in  which  the  Company  is  the  lessor,  offered  through  the  Company's  membership  program.  The
Company's leases for equipment rentals were all accounted for as operating leases during the second and third quarter of 2020.

During the fourth quarter ended December 31, 2020, certain of the membership program agreements were amended, granting the customers the exclusive
right and option to purchase the leased system from the Company, at any time during the period of 12 months from signing the amended agreement. For
contracts  signed  under  the  amended  membership  agreement,  the  Company  classified  and  accounted  for  the  arrangements  as  sales-type  leases  as  of
December 31, 2020, as the Company determined it is reasonably certain that the customer will exercise the purchase option

For the sales-type leases, the net investment of the Company’s lease receivable is measured at the commencement date and is included in the consolidated
balance sheets as a component of Other current assets and prepaid expenses. The following table, which reflects management’s assumption that lessees will
exercise the purchase option, summarizes the amount of sales-type lease income included in product revenue in the accompanying consolidated statements
of operations for the year ended  December 31, 2020 (in thousands):

Year Ended December 31,
2020

790 
Gross future lease payments from Customers
683 
Less: Present value of lease receipts and purchase option price(1)
107 
Difference between undiscounted cash flows and discounted cash flows
(1) Present value of lease receipts and purchase option price was included in Product revenue in the Company's Consolidated Statement of Operations in the
year ended December 31, 2020.

  $

  $

The revenue related to non-lease components, which comprise service contracts and consumables, are deferred and recognized either over time or at the
point of delivery. The non-lease component revenue amount as of December 31, 2020 was immaterial.

Equipment lease revenue for operating lease agreements is recognized over the life of the lease. The following table summarizes the amount of operating
lease  income  included  in  product  revenue  in  the  accompanying  consolidated  statements  of  operations  for  the  year  ended    December  31,  2020  (in
thousands):

Operating lease income from equipment rentals

Purchase Commitments

Year Ended December 31,
2020

  $

367 

The Company maintains certain open inventory purchase commitments with its suppliers to ensure a smooth and continuous supply for key components.
The Company’s liability in these purchase commitments is generally restricted to an agreed-upon period. These periods can vary among different suppliers.
Although open purchase orders are considered enforceable and legally binding, the terms generally allow the Company the option to cancel, reschedule,
and adjust their requirements based on the Company's business needs prior to the delivery of goods or performance of services.

Indemnifications

In  the  normal  course  of  the  Company’s  business,  the  Company  enters  into  agreements  that  contain  a  variety  of  representations,  warranties,  and
indemnification obligations. For example, the Company has entered into indemnification agreements with each of its directors and executive officers and
certain key employees. The Company’s exposure under its various indemnification obligations is unknown and not reasonably estimable as they involve
future claims that may be made against the Company. As such, the Company has not accrued any amounts for such obligations.

Contingencies

The Company is named from time to time as a party to other legal proceedings, product liability, commercial disputes, employee disputes, and contractual
lawsuits in the normal course of business. A liability and related charge are recorded to earnings in the Company’s consolidated financial statements for
legal  contingencies  when  the  loss  is  considered  probable  and  the  amount  can  be  reasonably  estimated.  The  assessment  is  re-evaluated  each  accounting
period  and  is  based  on  all  available  information,  including  discussion  with  outside  legal  counsel.  If  a  reasonable  estimate  of  a  known  or  probable  loss
cannot be made, but a range of probable losses can be estimated, the low-end of the range of losses is recognized if no amount within the range is a better
estimate than any other. If a material loss is reasonably possible, but not probable and can be reasonably estimated, the estimated loss or range of loss is
disclosed in the notes to the consolidated financial statements. The Company expenses legal fees as incurred.

95

 
 
     
 
     
 
   
   
     
 
   
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

In November  2019,  the  Company’s  former  Executive  Vice  President  and  CFO  Sandra  A.  Gardiner  announced  her  resignation  from  the  Company.  On
November 7, 2019, Ms. Gardiner filed an arbitration demand against the Company in connection with the terms of her employment and resignation. The
Company settled this matter with Ms. Gardiner during the second quarter of 2020 with a cash payment of $0.4 million and issuance of 15,408 shares of
common stock.

As of December 31, 2020 and 2019, the Company had accrued $0.4 million and Nil, respectively related to various pending commercial and product
liability lawsuits. The Company does not believe that a material loss in excess of accrued amounts is reasonably possible.

NOTE 12—DEBT

Loan and Security Agreement

On May 30, 2018, the Company and Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. (“Wells Fargo”) entered into a Loan and Security Agreement (the “Wells Fargo Revolving
Line of Credit”) in the original principal amount of $25 million.

On  July  9,  2020,  the  Company  terminated  its  undrawn  revolving  line  of  credit  with  Wells  Fargo  and  subsequently  entered  into  a  Loan  and  Security
Agreement with Silicon Valley Bank for a four-year secured revolving loan facility (“SVB Revolving Line of Credit”) in an aggregate principal amount of
up to $30.0 million. The SVB Revolving Line of Credit matures on July 9, 2024.

Covenants

In order to draw on the full amount of the SVB Revolving Line of Credit, the Company must satisfy certain liquidity ratios. If the Company is unable to
meet these liquidity ratios, then availability under the revolving line is calculated as 80% of the Company’s qualifying accounts receivable. The proceeds of
the revolving loans may be used for general corporate purposes. The Company’s obligations under the Loan and Security Agreement with Silicon Valley
Bank  are  secured  by  substantially  all  of  the  assets  of  the  Company.  Interest  on  principal  amount  outstanding  under  the  revolving  line  shall  accrue  at  a
floating per annum rate equal to the greater of either 1.75% above the Prime Rate or five percent (5.0%). The Company paid a non-refundable revolving
line commitment fee of $0.3 million, on the effective date of the Loan and Security Agreement with Silicon Valley Bank of July 9, 2020, and the Company
is required to pay an anniversary fee of $0.3 million on each twelve month anniversary of the effective date of the Loan and Security Agreement.

The Loan and Security Agreement with Silicon Valley Bank contains customary affirmative covenants, such as financial statement reporting requirements
and  delivery  of  borrowing  base  certificates,  as  well  as  customary  covenants  that  restrict  the  Company’s  ability  to,  among  other  things,  incur  additional
indebtedness,  sell  certain  assets,  guarantee  obligations  of  third  parties,  declare  dividends  or  make  certain  distributions,  and  undergo  a  merger  or
consolidation or certain other transactions. The Loan and Security Agreement also contains certain financial condition covenants, including maintaining a
minimum  revenue  of  $90.0  million,  determined  in  accordance  with  GAAP  on  a  trailing  twelve-month  basis.  This  minimum  revenue  requirement  is
performed quarterly and subject to renegotiation at the beginning of each fiscal year.

As  of  December  31,  2020,  the  Company  had  not  drawn  on  the  SVB  Revolving  Line  of  Credit  and  the  Company  is  in  compliance  with  all  financial
covenants of the SVB Revolving Line of Credit.

The Paycheck Protection Program (PPP) Loan

On April 22, 2020, the Company received loan proceeds of $7.1 million pursuant to the Paycheck Protection Program (the “PPP”) under the Coronavirus
Aid,  Relief,  and  Economic  Security  Act  (the  “CARES  Act”).  The  loan,  which  is  in  the  form  of  a  promissory  note  dated  April  21,  2020,  between  the
Company  and  Silicon  Valley  Bank  as  the  lender,  matures  on  April  21,  2022  and  bears  interest  at  a  fixed  rate  of  1.00%  per  annum,  payable  monthly
commencing September 2021. There is no prepayment penalty. Under the terms of the PPP, all or a portion of the principal may be forgiven if the loan
proceeds are used for qualifying expenses as described in the CARES Act, such as payroll costs, benefits, rent, and utilities. No assurance is provided that
the Company will obtain forgiveness of the loan in whole or in part. With respect to any portion of the loan that is not forgiven, the loan will be subject to
customary provisions for a loan of this type, including customary events of default relating to, among other things, payment defaults and breaches of the
provisions of the loan. 

The application for these funds required the Company to, in good faith, certify that the current economic uncertainty made the loan request necessary to
support the ongoing operations of the Company. Subsequently released guidance instructs all applicants and recipients to take into account their current
business activity and the Company's ability to access other sources of liquidity sufficient to support ongoing operations in a manner that is not significantly
detrimental to their business. On April 28, 2020, in press conference remarks, the Secretary of the U.S. Department of the Treasury stated that the SBA
intends to perform a review of PPP loans over $2.0 million. The required certification made by the Company is subject to interpretation. If, despite the
good-faith  belief  that  given  the  Company’s  circumstances  the  Company  satisfied  all  eligible  requirements  for  the  PPP  loan,  it  is  later  determined  the
Company was ineligible to apply for and receive the PPP loan, the Company may be required to repay the PPP loan in its entirety and the Company could
be subject to additional penalties. The company is in the process of applying for forgiveness of the PPP Loan, as of December 31, 2020. However, the
Company can provide no assurance that the loan will be forgiven.

The PPP loan will be derecognized upon repayment of the loan in accordance with its terms and/or upon confirmation of forgiveness from the SBA.

96

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

NOTE 13—SUBSEQUENT EVENTS

The Company evaluates events or transactions that occur after the balance sheet date through to the date which the financial statements are issued, for
potential recognition or disclosure in its consolidated financial statements in accordance with Subsequent Events.

On March 9, 2021, the Company offered $125 million aggregate principal amount of 2.25% convertible senior notes due 2026 (the “notes”) in a private
placement  to  qualified  institutional  buyers  pursuant  to  Rule  144A  under  the  Securities  Act  of  1933,  as  amended  (the  “Securities  Act”).  Cutera  also
granted the initial purchasers of the notes an option to purchase up to an additional $13.25 million aggregate principal amount of the notes on the same
terms and conditions. The Initial Purchasers exercised their option in full on March 5, 2021, bringing the total aggregate principal amount of the Notes
to $138.25 million.

The Company entered into capped call transactions, in connection with the offering, with one or more of the initial purchasers and/or their respective
affiliates and/or other financial institutions (the “option counterparties”). The capped call transactions are expected generally to reduce potential dilution
to Cutera’s common stock upon any conversion of notes, with such reduction subject to a cap. If the initial purchasers exercise their option to purchase
additional notes, the Company expects to enter into additional capped call transactions with the option counterparties.

The  net  proceeds  from  the  offering,  before  deducting  purchasers’  discounts  and  offering  expenses  were  approximately  $134.1  million.  The  Company
used $16.1 million of the net proceeds to pay the cost of the capped call transactions described above and the remainder of the net proceeds for general
corporate purposes, which may include working capital, capital expenditures and potential acquisitions and strategic transactions.

In connection with the offering, the Company entered into Amendment No. 1 to Loan and Security Agreement on March 4, 2021, which  amends  the
Company’s  Loan  and  Security  Agreement,  dated  as  of  July  9,  2020  between  the  Company,  as  borrower,  and  Silicon  Valley  Bank.  The  Amendment
amends  the  Loan  and  Security  Agreement  to  (i)  permit  the  Company  to  issue  the  Notes  and  perform  its  obligations  in  connection  therewith,  and  (ii)
permit the Capped Call transactions.

The Company has become aware that InMode Ltd. has filed a complaint with the United States International Trade Commission alleging that Ilooda, Co.,
Ltd’s Secret RF fractional radiofrequency microneedling system, distributed in the United States by the Company, infringes U.S. Patent No. 10,799,285
("285  patent").  The  complaint  has  not  been  served  on  the  Company.  The  Company  intends  to  vigorously  defend  against  this  lawsuit  and,  based  on  a
preliminary investigation, believes that the Company has strong defenses and that this patent is likely invalid in view of prior art. Based on the current
information available to the Company, it believes that any possible loss will not be material. If, following a successful third-party action for infringement,
the Company cannot obtain a license for the Company’s products, it may have to stop selling the applicable products.

SUPPLEMENTARY FINANCIAL DATA (UNAUDITED)
(In thousands, except per share amounts)

  $

Quarter ended:
Net revenue
Cost of revenue
Gross profit
Operating expenses:
Sales and marketing
Research and development
General and administrative
Total operating expenses
Income (loss) from operations    
Interest and other income

(expense), net

Income (loss) before income
taxes
Income tax provision (benefit)    
  $
Net income (loss)
Net income (loss) per share-
basic
Net income (loss) per share-

  $

Dec. 31,
2020

Sept. 30,
2020

June 30,
2020

March 31,
2020

Dec. 31,
2019

Sept. 30,
2019

June 30,
2019

March 31,
2019

49,943    $
21,877     
28,066     

39,132    $
17,386     
21,746     

26,369    $
14,745     
11,624     

32,239    $
17,903     
14,336     

51,795    $
23,005     
28,790     

46,117    $
19,884     
26,233     

47,774    $
21,943     
25,831     

14,656     
4,029     
7,938     
26,623     
1,443     

12,286     
3,432     
7,239     
22,957     
(1,211)    

11,035     
2,991     
8,529     
22,555     
(10,931)    

14,789     
3,870     
7,806     
26,465     
(12,129)    

20,323     
4,463     
5,933     
30,719     
(1,929)    

17,691     
3,643     
7,308     
28,642     
(2,409)    

16,992     
3,273     
5,267     
25,532     
299     

36,026 
18,717 
17,309 

16,104 
3,706 
5,525 
25,335 
(8,026)

7     

(382)    

3     

(207)    

(20)    

(146)    

46     

(79)

1,450     
(738)    
2,188    $

(1,593)    
664     
(2,257)   $

(10,928)    
466     
(11,394)   $

(12,336)    
78     
(12,414)   $

(1,949)    
139     
(2,088)   $

(2,555)    
73     
(2,628)   $

345     
(243)    
588    $

(8,105)
115 
(8,220)

0.12    $

(0.13)   $

(0.67)   $

(0.86)   $

(0.15)   $

(0.19)   $

0.04    $

(0.59)

diluted

Weighted average number of
shares used in per share
calculations:

Basic
Diluted

  $

0.12    $

(0.13)   $

(0.67)   $

(0.86)   $

(0.15)   $

(0.19)   $

0.04    $

(0.59 

17,653     
17,840     

17,603     
17,603     

17,055     
17,055     

14,433     
14,433     

14,261     
14,261     

14,182     
14,182     

14,086     
14,356     

14,017 
14,017 

97

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
 
   
   
     
       
       
       
       
       
       
       
 
   
   
   
   
   
   
     
       
       
       
       
       
       
       
 
   
   
 
Table of Contents

SCHEDULE II CUTERA, INC.
VALUATION AND QUALIFYING ACCOUNTS
(in thousands)
For the Years Ended December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018

Deferred tax assets valuation allowance
Year ended December 31, 2020
Year ended December 31, 2019
Year ended December 31, 2018

Allowance for credit losses, accounts receivable
Year ended December 31, 2020
Year ended December 31, 2019
Year ended December 31, 2018

Balance at
Beginning
of Year

Additions

    Deductions    

Balance
at End of
Year

32,350    $
27,865    $
7,242    $

7,986    $
7,396    $
22,770    $

2,015    $
2,911    $
2,147    $

38,321 
32,350 
27,865 

Balance at
Beginning
of Year

Additions

    Deductions    

Balance
at End of
Year

1,354    $
1,257    $
9    $

2,144    $
1,361    $
1,880    $

1,900    $
1,264    $
632    $

1,598 
1,354 
1,257 

  $
  $
  $

  $
  $
  $

98

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
     
       
       
       
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
     
       
       
       
 
 
Table of Contents

ITEM 9.           CHANGES IN AND DISAGREEMENTS WITH ACCOUNTANTS ON ACCOUNTING AND FINANCIAL DISCLOSURE

None.

ITEM 9A.        CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES

Conclusion Regarding the Effectiveness of Disclosure Controls and Procedures

The Company maintains disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as
amended) that are designed to ensure that information required to be disclosed in the Company’s Exchange Act reports is recorded, processed, summarized
and reported within the time periods specified in the SEC’s rules and forms and that such information is accumulated and communicated to the Company’s
management, including the Company’s principal executive officer and principal financial officer, as appropriate, to allow for timely decisions regarding
required disclosure.

As  required  by  SEC  Rule  13a-15(b),  the  Company  carried  out  an  evaluation,  under  the  supervision  and  with  the  participation  of  the  Company’s
management, including the Company’s principal executive officer and principal financial officer, of the effectiveness of the design and operation of the
Company’s  disclosure  controls  and  procedures  as  of  the  end  of  the  period  covered  by  this  Annual  Report  on  Form  10-K.  Based  on  the  foregoing,  the
Company’s Chief Executive Officer (“CEO”) and Chief Financial Officer (“CFO”) concluded that the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures were
effective at the reasonable assurance level.

Attached as exhibits to this Annual Report are certifications of the Company’s CEO and CFO, which are required in accordance with Rule 13a-14 of the
Securities  Exchange  Act  of  1934,  as  amended  (Exchange  Act).  This  Controls  and  Procedures  section  includes  the  information  concerning  the  controls
evaluation  referred  to  in  the  certifications,  and  it  should  be  read  in  conjunction  with  the  certifications  for  a  more  complete  understanding  of  the  topics
presented.

Inherent Limitations Over Internal Controls

The Company’s internal control over financial reporting is designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the
preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with GAAP. The Company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those
policies and procedures that:

● pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the Company’s

assets;

● provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with
GAAP, and that the Company’s receipts and expenditures are being made only in accordance with authorizations of the Company’s
management and directors; and

● provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the Company’s assets

that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

Management, including the Company’s CEO and CFO, does not expect that the Company’s internal controls will prevent or detect all errors and all fraud.
A control system, no matter how well designed and operated, can provide only reasonable, not absolute, assurance that the objectives of the control system
are met. Further, the design of a control system must reflect the fact that there are resource constraints, and the benefits of controls must be considered
relative to their costs. Because of the inherent limitations in all control systems, no evaluation of internal controls can provide absolute assurance that all
control issues and instances of fraud, if any, have been detected. Also, any evaluation of the effectiveness of controls in future periods are subject to the risk
that  those  internal  controls  may  become  inadequate  because  of  changes  in  business  conditions,  or  that  the  degree  of  compliance  with  the  policies  or
procedures may deteriorate.

Management’s Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting

The Company’s management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Rules 13a-
15(f)  and  15d-15(f)  under  the  Exchange  Act)  to  provide  reasonable  assurance  regarding  the  reliability  of  the  Company’s  financial  reporting  and  the
preparation of Consolidated Financial Statements for external purposes in accordance with U.S. GAAP.

Management,  including  Company’s  CEO  and  CFO,  assessed  the  Company’s  internal  control  over  financial  reporting  as  of  December  31,  2020.
Management based its assessment on criteria established in Internal Control—Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations
of the Treadway Commission (2013 framework). Management’s assessment included evaluation of elements such as the design and operating effectiveness
of key financial reporting controls, process documentation, accounting policies, and the Company's overall control environment.

Based on this assessment, management has concluded that the Company’s internal control over financial reporting was effective as of the end of the fiscal
year to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of Consolidated Financial Statements for external
reporting purposes in accordance with U.S. GAAP.

The effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2020, has been audited by an independent registered public
accounting firm, as stated in their attestation report, which is included in their annual report under “Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data”
of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

99

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Changes in Internal Control over Financial Reporting

There were no changes in the Company’s internal control over financial reporting during the quarter ended December 31, 2020 that have materially
affected, or are reasonably likely to materially affect, the Company's internal control over financial reporting.

ITEM 9B.        OTHER INFORMATION

None

PART III

Certain information required by Part III is omitted from this report on Form 10-K and is incorporated herein by reference to the Company’s definitive
Proxy Statement for the Company’s next Annual Meeting of Stockholders (the “Proxy Statement”), which the Company intends to file pursuant to
Regulation 14A of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, within 120 days after December 31, 2020.

ITEM 10.         DIRECTORS, EXECUTIVE OFFICERS AND CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

The information required by this item is set forth under the following captions in the Company’s Proxy Statement, all of which is incorporated herein by
reference: “Proposal No. 1 – Election of Class I Directors”, “Board and Committee Information”, “Executive Officers” and “Additional Information –
Stockholder Proposals to be Presented at Next Annual Meeting.”

ITEM 11.        EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION

The information required by this item set forth under the following captions in the Proxy Statement, all of which is incorporated herein by reference:
“Executive Compensation.”

ITEM 12.        SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT AND RELATED STOCKHOLDER

MATTERS

The information required by this item is set forth under the following captions in the Proxy Statement, all of which is incorporated herein by reference:
“Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management.”

ITEM 13.         CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS, AND DIRECTOR INDEPENDENCE

Certain Relationships and Related Transactions

The information required by this item is set forth under the following captions in the Proxy Statement, all of which is incorporated herein by reference:
“Certain Relationships and Related-Party Transactions.”

ITEM 14.         PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTING FEES AND SERVICES

The information required by this item is set forth under the following captions in the Proxy Statement, which is incorporated by reference herein by
reference: “Proposal No. 2, Ratification of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm.”

100

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

PART IV

ITEM 15.     EXHIBITS, FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES

(a) The following documents are filed in Part II of the Annual Report on the Original 10-K:

1. Financial Statements: Financial Statements: See "Index to Consolidated Financial Statements" within the Consolidated Financial Statements.

2. Financial Statement Schedules: Financial Statement Schedules; not applicable or the required information is otherwise included in the Consolidated
Financial Statements and accompanying notes.

3. Exhibits: The exhibits listed in the accompanying index to exhibits are filed, furnished, or incorporated by reference as part of this Form 10-K. The
following is a list of such Exhibits:

Exhibit No.  

Description

Exhibit Index

    3.1

    3.2

    4.1

    4.2

  10.1*

  10.2*

  10.3*

  10.4

  10.5

  10.6

  10.7*

  10.8*

  10.9

  10.10*

  10.11*

  10.12*

  10.13*

Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation of the Registrant (filed as Exhibit 3.5 to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form
10-Q filed on November 7, 2017 and incorporated herein by reference)

Bylaws of the Registrant (filed as Exhibit 3.4 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on January 8, 2015 and incorporated
herein by reference)

Specimen Common Stock certificate of the Registrant (filed as Exhibit 4.1 to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on
March 25, 2005 and incorporated herein by reference)

Description of the Registrant’s Securities (filed as Exhibit 4.2 to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on March 16, 2020
and incorporated herein by reference)

Form of Indemnification Agreement for directors and executive officers (filed as Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Current Report on
Form 8-K filed on February 21, 2019 and incorporated herein by reference)

1998 Stock Plan (filed as Exhibit 10.2 to the Company’s registration statement on Form S-1 filed on January 15, 2004 and incorporated
herein by reference)

2004 Employee Stock Purchase Plan (filed as Exhibit 10.4 to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on March 16, 2007 and
incorporated herein by reference)

Brisbane Technology Park Lease dated August 5, 2003 by and between the Registrant and Gal-Brisbane, L.P. for office space located at
3240 Bayshore Boulevard, Brisbane, California (filed as Exhibit 10.6 to the Company’s registration statement on Form S-1 filed on
January 15, 2004 and incorporated herein by reference)

Settlement Agreement between the Registrant and Palomar Medical Technologies, Inc. dated June  2, 2006 (filed as Exhibit 99.1 to the
Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on June 6, 2006 and incorporated herein by reference)

Non-Exclusive Patent License between the Registrant and Palomar Medical Technologies, Inc. dated June 2, 2006 (filed as Exhibit 99.2
to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on June 6, 2006 and incorporated herein by reference)

Form of Performance Unit Award Agreement (filed as Exhibit 10.11 to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on
November 14, 2005 and incorporated herein by reference)

2019 Equity Incentive Plan (filed as Appendix A to the Company’s definitive proxy statement on Form 14A filed on April  30, 2019
and incorporated herein by reference)

First Amendment to Brisbane Technology Park Lease dated August 11, 2010 by and between the Company and BMR-Bayshore
Boulevard LLC, as successor-in-interest to Gal-Brisbane, L.P., the original landlord, for office space located at 3240 Bayshore
Boulevard (filed as Exhibit 10.19 to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on November 1, 2010 and incorporated herein
by reference)

Change of Control and Severance Agreement between Kevin P. Connors and the Registrant (filed as Exhibit 10.20 to the Company’s
Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on August 1, 2016 and incorporated herein by reference)

Change of Control and Severance Agreement between Ronald J. Santilli and the Registrant (filed as Exhibit 10.21 to the Company’s
Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on August 1, 2016 and incorporated herein by reference)

Form of Performance Stock Unit Award Agreement (filed as Exhibit 10.22 to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on
August 1, 2016 and incorporated herein by reference)

Change of Control and Severance Agreement between James Reinstein and the Registrant (filed as Exhibit 10.23 to the Company’s
Current Report on Form 8-K filed on January 11, 2017 and incorporated herein by reference)

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
101

Table of Contents

  10.14

  10.15

  10.16

Lease Termination Agreement dated July  6, 2017 by and between the Registrant and SI 28, LLC (filed as Exhibit 10.26 to the Company’s
Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on August 7, 2017 and incorporated herein by reference)

Second Amendment to Lease dated July  6, 2017 by and between the Company and BMR-Bayshore Boulevard LP (filed as Exhibit 10.27 to
the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on August 7, 2017 and incorporated herein by reference)

Transition Agreement dated July  12, 2017 by and between the Company and Ronald J. Santilli (filed as Exhibit 10.28 to the Company’s
Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on November 7, 2017 and incorporated herein by reference)

  10.17*

Chief Financial Officer Consulting Agreement dated July  12, 2017 by and between the Company and Sandra A. Gardiner (filed as Exhibit
10.29 to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on November 7, 2017 and incorporated herein by reference)

  10.18

  10.19

  10.20

  10.21

  10.22*

  10.23*

  10.24*

Loan and Security Agreement dated May  30, 2018 by and between the Company and Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. (filed as Exhibit 10.1 to the
Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on June 5, 2018 and incorporated herein by reference).

Separation Agreement dated January  4, 2019 by and between the Company and James Reinstein (filed as Exhibit 10.2 to the Company’s
Current Report on Form 8-K on January 9, 2019 and incorporated herein by reference).

First Amendment and Wavier to the Loan and Security Agreement dated November  2, 2018 by and between the Company and Wells Fargo
Bank, N.A. (filed as Exhibit 10.20 to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on March 16, 2020 and incorporated herein by
reference)

Second Amendment and Waiver to the Loan and Security Agreement dated March  11, 2019 by and between the Company and Wells Fargo
Bank N.A. (filed as Exhibit 10.20 to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on March 16, 2020 and incorporated herein by
reference)

Employment Offer Letter dated June  22, 2019 by and between Cutera, Inc. and David Mowry (filed as Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s
Current Report on Form 8-K filed on July 9, 2019 and incorporated herein by reference)

Change of Control and Severance Agreement dated July  8, 2019 by and between Cutera, Inc. and David Mowry (filed as Exhibit 10.2 to
the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on July 9, 2019 and incorporated herein by reference)

Consulting Agreement between Cutera, Inc. and FLG Partners, effective November  11, 2019 (filed as Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s
Current Report on Form 8-K filed on November 18, 2019 and incorporated herein by reference)

Exhibit No.  Description

  23.1+

  Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

  24.1

  Power of Attorney

  31.3+

  Certification of Chief Executive Officer pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002

  31.4+

  Certification of Chief Financial Officer pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002

  32.1+

Certification of Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted pursuant to Section 906
of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002

101.INS

  Inline XBRL Instance Document

101.SCH   Inline XBRL Taxonomy Extension Schema Document

101.CAL   Inline XBRL Taxonomy Extension Calculation Linkbase Document

101.DEF

  Inline XBRL Taxonomy Extension Definition Document

101.LAB   Inline XBRL Taxonomy Extension Label Linkbase Document

101.PRE

  Inline XBRL Taxonomy Extension Presentation Linkbase Document

104

  Cover Page Interactive Data File (formatted as Inline XBRL and contained in Exhibit 101)

* Management contract or compensatory plan
+ Filed herewith

102

 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
Table of Contents

ITEM 16. FORM 10-K SUMMARY

None

Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its
behalf by the undersigned thereunto duly authorized, in the city of Brisbane, State of California, on the 23rd day of March, 2021.

SIGNATURES

CUTERA, INC.

By:

/s/ DAVID H. MOWRY
David H. Mowry
Chief Executive Officer

Power of Attorney

KNOW ALL MEN AND WOMEN BY THESE PRESENTS, that each person whose signature appears below constitutes and appoints David H.

Mowry, and Rohan Seth, and each of them, as his or her true and lawful attorneys-in-fact and agents, with full power of substitution and resubstitution for
him or her and in his or her name, place, and stead, in any and all capacities to sign any and all amendments to this Annual Report on Form 10-K, and to
file the same, with exhibits thereto and other documents in connection therewith, with the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission, granting unto
said attorneys-in-fact and agents, and each of them, full power and authority to do and perform each and every act and thing requisite and necessary to be
done therewith, as fully to all intents and purposes as they might or could do in person, hereby ratifying and confirming all that said attorneys-in-fact and
agents, and any of them or their substitute or substitutes, may lawfully do or cause to be done by virtue hereof.

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the

registrant and in the capacities and on the dates indicated.

Signature

Title

Date

/s/ DAVID H. MOWRY
David H. Mowry

/s/ ROHAN SETH
Rohan Seth

/s/ J. DANIEL PLANTS
J. Daniel Plants

/s/ GREGORY A. BARRETT
Gregory A. Barrett

/s/ JOSEPH E. WHITTERS
Joseph E. Whitters

/s/ TIM O’SHEA
Tim O’Shea

/s/ KATHERINE S. ZANOTTI
Katherine S. Zanotti

   Chief Executive Officer and Director (Principal Executive Officer)

March 23, 2021

   Chief Financial Officer (Principal Financial and Accounting Officer)

March 23, 2021

   Chairman of the Board of Directors

March 23, 2021

   Director

   Director

   Director

   Director

103

March 23,2021

March 23, 2021

March 23, 2021

March 23, 2021

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
CONSENT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

Exhibit 23.1

Cutera, Inc.
Brisbane, California

We hereby consent to the incorporation by reference in the Registration Statements on Form S-3 (No. 333-237552) and Form S-8 (No. 333-114149, 333-
123495, 333-132583, 333-141376, 333-149703, 333-158160, 333-187502, 333-206864, and 333-221542) of Cutera, Inc. of our reports dated March 23,
2021, relating to the consolidated financial statements and schedule, and the effectiveness of Cutera, Inc.’s internal control over financial reporting, which
appear in this Form 10-K.

/s/ BDO USA, LLP
San Francisco, California
March 23, 2021

9

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
CERTIFICATION OF CHIEF EXECUTIVE OFFICER
PURSUANT TO 15 U.S.C. SECTION 7241, AS
ADOPTED PURSUANT TO SECTION 302 OF THE SARBANES-OXLEY ACT OF 2002

Exhibit 31.3

I, David H. Mowry, certify that:

1. I have reviewed this annual report on Form 10-K of Cutera, Inc.:

2. Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the
statements  made,  in  light  of  the  circumstances  under  which  such  statements  were  made,  not  misleading  with  respect  to  the  period  covered  by  this
report;

3. Based  on  my  knowledge,  the  financial  statements,  and  other  financial  information  included  in  this  report,  fairly  present  in  all  material  respects  the

financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the registrant as of, and for, the periods presented in this report;

4. The  registrant’s  other  certifying  officer  and  I  are  responsible  for  establishing  and  maintaining  disclosure  controls  and  procedures  (as  defined  in
Exchange  Act  Rules  13a-15(e)  and  15d-15(e))  and  internal  control  over  financial  reporting  (as  defined  in  Exchange  Act  Rules  13a-15(f)  and  15d-
15(f)) for the registrant and have:

(a)  Designed  such  disclosure  controls  and  procedures,  or  caused  such  disclosure  controls  and  procedures  to  be  designed  under  the  Company’s
supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to the Company by
others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this annual report is being prepared;

(b) Designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under the Company’s
supervision,  to  provide  reasonable  assurance  regarding  the  reliability  of  financial  reporting  and  the  preparation  of  financial  statements  for  external
purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;

(c) Evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report the Company’s conclusions about the
effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and

(d) Disclosed in this report any change in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the registrant’s most recent fiscal
quarter (the registrant’s fourth fiscal quarter in the case of an annual report) that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the
registrant’s internal control over financial reporting; and

5. The  registrant’s  other  certifying  officer  and  I  have  disclosed,  based  on  the  Company’s  most  recent  evaluation  of  internal  control  over  financial
reporting, to the registrant’s auditors and the audit committee of the registrant’s board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions):

a) All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely
to adversely affect the registrant’s ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and

b) Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the registrant’s internal control over
financial reporting.

 Date: March 23, 2021

/s/ DAVID H. MOWRY
David H. Mowry
Chief Executive Officer (Principal Executive Officer)

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
CERTIFICATION OF CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER
PURSUANT TO 15 U.S.C. SECTION 7241, AS
ADOPTED PURSUANT TO SECTION 302 OF THE SARBANES-OXLEY ACT OF 2002

Exhibit 31.4

I, Rohan Seth, certify that:

1. I have reviewed this annual report on Form 10-K of Cutera, Inc.:

2. Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the
statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this
report;

3. Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the

financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the registrant as of, and for, the periods presented in this report;

4. The  registrant’s  other  certifying  officer  and  I  are  responsible  for  establishing  and  maintaining  disclosure  controls  and  procedures  (as  defined  in
Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-
15(f)) for the registrant and have:

(a)  Designed  such  disclosure  controls  and  procedures,  or  caused  such  disclosure  controls  and  procedures  to  be  designed  under  the  Company’s
supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to the Company by
others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this annual report is being prepared;

(b) Designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under the Company’s
supervision,  to  provide  reasonable  assurance  regarding  the  reliability  of  financial  reporting  and  the  preparation  of  financial  statements  for  external
purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;

(c) Evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report the Company’s conclusions about the
effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and

(d) Disclosed in this report any change in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the registrant’s most recent fiscal
quarter (the registrant’s fourth fiscal quarter in the case of an annual report) that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the
registrant’s internal control over financial reporting; and

5. The  registrant’s  other  certifying  officer  and  I  have  disclosed,  based  on  the  Company’s  most  recent  evaluation  of  internal  control  over  financial
reporting, to the registrant’s auditors and the audit committee of the registrant’s board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions):

a) All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely
to adversely affect the registrant’s ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and

b) Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the registrant’s internal control over
financial reporting.

 Date: March 23, 2021

/s/ ROHAN SETH
Rohan Seth
Chief Financial Officer (Principal Financial and
Accounting Officer)

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
CERTIFICATION OF
CHIEF EXECUTIVE OFFICER AND CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER
PURSUANT TO 18 U.S.C. SECTION 1350,
AS ADOPTED PURSUANT TO SECTION 906 OF THE SARBANES-OXLEY ACT OF 2002

Exhibit 32.1

In connection with the annual report on Form 10-K of Cutera, Inc. a Delaware corporation, for the period ended December 31, 2020, as filed with
the Securities and Exchange Commission, each of the undersigned officers of Cutera, Inc. certifies pursuant to section 1350 of chapter 63 of title 18 of the
United States Code, as adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, that to his respective knowledge:

(1)

(2)

the annual report of Cutera, Inc. on Form 10-K for the period ended December 31, 2020, fully complies with the requirements of
Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended; and
the  information  contained  in  the  annual  report  fairly  presents,  in  all  material  respects,  the  financial  condition  and  results  of
operations of Cutera, Inc. for the periods presented therein.

 Date: March 23, 2021

 Date: March 23, 2021

/s/ DAVID H. MOWRY
David H. Mowry
Chief Executive Officer (Principal Executive Officer)

/s/ ROHAN SETH
Rohan Seth
Chief Financial Officer (Principal Financial and Accounting
Officer)